+ All Categories
Home > Documents > GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score:...

GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score:...

Date post: 08-Jul-2020
Category:
Upload: others
View: 0 times
Download: 0 times
Share this document with a friend
314
Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012-07-19.by.OtherPeoples+Ahmad502q_formatted Number : 000-000 Passing Score : 800 Time Limit : 120 min File Version : 1.0 http://www.gratisexam.com/ 70-662::Other People's Ahmad.Sabry.Elgendi::502q:: 13-10-2012 Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox 180q, Majd Salha 420q, and Fiber 342q (due to the vast amount of duplication inherent in these particular exams) with a lot of the wrong answers meticulously corrected thanks to a great deal of searching through MS Technet AND a lot of the bad grammar corrected thanks to a massive pedant being at the helm. I have also added six new questions that I came across in my exam and updated a few that were out of date (with the wrong commands etc).. Please be aware that there is still some minor duplication of questions as the wording and answers may be different in each. ============================================================== Modified October 2012 By Ahmad Sabry , Kindly note that below This Dump is SAME OtherPeoples one but I added the below Snapshots or explainations or removed little duplicated questions, I have increased the number of qiestions in each exam to avoid the long Exams model , Also I have exported Questions from Microsfot Self Paced training KIT official book ,, the good thing about it , All questions almost tells you Why the incorrect is not right , I used it at first as quick review the Exam content , then I went to this dump. Never be dissapointed when you see it is 502 Questions , Just study each question to get the real flavor and benfit of this. A: Q5 Extra Explaination Comment. Q12 Powershell Example. Q13 ACK POwershell Example Q15 Examples Q17 Explanination Q18 The full screeenshot for better understanding. Q19 The full screeenshot for better understanding. Q20 Additional screeenshot for better understanding. Q22 Explain scoped send connector Q33 Mailbox database properities B: Q2 Snapshot for ExMon
Transcript
Page 1: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012-07-19.by.OtherPeoples+Ahmad502q_formatted

Number: 000-000Passing Score: 800Time Limit: 120 minFile Version: 1.0

http://www.gratisexam.com/

70-662::Other People's Ahmad.Sabry.Elgendi::502q:: 13-10-2012

Number: 70-662Passing Score: 700Time Limit: 120 minFile Version: 1.1

Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox 180q, Majd Salha 420q, and Fiber 342q (due to the vast amount ofduplication inherent in these particular exams) with a lot of the wrong answers meticulously corrected thanks toa great deal of searching through MS Technet AND a lot of the bad grammar corrected thanks to a massivepedant being at the helm.

I have also added six new questions that I came across in my exam and updated a few that were out of date(with the wrong commands etc)..

Please be aware that there is still some minor duplication of questions as the wording and answers may bedifferent in each.============================================================== Modified October 2012 ByAhmad Sabry , Kindly note that below This Dump is SAME OtherPeoples one but I added the below Snapshotsor explainations or removed little duplicated questions, I have increased the number of qiestions in each examto avoid the long Exams model , Also I have exported Questions from Microsfot Self Paced training KIT officialbook ,, the good thing about it , All questions almost tells you Why the incorrect is not right , I used it at first asquick review the Exam content , then I went to this dump.

Never be dissapointed when you see it is 502 Questions , Just study each question to get the real flavor andbenfit of this.

A:Q5 Extra Explaination Comment.Q12 Powershell Example.Q13 ACK POwershell ExampleQ15 ExamplesQ17 ExplaninationQ18 The full screeenshot for better understanding.Q19 The full screeenshot for better understanding.Q20 Additional screeenshot for better understanding.Q22 Explain scoped send connectorQ33 Mailbox database properities

B:Q2 Snapshot for ExMon

Page 2: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Q5 PowerShell Examples.Q14 Explanation for send as send on behalfQ29 Snapshot Example.Q35 Snapshot ExampleQ36 Powershell COmmand

C:Q7 Powershell clear Examples .Q29 Clear Example of personal tagQ32 Snapshot & powershell Example

D:Q2 Explain what is pipeline tracing by examplesQ3 SnapshotQ5 SnapshotQ7 Snapshot & ExplainQ10 Explain & Snapshots to understandQ18 SnapshotQ28 Explain DACQ33 Example

E:Q2 Examples to understandQ11 cmdlet example & SnapshotQ15 & Q36 Same SnapshotQ16 SnapshotQ27 SnapshotQ29 Explain Cashed ModeQ43 URL to explainQ39 Cmdlets example

F:Q12 SnapshotQ21 Snapshot

G:Q7 All unattended ExamplesQ12 Adding Command Example & Refference.Q17 Explaination & SnapshotQ23 SnapshotQ24 ExampleQ33 StepsQ35 Explain Commands in question for better understanding.Q36 command example

H:Q2 ExplainQ4 ExplainQ6 SnapshotQ14 ExplainQ24 ExplainQ25 ExampleQ29 Example snapshotsQ38 Smnapshot & ExampleQ39 Explain

I:Q9 SnapshotQ11 PowerShell Examples.Q14 Explain Cmdlets

Page 3: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Q21 explain Change DAG replication PortQ24 Explain Edge PrerequisitesQ30 Explain why C is correct.Q32 Explain how to create a recovery database.Q33 SnapshotQ37 SnapshotQ38 My Comment

J:Q7 Adding Snapshot to clear the Role Assignment.Q11 Snapshot to clear the answerQ12 I changed the answer from C: to D. The question says (Which tool) , yes it can be done from the individualuser Public folder permissions in outlook , but this is a tool in Exchange is more closer as far I understand.Q14 Set-PowerShellVirtualDirectory "Contoso (default Web site)" -ExternalUrl "http://www.contoso.com/powershell"Q15 Explain WIldCard certificate & How to configureQ17 Explaination and Snapshot.Q20 Snapshot for OWA virtual directory to Change PasswordQ25 Explaination.Q29 Explaination and refference.Q31 Explaination by examples

--->>> Duplicates Removed:==================================================Search by this question head:You have a server that runs Windows Server 2008 SP2. You plan to install Exchange Server 2010 SP1 on theserver.You need to install the Exchange Server 2010 SP1 pre-requisites for the Mailbox, Client Access, and HubTransport server roles.orby the answer:Install Microsoft .NET Framework 3.5 SP1Install Windows Management FrameworkRun ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP Exchange-Typical.xml----------There are 4 similar questions , 3 Identical with same answer, one with extra answers.I removed 2=======================================

K: Questions Sections are collected from here:Exam A

Sections1. (none)

Page 4: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Exam A

QUESTION 1You have an Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization. The SMTP domain for the organizationis contoso.com. You enable the Exchange anti-spam features.

You need to specify a quarantine mailbox for the Exchange organization.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the Content Filter agent.B. Run the Set-ContentFilterConfig from the Exchange Management Shell.C. Run the Set-TransportConfig cmdlet from the Exchange Management Shell.D. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the Recipient Filter agent.E. Run the New-TransportRule cmdlet from the Exchange Management Shell.F. Run the Set-OrganizationConfig cmdlet from the Exchange Management Shell.G. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the Sender Filter agent.H. Run the New-JournalRule cmdlet from the Exchange Management Shell.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-ContentFilterConfig -QuarantineMailbox [email protected]

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123746.aspx

QUESTION 2Your network contains an Active Directory forest named fabrikam.com. The forest contains an ExchangeServer 2010 Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization.

All client computers run Microsoft Office Outlook 2003. A server named Ex1 hosts all public folders. Youupgrade all of the client computers to Outlook 2010.

You need to remove all of the public folders from Ex1.

What should you do first?

A. Modify the offline address book (OAB) distribution settings.B. Modify the properties of the mailbox database.C. Delete all of the public folders from the public folder database.D. Perform an offline defragmentation of the public folder database files.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:In the console tree, click Toolbox.In the result pane, click Public Folder Management Console. In the action pane, click Open Tool. The PublicFolder Management Console appears. In the console tree, expand Default Public Folders, and then select the

Page 5: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

parent public folder of the public folder that you want to remove.In the result pane, select the public folder that you want to remove. In the action pane, click Remove. A warningappears. Click Yes to confirm that you want to remove the public folder.Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa997202.aspx

QUESTION 3You have an Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization named contoso.com. All users accesstheir mailbox by using Microsoft Outlook 2010.

You need to ensure that the users can prevent sensitive email messages from being forwarded to otherrecipients.

What should you do first?

A. Configure Transport Layer Security (TLS) on all Send connectors.B. Install Active Directory Rights Management Services (AD RMS).C. Run the Set-TransportConfig cmdlet.D. Deploy Secure MIME.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:You have to have AD RMS in your environment first. Then, you can set the transport configuration.

Get-RMSTemplate | flNew-TransportRule -Name "Protect-BusinessCriticalProject" -SubjectContainsWords "Business Critical" -ApplyRightsProtectionTemplate "Do Not Forward"

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd302432.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd351035

QUESTION 4You are a network administrator for a company named Contoso, Ltd. Contoso has an Exchange Server 2010Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization named contoso.com. The organization contains the following Exchangeservers:

Two Hub Transport servers

Two Edge Transport servers that have Edge Subscriptions

Contoso merges with another company named Fabrikam, Inc. Fabrikam has an Exchange Server 2010 SP1organization that uses the fabrikam.com SMTP domain.

All mail exchange (MX) records for fabrikam.com point to the contoso.com Edge Transport servers. You deploya solution for Contoso to journal all email messages by using Hub Transport rules.

You need to ensure that all email messages received by fabrikam.com users from the Internet are journaled bythe contoso.com Exchange organization.

Page 6: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the new-accepteddomain -domaintype internalrelay command.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the new-sendconnector -addressspaces fabrikam.com

command.C. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), create an accepted domain that uses the authoritative

domain type.D. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the new-receiveconnector -partner command.E. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the new-accepteddomain -domaintype externalrelay command.F. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), create an accepted domain that uses the internal relay

domain type.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Accepted Domain = Any domain whose email will be routed by the Exchange organization transport serversAuthoritative Domain = used to specify which SMTP domain is served by your Exchange organization; anexchange organization is authoritative when it handles mail delivery for recipients in the accepted domain.Internal Relay = Hub to Hub between Exchange Organizations External Relay = Edge to Edge betweenExchange Organizations

Journaling can be done on a per user or per mailbox database basis. Journal rules can also be made Global,thereby journaling all messages that pass through the Hub Transport server.

References:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124423.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa996314.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa995975.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa998649.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124911.aspxhttp://blogs.technet.com/b/exchange/archive/2011/10/07/accepted-domains-shared-smtp-address-spaces- and-recipient-filtering.aspx

QUESTION 5Your network contains an Active Directory domain named contoso.com. All domain controllers run WindowsServer 2008 R2.

You have a server named Server1 that runs Windows Server 2008 R2 Service Pack 1 (SP1). You plan to installthe following Exchange Server 2010 SP1 server roles on Server1:

Mailbox

Client Access

Hub Transport

You need to prepare Server1 for the planned installation. You import the Server Manager module for WindowsPowerShell.

What should you do next?

Page 7: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. From Windows PowerShell, run add-windowsfeature net-framework,rsat,adlds.B. At the command prompt, run servermanagercmd and use the Exchange-Typical.xml template.C. From Windows PowerShell, run add-windowsfeature net-framework. From the Exchange Server 2010

installation program, select the Automatically install Windows Server roles and features required forExchange Server check box.

D. At the command prompt, run servermanagercmd and use the Exchange-Base.xml template.E. At the command prompt, run setup /pl. From the Exchange Server 2010 installation program, select the

Automatically install Windows Server roles and features required for Exchange Server check box.F. From Windows PowerShell, run add-windowsfeature net-framework,rsat-adds,web-server,web- basic-auth.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://msmvps.com/blogs/andersonpatricio/archive/2010/07/07/installing-operating-system-roles-and- features-automatically-in-exchange-server-2010-sp1.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb691354.aspx (under the "Install the Windows 2008 R2 operatingsystem prerequisites" section)http://msmvps.com/blogs/richardsiddaway/archive/2009/04/18/powershell-modules-and-exchange-2010-prerequisites.aspx

-----------------

Each file relates to a specific Exchange 2010 deployment scenario.exchange-all.xml all server rolesexchange-base.xml only the requirements for Forest and Domain prep operations exchange-cadb.xml CentralAdmin Database roleexchange-cas.xml Client Access Server roleexchange-eca.xml Central Admin roleexchange-edge.xml Edge Transport Server roleexchange-hub.xml Hub Transport Server roleexchange-mbx.xml Mailbox Server roleexchange-typical.xml Typical Exchange server (Client Access, Hub Transport, and Mailbox Server roles)exchange-um.xml Unified Messaging role

QUESTION 6You have an Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack 1 (SP1) Mailbox server named Server1.

You need to ensure that a copy of each email message modified or deleted by a user named User1 is retainedon Server1.

What should you do?

A. Create a personal tag.B. Enable single item recovery.C. Enable message tracking.D. Enable litigation hold.E. Create a retention policy.F. Create a journal rule.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)

Page 8: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ee861123.aspx

QUESTION 7Your company has two offices. Each office is configured as an Active Directory site. The offices connect toeach other by using a congested WAN link.

Each office has a direct, high-speed connection to the Internet. Each site contains two Exchange Server 2010Service Pack 1 (SP1) Hub Transport servers.

http://www.gratisexam.com/

You need to ensure that email messages sent to the Internet from the Exchange organization are never routedover the WAN link.What should you do from each site?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-TransportConfig crndlet.B. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the accepted domain.C. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-SendConnector cmdlet.D. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the Receive connector.E. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the Send connector.F. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the remote domain.G. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set- ForeignConnector cmdlet.H. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-TransportAgent cmdlet.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa998294.aspx

QUESTION 8You have an Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack1 (SP1) organization. The organization contains the serversconfigured as shown in the following table:

Page 9: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

The Mailbox servers are members of a database availability group (DAG) named DAG1. The organization alsohas a load balancing solution for Client Access. The load balancing solution has a virtual IP address that isavailable by using the mail.contoso.com host name.

You create a new Client Access array that uses the outlook.contoso.com fully qualified name (FQDN). Youneed to ensure that all users connect to outlook.contoso.com from Microsoft Outlook 2010.

Which Windows Powershell cmdlet should you run?

A. Set-MailbxDatabaseCopy.B. New-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup.C. Set-MailboxServer.D. Set-ClientAccessServer.E. New-PublicMailboxDatabase.F. New- PublicFolderDatabase.G. Set-ClientAccessArray.H. Add-MailboxDatabaseCopy.I. Set-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup.J. Set-PublicFolderDatabae.K. Add-RoleGroupMember.L. Add-DatabaseAvailabilityGroupServer.M. Set-MailboxDatabase.

Correct Answer: MSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123971.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ee332317.aspxhttp://www.msexchange.org/articles_tutorials/exchange-server-2007/planning-architecture/uncovering-new-rpc-client-access-service-exchange-2010-part1.html

QUESTION 9You have an Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack1 (SP1) organization. The organization contains the serversconfigured as shown in the following table:

Page 10: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

The Mailbox servers are members of a database availability group (DAG) named DAG1.

You need to configure DAG1 to use a static IP of 192.168.1.100.

Which Windows PowerShell cmdlet should you run?

A. Set-MailboxServer.B. Set-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup.C. New-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup.D. Add-MailboxDatabaseCopy.E. Add-DatabaseAvailabilityGroupServer.F. Set-MailboxDatabase.G. Set-ClientAccessServer.H. Set-ClientAccessArray.I. Set-PublicFolderDatabae.J. New- PublicFolderDatabase.K. Add-RoleGroupMember.L. Set-MailbxDatabaseCopy.M. New-MailboxDatabase.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup -Identity DAG1 -DatabaseAvailabilityGroupIpAddresses 192.168.1.100

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd297934.aspx

QUESTION 10You have an Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization named fabrikam.com. A partnercompany has an Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization named contoso.com. You plan toimplement federated delegation between fabrikam.com and contoso.com.

You need to identify which DNS records must be created to support federated delegation.

Which DNS records should you identify? (Choose all that apply).

A. Host (A).B. Mail exchanger (MX).C. Host information (HINFO).D. Text (TXT).

Page 11: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

E. Mail group (MG).

Correct Answer: ADSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Create a TXT record for federated delegation.Create an Autodiscover DNS record (CNAME).

In this case I left the original A record answer in as that would already need to be created to resolve the IP, thena CNAME record would point to the A record (as CNAMEs can't point to IP addresses).

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd335047.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd335198.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ff601760.aspx

QUESTION 11Your network contains an Active Directory domain named contoso.com. You have an Exchange Server 2010Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization. External users access their email by using Outlook Web App.

You need to ensure that the external users can log on to Outlook Web App without specifying a domain name.

Which Windows PowerShell cmdlet should you use?

A. Set-OrganizationConfig.B. Set-OwaVirtualDirectory.C. New-OrganizationRelationShip.D. New-OwaMailboxPolicy.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-OWAVirtualDirectory -Identity "owa (default web site)" -LogonFormat username -DefaultDomainwww.contoso.com

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123515.aspx

QUESTION 12You have an Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack1 organization. The Organization contains a Hub Transportserver named Server1 and an Edge Transport sever named Server2. All servers are configured to use aninternal DNS server named DNS1 for host resolution.

You configure an Edge Subscription from Server1 to Server2. You deploy a monitoring server namedServerApp1. ServerApp1 will send email notifications to administrators.

You need to ensure that ServerApp1 can relay email to the administrators through Server1.

What should you do?

Page 12: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-TransportServer cmdlet.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-TransportConfig cmdlet.C. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), create a transport rule.D. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the remote domain.E. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-ReceiveConnector cmdlet.F. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), disable the IP Block List feature.G. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the accepted domain.H. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-TransportAgent cmdlet.

Correct Answer: ESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/hh529935.aspx

To add a single IP address to an existing Receive Connector:[PS] C:\>$RecvConn = Get-ReceiveConnector "Relay Connector" [PS] C:\>$RecvConn.RemoteIPRanges +="10.0.0.99"[PS] C:\>Set-ReceiveConnector "Relay Connector" -RemoteIPRanges $RecvConn.RemoteIPRanges

QUESTION 13You have an Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack1 organization. The organization contains a Hub Transportserver named Server1 and an Edge Transport sever named Server2. All servers are configured to use aninternal DNS server named DNS1 for host resolution. You configure an Edge Subscription from Server1 toServer2.

You need to modify the delayed acknowledgment (ACK) setting of Server2.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the accepted domain.B. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), create a transport rule.C. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-TransportServer cmdlet.D. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-ReceiveConnector cmdlet.E. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), disable the IP Block List feature.F. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-TransportAgent cmdlet.G. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-TransportConfig cmdlet.H. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the remote domain.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/hh529935.aspx

Set-ReceiveConnector "Custom App Receive Connector" -MaxAcknowledgementDelay 0

QUESTION 14

Page 13: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Your network contains an Active Directory domain. The domain contains one site.

You have an Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization that contains two Client Access serversand two Hub Transport servers. Users report that they fail to receive email messages from the Internet. Youreview the message tracking logs and discover that the organization failed to receive any email messages fromthe Internet during the past hour.

You need to identify what is preventing the Hub Transport servers from receiving email messages.

What should run from the Exchange Management Shell?

A. Test-WebServicesConnectivity.B. Test-MailFlow.C. Get-MailboxDatabase.D. Test-MapiConnectivity.E. Test-ReplicationHealth.F. Test-AvailabilityService.G. Get-SenderIdConfig.H. Test-SMTPConnectivity.I. Checkdatabaseseredundancy.ps1.J. Retry-Queue.K. Test-SenderID.L. Get-MailboxDatabaseCopyStatus.M. Test-SystemHealth.N. Test-OutlookWebServices.

Correct Answer: HSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ff849710.aspx

QUESTION 15Your network contains an Active Directory domain. The domain contains one site.

You have an Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization that contains two Client Accessservers, two Hub Transport servers, and three Mailbox servers. The mailbox servers are members of adatabase availability group (DAG) named DAG1.

You have a mailbox database named DB1. You configure two mailbox database copies of DB1. You verify thatboth mailbox database copies have a status of Healthy.

You need to ensure that an administrator is notified when the health status of a mailbox database copychanges.

What should you run from the Exchange Management Shell?

A. Test- WebServicesConnectivity .B. Test-SystemHealth .C. Test-AvailabilityService .D. checkdatabaseredundancy.ps1.

Page 14: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

E. Test-ReplicationHealth.F. Test-SmtpConnectivity.G. Get-MailboxDataboxCopyStatus.H. Retry-Queue.I. Test-MailFlow.J. Get-MailboxDatabase.K. Test-SenderId.L. Get-SenderIdConfig.M. Test-MapiConnectivity.N. Test-OutlookWebServices.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd351258.aspxhttp://gallery.technet.microsoft.com/scriptcenter/8833b4db-8016-47e5-b747-951d28faafe7

[PS] CheckDatabaseRedundancy.ps1 -MailboxDatabaseName "Mailbox Database 1928496050"

DatabaseName : Mailbox Database 1928496050LastRedundancyCount : 0CurrentRedundancyCount : 2LastState : UnknownCurrentState : GreenLastStateTransitionUtc : 5/11/2010 7:51:19 PMLastGreenTransitionUtc : 5/11/2010 7:51:19 PMLastRedTransitionUtc :LastGreenReportedUtc : 5/11/2010 7:51:19 PMLastRedReportedUtc :PreviousTotalRedDuration : 00:00:00TotalRedDuration : 00:00:00IsTransitioningState : TrueHasErrorsInHistory : FalseCurrentErrorMessages :ErrorHistory :

QUESTION 16Your network contains two Active Directory forests named Contoso and NWTraders. The Contoso forestcontains Exchange 2003 SP2 Servers. The NWTraders forest contains Exchange 2010 SP1 Servers.

You need to move all mailboxes from contoso to NWTraders.

What should you do from NWTraders forest?

A. Create a mail enabled contact for each mailbox in contoso. Run the Movemailbox cmdlet.B. Create a mail enabled user for each mailbox in contoso. Run the New-MoveRequest cmdlet.C. Create a linked mailbox for each mailbox in contoso. Run Movemailbox cmdlet.D. Create a shared mailbox for each mailbox in contoso. Run the New-MoveRequest cmdlet.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)

Page 15: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Microsoft Exchange Server 2010 supports remote mailbox moves via the New-MoveRequest cmdlet. To movea mailbox from an Exchange Server 2010, Exchange Server 2007, or Exchange Server 2003 forest to anotherExchange 2010 forest, the Exchange 2010 target forest must contain a valid mail-enabled user with a specifiedset of Active Directory attributes. (Exchange 2010 doesn't support moving an Exchange 2000 Server mailbox).If there is at least one Exchange 2010 Client Access server deployed in the forest, the forest is considered anExchange 2010 forest.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ee633491.aspx

QUESTION 17You have a hosted Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1installed.

You need to group a set of users for administrative delegation.

What should you create?

A. A new distribution group.B. A new management role.C. A managed folder mailbox policy.D. A new role assignment policy.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:When you change role assignments, the changes you make will probably be between role groups and roleassignment policies. By adding, removing, or modifying role assignments to or from these role assignees, youcan control what permissions are given to your administrators and users, in effect turning on and offmanagement of related features.

Regular role assignments enable the role assignee to access the management role entries made available bythe associated management role. If multiple management roles are assigned to a role assignee, themanagement role entries from each management role are aggregated and applied. This means that if a roleassignee is assigned the Transport Rules and Journaling roles, the roles are combined, and all the associatedmanagement role entries are given to the role assignee. If the role assignee is a role group or role assignmentpolicy, the permissions provided by the roles are then given to the users assigned to the role group or roleassignment policy.

The management role assignment policy is a special object in Exchange 2010. Users are associated with therole assignment policy when their mailboxes are created or if you change the role assignment policy on amailbox. This is also what you assign end-user management roles to. The combination of all the roles on a roleassignment policy defines everything that the user can manage on his or her mailbox or distribution groups.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd638100.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd335131.aspx

* RBAC enables you to align the roles you assign to users and administrators to the roles they hold within yourorganization.

Page 16: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

* A management role holds a group of management role entries, which define the specific tasks that themembers of a role group can perform.

* You can assign management roles to management role groups using management role assignments. Themanagement role entries associated with the management roles define the permissions granted to membersand delegates of the management role groups.

* You can add users or universal security groups to management role groups as members or delegates. Bothmembers and delegates are granted all the permissions associated with the management role entries, butdelegates can also manage the management group.

* A management role scope defines the objects to which the permissions granted through membership of amanagement role group can be applied.

QUESTION 18You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

You need to ensure that each user who sends a meeting request to a room mailbox receives a custommessage from the mailbox.

What should you do from the properties of the mailbox?

A. Configure the Mailbox Features settings.B. Configure the Mail Flow settings.C. Enable the Resource Booking Attendant.D. Configure the Resource Information settings.E. Configure the Resource In-Policy Requests settings.F. Configure the Resource Out-of-policy Requests settings.G. Configure the Account settings.H. Configure the Resource Policy settings.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Custom messages are configured in the Resource Information settings:

Page 17: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 19You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

You need to ensure that an equipment mailbox can be scheduled for meetings that occur during working hoursonly.

What should you do from the properties of the mailbox?

A. Configure the Mailbox Features settings.B. Configure the Resource Policy settings.C. Enable the Resource Booking Attendant.D. Configure the Resource In-Policy Requests settings.E. Configure the Mail Flow settings.F. Configure the Account settings.G. Configure the Resource Out-of-Policy Requests settings.H. Configure the Resource Information settings.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)

Page 18: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Configured on the Resource Policy settings:

QUESTION 20You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

The organization contains a distribution group named Group1.

You need to ensure that a user named User1 can review and approve all messages sent to Group1.

What should you do?

A. Modify the Managed By list for Group1.B. Create a new journal rule and specify user1 as the journal recipient.C. Modify the mail flow settings for User1.D. Modify the mail flow settings for Group1.

Page 19: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:For review and approval, Mail Flow settings then Message Moderation in the group properties:

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd297936.aspx

QUESTION 21You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization named contoso.com. All users have the @contoso.

Page 20: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

com email address suffix.

You discover that both anonymous and authenticated users can post content to a public folder named folder1by sending email messages to [email protected].

You need to prevent all users from posting content to folder1 by sending email.

What should you do?

A. From Outlook Web App (OWA), modify they properties of Folder1.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, modify the permissions of the default Receive connector.C. From the Public Folder Management Console, modify the properties of Folder1.D. From the Exchange Management Console, modify the properties of the Public Folder database.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 21: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 22You deploy an Exchange organization. All Servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1installed. The organization contains two Hub Transport servers.

The network contains two Active Directory sites named Site1 and Site2. Each site contains one Hub Transportserver. Each site has a direct connection to the Internet.

You need to configure message routing for the organization to meet the following requirements:

email messages to a SMTP domain named nwtrader.com must be delivered from Site2.

If Site2 is unavailable, email messages sent to nwtraders.com must be delivered from Site1.

email messages sent to all other SMTP domains must be delivered from Site1 only.

What should you do?

Page 22: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Create two Send connectors.

Assign one Hub Transport server as a source server to each Send connector.

Configure the connectors as Scoped Send connectors.

B. Create one Send connector.

Assign both Hub Transport servers as source servers.

Configure the connector as a Scoped Send connector.

C. Create one Send connector.

Assign both Hub Transport servers as source servers.

Configure the address spaces for the connector, and then configure the costs for the address

spaces.D. Create two Send connectors.

Assign one Hub Transport server as the source server to each Send connector.

Configure the address spaces for each connector.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:You already know from the question you need 2 Send connectors, this rules out 2 answers. There is no needfor a Scoped Send connector so this leaves only 1 answer.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa998662.aspx

So, what is a scoped send connector? When a send connector has the "scoped" option enabled, the connectorcan only be used by Hub servers in the same Active Directory site. If it is not selected, the connector can beused by all Hub servers in the environment. This option will only interest Exchange admins who manage large

Page 23: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Exchange deployments spanning multiple AD sites, having multiple internet breakout points.

It is an option Exchange Architects should be aware of when designing complex Exchange environments.

You can change the send connector scope by running the command

Set-SendConnector "name" IsScopedConnector $true/$false

QUESTION 23You have an Exchange organization named contoso.com. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server2010 SP1 installed. The organization contains a mail-enabled domain local group name Group1.

Users from outside the organization report that all email messages sent to [email protected] generate anon-delivery report (NDR).

You need to ensure that users from outside the organization can successfully send email [email protected].

What should you modify for Group1?

A. The advanced settings.B. The mail flow settings.C. The group scope.D. The group type.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:By default the Message Delivery Restrictions, under the Mailflow options, are set to require that all senders togroup mailboxes are authenticated locally by the server. This is not acceptable if the group will be acceptingmail from external domains, so the following checkbox should be un-ticked:

Page 24: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 24Your company has a main office and five branch offices. Each office is configured as a separate ActiveDirectory site.

You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization that contains one Hub Transport server in each site andan Edge Transport server in the main office site.

You add a disclaimer to all internal and external email messages sent by users in the company.

You discover that the email messages sent from one of the branch offices do not include the disclaimer.

You need to ensure that all email messages include the disclaimer.

What should you do?

A. Force Active Directory replication on the branch office domain controllers.B. Export all transport rules from the Hub Transport server in the main office. Import the transport rules in the

branch office Hub Transport server.C. Restart the Microsoft Exchange System Attendant.D. Modify the cache settings of the branch office Hub Transport servers.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)

Page 25: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Replication of transport rules across an organization depends on Active Directory replication. Replication timebetween Active Directory domain controllers varies depending on the number of sites in the organization, slowlinks, and other factors outside the control of Exchange. When you configure transport rules in yourorganization, make sure that you consider replication delays.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124703.aspx#TRR

QUESTION 25You have an Exchange Server 2003 organization. You install an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 Edge Transportserver on the network.

You need to ensure that the Edge Transport server can send and receive e-mail messages from the Internet forthe organization.

You configure the Exchange Server 2003 servers to send all e-mail for external recipients to the EdgeTransport servers.

What should you do on the Edge Transport servers?

A. Create and configure a Send connector.

Create and configure a Receive connector.

Create and configure an Accepted domain.

B. Create an Edge Subscription file.

Create and configure a Send connector.

Create and configure a Receive connector.

C. Create an Edge Subscription file.

Create and configure a Send connector.

Create and configure an Accepted domain.

D. Create and configure a Send connector.

Create and configure an Accepted domain.

Page 26: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Install the Exchange Server 2010 schema extensions.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124011.aspx

QUESTION 26You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.The network contains internal DNS servers.

You need to ensure that the Hub Transport servers use external DNS servers when they resolve Internetnames.

What should you modify?

A. The properties of the Hub Transport server object.B. The message delivery properties of the Hub Transport global settings.C. The properties of the default remote domain.D. The properties of a Send connector.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Configured on the Hub Transport server properties window, External DNS lookups tab:

Page 27: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123514.aspx

QUESTION 27You have an Exchange organization named Contoso, Ltd. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server2010 SP1 installed. The organization contains an Edge Transport Server.

Users from a company named Fabrikam, Inc., send email messages over the Internet by using [email protected] email address suffix.

Contoso acquires Fabrikam.

You need to ensure that messages sent from Fabrikam users to Contoso users have the contoso.com emailaddress suffix in their source address.

What should you create?

A. An Edge Transport rule.B. An email address policy.C. A Hub Transport rule.D. An address rewrite entry.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:

Page 28: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:You use address rewriting to present a consistent appearance to external recipients of messages from yourExchange 2010 organization. Address rewriting can be valuable to organizations that use third-party vendors toprovide email support and services. Customers and partners expect email messages to come from theorganization, not a third-party vendor. Similarly, after a merger or acquisition, an organization might want allemail messages to appear to come from the single new organization. The address rewriting feature freesorganizations to structure their businesses by business requirements instead of by technical requirements orlimitations.

You can also use address rewriting to enable appropriate routing of inbound messages from outside yourExchange 2010 organization to internal recipients. Address rewriting enables replies to messages that wererewritten to be correctly routed to the original sender of the rewritten message.

You configure Address Rewriting agents on the Receive connector and Send connector on a computer that hasthe Edge Transport server role installed.

EMS :

Enable-TransportAgent -Identity "Address Rewriting Inbound agent"

New-AddressRewriteEntry -name "[email protected] to [email protected]" - [email protected] -ExternalAddress [email protected]

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa996806http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123966.aspx

QUESTION 28You have an organization that contains Exchange Server 2007 and Exchange Server 2010 Hub Transportservers.

You create a moderated distribution group named Group1. You assign a user named User1 as the group'smoderator. User1 reports that some email messages are delivered to the members of Group1 without hisapproval.

You need to ensure that all email messages delivered to Group1 are approved by User1.

What should you do?

A. Recreate the group as a dynamic distribution group.B. Restart the MSExchangeTransport Service.C. Modify the expansion server for the group.D. Force a replication between all domain controllers.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 29: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Reference:

http://www.howexchangeworks.com/2009/12/message-moderation-is-not-working-in.html

QUESTION 29You have an Exchange organization named nwtraders.com. All servers in the organization have ExchangeServer 2010 SP1 installed.

Your company acquires another company named Contoso, Ltd. You plan to create new mailboxes for eachuser from Contoso.

You need to ensure that each new mailbox can receive email messages sent to contoso.com.

Which two objects should you create? (Choose two).

A. A Receive connector.B. A Remote domain.C. An organizational relationship.D. An accepted domain.E. An email address policy.

Correct Answer: DESection: (none)

Page 30: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:An accepted domain is any SMTP namespace for which a Microsoft Exchange organization sends or receivesemail. Accepted domains include those domains for which the Exchange organization is authoritative. AnExchange organization is authoritative when it handles mail delivery for recipients in the accepted domain.Accepted domains also include domains for which the Exchange organization receives mail and then relays it toan email server that's outside the Active Directory forest for delivery to the recipient.

You must configure an accepted domain before that SMTP address space can be used in an email addresspolicy. When you create an accepted domain, you can use a wildcard character (*) in the address space toindicate that all subdomains of the SMTP address space are also accepted by the Exchange organization. Forexample, to configure contoso.com and all its subdomains as accepted domains, enter *.contoso.com as theSMTP address space. The accepted domain entries are automatically available for use in an email addresspolicy.

If you delete an accepted domain that's used in an email address policy, the policy is no longer valid, andrecipients with email addresses in that SMTP domain will be unable to send or receive email.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124423

QUESTION 30You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 Mailbox server that contains multiple mailbox databases.

You need to ensure that you are notified when deleted mailboxes are purged from the server.

What should you do?

A. Attach a new task to the Application event log.B. Modify the properties of the mailbox database objects.C. Create a new Data Collector Set.D. Create a new Event Viewer Subscription.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://www.windowsecurity.com/articles/Attaching-Tasks-Event-Viewer-Logs-Events.html

QUESTION 31You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains 20 Mailbox servers.

You plan to create 10 mailbox databases on each Mailbox server. You need to create a naming convention forall mailbox databases.

What should you include in your naming convention?

A. For each mailbox database, provide a database name that is unique within the organization.B. For each mailbox database, provide a database name that is unique within the Mailbox server.C. For each mailbox database file, provide a file name that is unique within the organization.D. For each mailbox database file, provide a file name that is unique within the Mailbox server.

Page 31: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 32Your company has a main office and a branch office.

The branch office administrators are the only members of a custom management role group. The role group isconfigured to allow members to manage recipients.

You notice that the branch office administrators can manage recipients in both offices. You need to ensure thatthe branch office administrators can manage recipients in the branch office only.

What should you do?

A. Create and associate a management scope to the role group.B. Create and associate a management role assignment policy to the role group.C. Create a new linked role group, and then add the branch office administrators to the role group.D. Create a new role, and then add management role entries to the role.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 33You have an Exchange 2010 Mailbox server.

You need to ensure that deleted mailboxes are kept for 60 days.

What should you do?

A. Create a Retention Policy.B. Create a managed folder mailbox policy.C. Modify the properties of the mailbox database.D. Modify the properties of the mailbox server object.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 32: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 34Your company has an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

A user named User1 is configured as a Delegate for a user named User2.

You need to ensure that User1 can add User2 in the From field when sending email messages. Messages thatcontain User2 in the From field must display User2 as the message sender when recipients receive themessages.

What should you do?

A. Remove User1 as a delegate, then grant User1 Send As permissions to User2's mailbox.B. Remove User1 as a delegate, then grant User1 Send on Behalf permissions to User2's mailbox.C. Create a Sharing policy, then grant User1 Modify permissions to User2's mailbox.D. Create a Sharing policy, then grant User1 Full Mailbox permissions to User2's mailbox.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 33: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 35Your network contains an Exchange Server 2007 Mailbox server named Server1 and an Exchange Server2010 Mailbox server named Server2.

You need to move a mailbox from Server1 to Server2.

What should you do?

A. From Server1, run Movemailbox.B. From Server2, run Movemailbox.C. From Server1, run New-MoveRequest.D. From Server2, run New-MoveRequest.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 36You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to use Role Based Access Control (RBAC) to provide a user the ability to manage recipients in aspecific organizational unit (OU).

What should you do first?

A. Create a new direct role assignment.B. Create a new management role assignment policy.C. Create a new management scope.D. Modify the default management scope.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 37Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 server.

You need to prevent a user named User1 from downloading attachments larger than 50 KB when usingExchange ActiveSync.

Your solution must not affect other users.

What should you do first?

A. Create a new ActiveSync Device Access rule.B. Create a new Exchange ActiveSync Mailbox policy.C. Modify the properties of User1's mailbox.D. Modify the properties of the default Exchange ActiveSync Mailbox policy.

Page 34: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 38You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to create a resource record in DNS to support Autodiscover from the Internet.

What type of resource record should you create?

A. Host (A).B. Text (TXT).C. Pointer (PTR).D. Mail exchange (MX).

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 39You have an Exchange Server 2007 organization.

All users on your network run Microsoft Office Outlook 2007 to access their mailboxes. Outlook 2007 isconfigured to connect using RPC over HTTP and Autodiscover.

You perform a Typical installation of Exchange Server 2010 on a new server, and then move mailboxes to thenew server. Users now report that they cannot access their mailboxes.

You need to ensure that all users can access their mailboxes.

What should you do from the new server?

A. Run the Switchover Server wizard.B. Enable and configure Outlook Anywhere.C. Create and configure a Client Access array.D. Rename the OWA virtual directory to Exchange.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 40You have an existing Exchange 2010 environment. Users report that they can share free/busy information withusers at a federated partner, but they cannot share contacts with those users.

You need to ensure that your users can share contacts with users at the federated partner.

Page 35: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

What should you modify?

A. The federation trust.B. The EWS virtual directory.C. The default sharing policy.D. The organizational relationship.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Exam B

QUESTION 41You have an Exchange organization. All Servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

The organization contains five Hub Transport servers. All of the Hub Transport servers are listed as sourceservers for the Send connector to the Internet.

You need to prevent a Hub Transport Server named Hub1 from sending and receiving email messages fromthe Internet. The solution must meet the following requirements:

Ensure that Mailbox servers can deliver email messages to Hub1

Ensure that all other Hub Transport server can deliver email messages to the Internet.

What should you do first on Hub1?

A. Suspend all message queues.B. Disable all Receive connectors and Send connectors.C. Stop the Microsoft Exchange Mail Submission Service.D. Stop the Microsoft Exchange Transport Service.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:The first thing you do is suspend the queues on Hub1.Then, you modify the Internet Send connector and remove Hub1 as a source server. Finally, you modify thedefault Receive connector for Hub1 to disable Anonymous permissions.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124034.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb125022.aspx

QUESTION 42You have a hosted Exchange organization that contains 10,000 mailboxes. All servers in the organization haveExchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

Page 36: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You need to retrieve the following information for the organization:

The IP address of all client connections

The network latency for all MAPI connections

The version of Microsoft Outlook that is used to access all of the mailboxes.

What should you use?

A. The Microsoft Exchange Server User Monitor (ExMon).B. The Test-LogonStatistics cmdlet.C. The Test-MAPIConnectivity cmdlet.D. The Remote Connectivity Analyzer.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Use the Microsoft Exchange Server User Monitor to gather real-time data to better understand current clientusage patterns, and to plan for future work. Administrators can view several items, including IP addresses usedby clients, versions and modes of Microsoft Office Outlook, and resources such as CPU usage, server-sideprocessor latency, and total latency for network and processing. Works with Microsoft Exchange Server 2000,2003, 2007 and 2010.

Reference:

Page 37: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb508855.aspxhttp://www.microsoft.com/en-us/download/details.aspx?id=11461

QUESTION 43You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.All Servers run Windows Server 2008 R2.

The organization contains Mailbox servers, Client Access servers, and Hub Transport servers only.

You need to identify which user accounts are associated with the largest mailboxes in the organization.

What should you do?

A. Modify the Server Diagnostic Logging Properties.B. Run the Get-User cmdlet.C. Review the Application event log.D. Review the connectivity logs.E. Enable SMTP protocol logging.F. Modify the Log Settings from the properties of the Hub Transport Server.G. Run the Exchange Best Practices Analyzer.H. Run the Get-MailboxStatistics cmdlet.I. Get-MailboxFolderStatistics cmdlet.

Run theJ. Run the Get-Mailboxdatabase cmdlet.K. Run the Set-AdminAuditLogConfig cmdlet.L. Run the Set-EventLogLevel cmdlet.

Correct Answer: HSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Get-MailboxStatistics -database "mdb01" | ft DisplayName, TotalItemSize, ItemCount

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124612.aspx

QUESTION 44You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.All Servers run Windows Server 2008 R2.

The organization contains Mailbox servers, Client Access servers, and Hub Transport servers only.

You need to ensure that you can review any changes made by administrators to the Exchange configuration.The solution must identify which administrators performed each change.

What Should you do?

A. Run the Get-MailboxStatistics cmdlet.B. Enable SMTP protocol logging.C. Run the Exchange Server User Monitor (ExMon).D. Modify the Log Settings from the properties of the Hub Transport server.

Page 38: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

E. Run the Set-AdminAuditLogConfig cmdlet.F. Review the Application event log.G. Run the Get-MailboxFolderStatistics cmdlet.H. Modify the Server Diagnostic Logging Properties.I. Run the Set-EventLogLevel cmdlet.J. Run the Get-User cmdlet.K. Review the connectivity logs.L. Run the Exchange Best Practices Analyzer.

Correct Answer: ESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:To configure the cmdlet auditing list, you need to run Set-AdminAuditLogConfig - AdminAuditLogCmdletsfollowed by the cmdlet name to be audited.

For instance, to audit cmdlets that contain the keyword "mailbox" within the cmdlet name, run:

Set-AdminAuditLogConfig -AdminAuditLogCmdlets *mailbox*

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd335109.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd298169.aspxhttp://www.exchangeinbox.com/article.aspx?i=151

QUESTION 45You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

You need to identify why a remote SMTP server rejects email sent from the organization.What should you do?

A. Modify the diagnostic logging level on the MSEchangeTransportService object, and then review theApplication event log.

B. Modify the connectivity log settings on the Transport server, and then review the connectivity logs.C. Modify the message tracking settings on the Transport server, and then review the message tracking logs.D. Modify the protocol logging level on the Send connectors, and then review the protocol logs.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

How to Use Shell to Enable or Disable Protocol Logging on Receive Connector

In the below example, we have enabled protocol logging level for the Receive connector "Connection fromTechpeoples.net".

Set-ReceiveConnector -Connection from Techpeoples.net -ProtocolLoggingLevel Verbose

Page 39: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

How to Use Shell to Enable or Disable Protocol Logging on Send Connector

In the below example, we have enabled protocol logging level for the Send connector "Connection fromTechpeoples.net".

Set-SendConnector -Connection from Techpeoples.net -ProtocolLoggingLevel Verbose

Protocol logging records the SMTP conversations that occur between email servers as part of messagedelivery. These SMTP conversations occur on Send connectors and Receive connectors configured on serversrunning Microsoft Exchange Server 2010 that have the Hub Transport server role or the Edge Transport serverrole installed. You can use protocol logging to diagnose mail flow problems.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124531.aspx

QUESTION 46Your network contains two Exchange Server 2010 SP1 mailbox servers.

You create a database availability group (DAG).

You need to install all of the Failover Clustering components on the Mailbox servers.

What should you do?

A. Add both servers to the DAG.

Page 40: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

B. Install the Application server role on both servers.C. Run Setup /roles:Mailbox /NewCMS on both servers.D. Run the Start-ClusterMailboxServer cmdlet on both servers.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd298065.aspx

QUESTION 47You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

The organization contains a database availability group (DAG) named DAG1. DAG1 contains two Mailboxservers named Server1 and Server2. Five databases are replicated in DAG1.

You need to install Exchange rollup updates on Server1. The solution must not prevent users from accessingtheir mailboxes.

What should you do first?

A. Run the Set-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup cmdlet, and then enable Datacenter Activation co-ordination forDAG1.

B. Run the Set-MailboxDatabase cmdlet, and then configure all mailbox database copies as lagged copies.C. Run the Suspend-MailboxDatabaseCopy cmdlet, and then switch over all mailbox databases to Server2.D. Run the UpdatemailboxDatabaseCopy cmdlet, and then modify the mailbox database Activiation

preference.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:In situations where you have a planned outage/maintenance window or if you perhaps need to seed adatabase, the first step is to suspend replication for the involved database(s). This can be done both via theExchange Management Console (EMC) and the Exchange Management Shell (EMS). To do so via the EMC,you simply right-click on the respective database copy/copies and select suspend in the context menu.To do the same via the EMS, you can use the following command:

Suspend-MailboxDatabaseCopy Identity MDB02\E14EX02

However, I don't like this answer as in the technet article they list several powershell scripts:StartDagServerMaintenance.ps1, StopDagServerMaintenance.ps1, and RedistributeActiveDatabases.ps1. Ofcourse, the first thing the StartDagServerMaintenance.ps1 script does is run Suspend- MailboxDatabaseCopy.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd298065.aspxhttp://www.msexchange.org/articles_tutorials/exchange-server-2010/high-availability-recovery/uncovering-exchange-2010-database-availability-groups-dags-part4.html

QUESTION 48You have an Exchange organization. All Servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

Page 41: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You need to ensure that you can restore a mailbox that was deleted from a mailbox database if the mailboxwas deleted up to six months earlier. The solution must not require a database backup.

What should you do?

A. Create a managed custom folder and managed content settings.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the New-MailboxExportRequest cmdlet.C. From the Exchange Management Shell, run Set-MailboxDatabase -DumpsterStatistics $true.D. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Export-Mailbox cmdlet.E. Create a retention policy and a retention tag.F. From the properties of the mailbox database, modify the Deletion Settings.G. From the properties of the mailbox database, select the This database can be overwritten by a restore

check box.H. From the properties of the mailbox database, modify the maintenance schedule.I. From the properties of the mailbox, enable litigation hold.J. From the properties of the mailbox, enable retention hold.K. From the Exchange Managent Shell, run the New-MailboxSearch cmdlet.L. From the properties of a Mailbox server, modify the System Settings.M. From the Exchange Managent Shell, enable single item recovery.

Correct Answer: FSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Deletion settings are easiest set on the Limits tab for mailbox databases.

As, by default, user mailboxes have the global limits set (unless specifically and individually set otherwise), thiswill take care of just about everyone in the organisation:

Reference:

Page 42: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd297937.aspx

QUESTION 49You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

You need to ensure that an administrator can recover hard-deleted email messages from a user's mailbox untilthe deleted item retention period has elapsed. All expired email messages must be deleted when the retentionperiod has elapsed.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run Set-MailboxDatabase -DumpsterStatisics $true.B. From the properties of the mailbox database, select the This database can be overwritten by a restore

check box.C. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the New-MailboxSearch cmdlet.D. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the New-MailboxExportRequest cmdlet.E. From the properties of the mailbox database, modify the Deletion Settings.F. From the Exchange Management Shell, enable single item recovery.G. Create a managed custom folder and managed content setting.H. From the properties of a Mailbox server, modify the System Settings.I. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Export-Mailbox cmdlet.J. From the properties of the mailbox, enable retention hold.K. Create a retention policy and a retention tag.L. From the properties of the mailbox, enable litigation hold.M. From the properties of the mailbox database, modify the maintenance schedule.

Correct Answer: FSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:This is not litigation hold as the expired messages must be deleted when the retention period has elapsed.Litigation hold would keep them indefinitely.Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ee364755.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ee633460.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ff660637.aspx

QUESTION 50You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

The organization contains two Mailbox servers named Server1 and Server2 . Each Mailbox server has onemailbox database and one public folder database.

You discover that all users create public folders on Server1 only.

You need to ensure that all users create public folders on Server2 only.

What should you do?

A. Move all mailboxes to server2.B. Modify the properties of both mailbox databases.C. Remove all public folder replicas from Server1.

Page 43: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

D. Modify the properties of both public folder databases.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Public folder referrals have an associated cost number. The numbers range from 1 through 100. This costnumber is used to optimize message flow. Specifically, email messages are routed according to lowest costnumber. If two or more routes are available with the same cost, the load is distributed as equally as possiblebetween them. This cost is also used to calculate the most appropriate route that the client application (such asMicrosoft Outlook) can use to access public folders on remote servers.

You can also change the default public folder database. This will point the users to the appropriate public folderdatabase.

Setting a referral cost and default public folder database are both done through the properties of the mailboxdatabase.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb629522.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb629643

Page 44: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 51You install two Exchange 2010 SP1 Edge Transport servers named Edge1 and Edge2.

You need to ensure that e-mail is sent to Edge2 only if Edge1 fails.

What should you do?

A. Create two CNAME records that have the same name. Create one MX record that uses the FQDN of theCNAME records. Assign a priority of 0 to the MX record.

B. Create two MX records. Assign the MX record for Edge1 a priority of 5. Assign the MX record for Edge2 apriotity of 1.

C. Create two A records that use the same name. Create one MX record that uses the FQDN of tha A record.Assign a priority of 0 to the MX record.

D. Create two MX records. Assign the MX record for Edge1 a priority of 1. Assign the MX record for Edge2 apriority of 5.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:The mail exchanger (MX) resource record shows the DNS domain name for the computer or computers thatprocess mail for a domain. If multiple mail exchanger (MX) resource records exist, the DNS Client serviceattempts to contact mail servers in the order of preference from lowest value (highest priority) to highest value(lowest priority).

Page 45: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 52Your network contains an Exchange Server SP1 Edge Transport server named Server1. You install a newExchange Server 2010 SP1 Edge Transport server named Server2.

You need to copy all the Edge Transport configurations from Server1 to Server2.

Which two actions should you perform on Server1? (Choose two).

A. Run the ExportEdgeConfig.PS1 script.B. Run the New-EdgeSyncServiceConfig cmdlet.C. Backup the system state.D. Run the Export-TransportRuleCollection cmdlet.E. Run the Export-ExchangeCertificate cmdlet.

Correct Answer: ADSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:ExportEdgeConfig.PS1You can use the provided Shell scripts to duplicate the configuration of a computer that has the MicrosoftExchange Server 2010 Edge Transport server role installed. This process is referred to as cloned configuration.Cloned configuration is the practice of deploying new Edge Transport servers based on the configurationinformation from a previously configured source server. The configuration information from the previouslyconfigured source server is copied and exported to an XML file, which is then imported to the target server.

Edge Transport server configuration information is stored in Active Directory Lightweight Directory Services (ADLDS) and isn't replicated among multiple Edge Transport servers. By using cloned configuration, you can makesure that every Edge Transport server that's deployed in the perimeter network is operating by using the sameconfiguration.Export-TransportRuleCollectionUse the Export-TransportRuleCollection cmdlet to export a transport rule collection used by the TransportRules agent on a computer running Microsoft Exchange Server 2010 that has the Hub Transport server role orthe Edge Transport server role installed.

References:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd351127.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124410.aspx

QUESTION 53You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

The organization contains a database availability group (DAG) named DAG1. DAG1 contains three Mailboxservers including a server named Server1.

Server1 fails. You restore Server1.

You need to ensure that Server1 can replicate mailbox databases from DAG1.

What should you do first?

A. Remove the Default Mailbox database from Server1.B. Modify the GUID for Server1.C. Remove the object for Server1 from DAG1.D. Disable log truncation for the mailbox databases in DAG1.

Page 46: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Remove-DatabaseAvailabilityGroupServer -Identity DAG1 -MailboxServer MBX1 -ConfigurationOnly

High level steps to recover Server1:

1) Remove the failed server's configuration from the DAG by using the Remove-DatabaseAvailabilityGroupServer cmdlet. Because the DAG member being removed was offline and could notbe brought online, you must add the ConfigurationOnly parameter to the above command.

2) Reset the server's computer account in Active Directory.

Setup /3) Open a Command Prompt window. Using the original Setup media, run the following command:m:RecoverServer

4) When the Setup recovery process is complete, add the recovered server to the DAG by using the Add-DatabaseAvailabilityGroupServer cmdlet.

5) After the server has been added back to the DAG, you can reconfigure mailbox database copies by using theAdd-MailboxDatabaseCopy cmdlet.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd638206.aspx

QUESTION 54You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization. The organization contains two mailbox-enabled usersnamed User1 and User2You need to ensure that User1 can send email messages on behalf of User2

Which cmdlet should you use?

A. Set-MailUser.B. Set-MailboxFolderPermissions.C. New-TransportRule.D. Set-Mailbox.E. New-MailContact.F. New-ManagementScope.G. New-ManagementRoleAssignment.H. Set-Group.I. Set-ManagementRoleAssignment.J. Add-ADPermission.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-Mailbox. e.g.- Set-Mailbox user2 -GrantSendOnBehalfTo user1

Page 47: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

J: Send-As is incorrect (Add-ADPermission UserMailbox -ExtendedRights Send-As -user UserWhoSends)

Send on Behalf and Send AsSend on Behalf and Send As are similar in fashion. Send on Behalf will allow a user to send as another userwhile showing the recipient that it was sent from a specific user on behalf of another user. What this means, isthat the recipient is cognitive of who actually initiated the sending message, regardless of who it was sent onbehalf of. This may not be what you are looking to accomplish. In many cases, you may want to send asanother person and you do not want the recipient to be cognitive about who initiated the message. Of course, apossible downside to this, is that if the recipient replies, it may go to a user who did not initiate the sentmessage and might be confused depending on the circumstances. Send As can be useful in a scenario whereyou are sending as a mail-enabled distribution group. If someone replies, it will go to that distribution groupwhich ultimately gets sent to every user who is a part of that distribution group. This article will explains how touse both methods.

Reference:http://www.shudnow.net/2007/08/12/send-on-behalf-and-send-as/

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123981.aspx

QUESTION 55You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization. The organization contains two mailbox-enable usersnamed User1 and User2.

You need to ensure that User1 can send email messages as User2.

Which cmdlet should you use?

A. Add-ADPermission.B. Set-Group.C. Set-MailboxFolderPermissions.D. Set-Mailbox.E. New-ManagementRoleAssignment.F. New-ManagementScope.G. New-TransportRule.H. New-MailContact.I. Set-MailUser.J. Set-ManagementRoleAssignment.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Add-ADPermission e.g. Add-ADPermission user2 -User "Domain\User1" -Extendedrights "Send As"

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124403.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb676368.aspx

QUESTION 56Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization named contoso.com. The organizationcontains a Client Access server named Server1 and a domain controller named DC1.

Page 48: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

All client computers run Windows 7 Professional. All users access their calendar and download their emailmessages by using Windows Mail.

You need to modify the TCP port on the Exchange server used by the Windows Mail clients.

What should you do?

A. Run the Set-PopSettings cmdlet.B. Run the Set-OfflineAddressBook cmdlet.C. Modify the properties of the Exchange ActiveSync virtual directory.D. Modify the Redirect.aspx file.E. Modify the properties of the Client Access server object.F. Run the New-OwaMailboxPolicy cmdlet.G. Modify the properties of the offline address book (OAB) virtual directory.H. Run the New-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicy cmdlet.I. Modify the Casredirect.aspx file.J. Modify the properties of the OWA virtual directory.K. Run the Set-ImapSettings cmdlet.L. Run the Export-ExchangeCertificate cmdlet.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa996347.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb676455.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123530.aspx

QUESTION 57Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization named contoso.com. The organizationcontains a Client Access server named Server1 and a domain controller named DC1.

You need to modify the external host name for Outlook Anywhere.

What should you do?

A. Run the Set-OfflineAddressBook cmdlet.B. Run the Export-ExchangeCertificate cmdlet.C. Modify the Redirect.aspx file.D. Modify the Casredirect.aspx file.E. Modify the properties of the Client Access server object.F. Modify the properties of the offline address book (OAB) virtual directory.G. Run the Set-ImapSettings cmdlet.H. Modify the properties of the Exchange ActiveSync virtual directory.I. Run the Set-PopSettings cmdlet.J. Modify the properties of the OWA virtual directory.K. Run the New-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicy cmdlet.L. Run the New-OwaMailboxPolicy cmdlet.

Correct Answer: E

Page 49: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Section: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa996902.aspx

QUESTION 58Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization named contoso.com. The organizationcontains a Client Access server named Server1 and a domain controller named DC1.

You need to ensure that all Outlook Anywhere SSL sessions can be terminated by the firewall. The solutionmust ensure that Server1 will accept non-SSL sessions from the firewall.

What should you do?

A. Run the Export-ExchangeCertificate cmdlet.B. Modify the properties of the Client Access server object.C. Run the New-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicy cmdlet.D. Modify the Casredirect.aspx file.E. Modify the Redirect.aspx file.

Page 50: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

F. Modify the properties of the offline address book (OAB) virtual directory.G. Modify the properties of the Exchange ActiveSync virtual directory.H. Run the Set-OfflineAddressBook cmdlet.I. Run the New-OwaMailboxPolicy cmdlet.J. Run the Set-PopSettings cmdlet.K. Run the Set-ImapSettings cmdlet.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123542.aspx

QUESTION 59Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization named contoso.com. The organizationcontains a Client Access server named Server1 and a domain controller named DC1.

You need to ensure that users who have a Windows Phone 7 device can connect to the Exchange organizationby using the mail.contoso.com host name. The solution must ensure that all of the Windows Phone 7 devicescan use the Autodiscover service.

What should you do?

Page 51: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Modify the Casredirect.aspx file.B. Run the Export-ExchangeCertificate cmdlet.C. Modify the properties of the Client Access server object.D. Run the Set-OfflineAddressBook cmdlet.E. Modify the properties of the Exchange ActiveSync virtual directory.F. Modify the properties of the offline address book (OAB) virtual directory.G. Run the Set-PopSettings cmdlet.H. Modify the properties of the OWA virtual directory.I. Run the New-OwaMailboxPolicy cmdlet.J. Run the Set-ImapSettings cmdlet.K. Modify the Redirect.aspx file.

Correct Answer: ESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Under the Server Configuration -> Client Access -> Exchange ActiveSync node you can change the MicrosoftServer ActiveSync (Default Web Site) Properties. In here you can modify both the Internal and ExternalExchange ActiveSync URLs:

QUESTION 60Your network contains an Active Directory domain named contoso.com.

The network contains a server named server1 that runs Exchange Server 2010 SP1.

The Exchange organization contains 500 mailboxes. All of the mailboxes are stored on a mailbox databasenamed DB1.

You need to provide a user named User1 with the ability to open the mailbox of another user named User2.User1 must only be able to open the mailbox of User2.

Page 52: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Which PowerShell cmdlet should you use?

A. New-RoleAssignmentPolicy.B. Set-Mailbox.C. Add-MailboxPermission.D. New-ManagementRole.E. New-ManagementRoleEntry.F. New-ManagementRoleAssignment.G. New-RoleGroup.H. Add-ADPermission.I. Set-DestributionGroup.J. New-MailboxAuditSearchLog.K. New-ManagementScope.L. New-EmailAddressPolicy.M. Add-ManagementRoleEntry.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Add-MailboxPermission "User2" -User "User1" -AccessRights FullAccess

QUESTION 61Your network contains an Active Directory domain named contoso.com.

The network contains a server named Server1 that runs Exchange Server 2010 SP1.

The Exchange organization contains 500 mailboxes. All of the mailboxes are stored on a mailbox databasenamed DB1.

You need to prevent a user named User1 from permanently deleting email messages from his mailbox.

Which PowerShell cmdlet should you use?

A. New-MailboxAuditSearchLog.B. New-ManagementRoleAssignment.C. New-ManagementRole.D. New-RoleAssignmentPolicy.E. New-RoleGroup.F. New-ManagementRoleEntry.G. New-ManagementScope.H. Add-ManagementRoleEntry.I. New-EmailAddressPolicy.J. Add-ADPermission.K. Set-Mailbox.L. Set-DestributionGroup.M. Add-MailboxPermission.

Correct Answer: KSection: (none)

Page 53: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-Mailbox User1 -LitigationHoldEnabled $true

QUESTION 62Your network contains an Active Directory domain named contoso.com.

The network contains a server named Server1 that runs Exchange Server 2010 SP1.

The Exchange organization contains 500 mailboxes. All of the mailboxes are stored on a mailbox databasenamed DB1.

You need to provide an administrator named Admin1 with the ability to search for mailbox content in multiplemailboxes.

Which Windows PowerShell cmdlet should you use?

A. New-EmailAddressPolicy.B. Set-Mailbox.C. Add-ManagementRoleEntry.D. New-ManagementScope.E. New-ManagementRoleEntry.F. Add-ADPermission.G. New-ManagementRole.H. Add-RoleGroupMember.I. Add-MailboxPermission.J. New-RoleGroup.K. New-ManagementRoleAssignment.L. New-MailboxAuditSearchLog.M. New-RoleAssignmentPolicy.

Correct Answer: KSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://www.1ask2.com/Exchange2010/RBAC2/RBAC3.html

QUESTION 63Your network contains an Active Directory domain named contoso.com.

The network contains a server named Server1 that runs Exchange Server 2010 SP1.

The Exchange organization contains 500 mailboxes. All of the mailboxes are stored on a mailbox databasenamed DB1.

You need to add an administrator named Admin1 to the Recipient Management role group. Admin1 must onlybe able to manage Exchange recipients in an organizational unit name OU1.

Which PowerShell cmdlet should you use first?

Page 54: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Set-DestributionGroup.B. New-ManagementScope.C. New-ManagementRole.D. Add-MailboxPermission.E. New-RoleGroup.F. New-EmailAddressPolicy.G. New-RoleAssignmentPolicy.H. New-MailboxAuditSearchLog.I. Add-ADPermission.J. Add-ManagementRoleEntry.K. New-ManagementRoleEntry.L. Set-Mailbox.M. New-ManagementRoleAssignment.

Correct Answer: ESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:To add a mailbox to the Recipient Management role group, you actually have to start off with:

Add-RoleGroupMember "Recipient Management" -Member Admin1

However, as mentioned in the question, this needs to be scoped to a single OU, and you wouldn't want toscope the default Receipient Management role group to one OU as it would affect all other mailboxes in thatgroup.

So, you would have to create a new role group that is scoped to a single OU and has all the same roles that areassigned to the Recipient Management role group, then put in Admin1 as the only Role Group Member.

You can accomplish this as follows:

New-RoleGroup -Name "Admin Recipient Management" -Roles "Distribution Groups", "Mail Enabled PublicFolders", "Mail Recipient Creation", "Mail Recipients", "Message Tracking", "Migration", "Move Mailboxes","Recipient Policies" -Members Admin1 -RecipientOrganizationalUnitScope OU1

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd638209.aspx (Use the Shell to create a role group with an OUscope)http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd638181.aspx (EXAMPLE 2)

QUESTION 64You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

You need to prevent users on the network from enabling text message notifications to their Windows mobiledevices.

What should you configure?

A. A Group Policy administrative template.B. An RMS template.C. An Outlook Web App mailbox policy.D. An Exchange ActiveSync mailbox policy.

Page 55: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:For text message notifications (letting you know when important mails have been received from certain usersetc)., you should set an OWA mailbox policy.

Reference showing the client side (what users see in OWA):

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ee633486.aspx

You can also use EMS to disable text messages completely (not just text message notifications) using theExchange ActiveSync Mailbox Policy, but this is not what they are asking for here:

Set-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicy -Identity:default -AllowTextMessaging:$false

This is where you turn text message notifications off in EMC:

QUESTION 65You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

Page 56: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

The network contains two Active Directory sites named Site1 and Site2. Each site contains two Client Accessservers. All mailbox databases in the organization are replicated to mailbox servers in both sites.

All users connect to their mailbox by using Microsoft Office Outlook 2003.

You create a Client Access server array named array1.contoso.com in Site1, and then configure all users toconnecto to array1.contoso.com.

You verify that all users can connect successfully to array1.contoso.com.Once month later, all of the servers in Site1 fail.

You need to ensure that all users can connect to a Client Access server in Site2 by using array1.contoso.com.

What should you do?

A. Modify the host (A) record for array1.contoso.com to point to the IP address of a Client Access server inSite2.

B. Create a Client Access server array named array2.contoso.com in site2. Rename array2.contoso.com asarray1.contoso.com.

C. Modify the host (A) record for autodiscover.contoso.com to point to the IP address of a Client Acess serverin Site2.

D. Create a Client Access server array named array2.contoso.com in site1. Remove all of the Client Accessserver from array1.contoso.com.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 66You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization.

You need to allow all the members of a group named Sales to add members to distribution groups.

Which cmdlet should you use?

A. Set-Mailbox.B. New-ManagementScope.C. New-MailContact.D. New-TransportRule.E. Add-ADPermission.F. New-ManagementRoleAssignment.G. Set-ManagementRoleAssignment.H. Set-MailUser.I. Set-MailboxFolderPermissions.J. Set-Group.

Correct Answer: FSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:

Page 57: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:New-ManagementRoleAssignment -Name "Distribution Groups -Managedby "Sales" -SecurityGroup "Sales" -Role "Distribution Groups"

QUESTION 67You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization.

All users have Microsoft Outlook 2010 installed on their client computer.

You need to ensure that the users are warned of a new corporate communication policy before they send emailmessages to users in the legal department.Which cmdlet should you use?

A. Set-MailUser.B. New-ManagementScope.C. New-ManagementRoleAssignment.D. Set-ManagementRoleAssignment.E. New-MailContact.F. New-TransportRule.G. Set-Mailbox.H. Set-MailboxFolderPermissions.I. Add-ADPermission.J. Set-Group.

Correct Answer: GSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:This is a MailTip. e.g. Set-Mailbox -Identity legal1 -MailTip "new corporate communication policy"

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd297974.aspx

QUESTION 68You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization.

You need to ensure that a user named user1 can manage the properties of all the public folders in theorganization.

What cmdlet should you use?

A. New-ManagementScope.B. Set-Mailbox.C. Set-ManagementRoleAssignment.D. New-MailContact.E. Set-MailUser.F. Set-Group.G. Set-MailboxFolderPermissions.H. New-TransportRule.I. New-ManagementRoleAssignment.J. Add-ADPermissions.

Page 58: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: ISection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:New-ManagementRoleAssignment -Name "Public Folder Management for User1" -Role "Public FolderManagement" -User User1

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd335193http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd876947.aspx

QUESTION 69Your company has offices in New York and Montreal. Each Office is configured as an Active Directory site.

You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization. The organization contains five servers. The servers areconfigured as shown in the following table:

Each Mailbox server contains two mailbox databases. All users have a mailbox on their local Mailbox server.

Server3 contains a public folder database.

You create a new public folder database on server4.

You need to ensure that all new public folders created by users are created on server4.

What should you modify?

A. The mailbox database.B. An Attachment Filter agent.C. The Autodiscover DNS record.D. The email address policy.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 59: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 70You have an Exchange Server 2003 organization. All servers in the organization run Exchange 2003 SP1.

Corporate security policy states that the Exchange servers cannot be managed by using Remote Desktopsessions.

You plan to deploy Exchange Server 2010 SP1 server to the network.

You have a member server named Server5 that runs Windows Server 2008 SP2.

You need to install the Exchange Management Console (EMC) on Server5.

What should you do on Server5?

A. Run setup /mode:upgrade.B. Modify the Internet Information (IIS) authentication settings.C. Run setup /nprs:server5.D. Suppress link state updates.E. Run setup /rps:server5.F. Add a mail exchange (MX) record to the internal DNS zone.G. Modify the smart host settings.H. Install Exchange Server 2003 SP2.I. Install Windows Server 2008 R2.

Page 60: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

J. Install Windows 7.K. Add a mail exchanger (MX) record to the public DNS zone.L. Run setup /r:mt.

Correct Answer: LSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Setup / (r=roles): (mt or t=Management tools) Setup /r:mt

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb232090.aspx

QUESTION 71You have an Exchange Server 2010 server.

You need to prevent users from accessing public folders using Outlook Web Access (OWA). Your solutionmust not prevent users from accessing public folders using Microsoft Office Outlook.

Which two actions should you perform? (Each correct answer presents a complete solution. Choose two).

A. Create an OWA mailbox policy.B. Create a managed folder mailbox policy.C. Modify the properties of the OWA virtual directory.D. Modify the properties of the public folder database.

Correct Answer: ACSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 72You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to prevent users from changing their password using Outlook Web Access (OWA).

What should you do?

A. Create a Group Policy Object.B. Create an OWA mailbox policy.C. Modify the authentication settings of the OWA virtual directory.D. Modify the authentication settings of the IISADMPWD virtual directory.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 73

Page 61: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains a Hub Transport server and an Edge Transportserver. The Edge Transport server sends all SMTP mail to the Internet.

You need to add a disclaimer to all internal and external email messages sent by users of your company.

What should you do?

A. From the Hub Transport server, create a transport rule.B. From the Edge Transport server, create a transport rule.C. From the Hub Transport server, modify the properties of a Send connector.D. From the Edge Transport server, modify the properties of a Send connector.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 74You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. You acquire a new Internet domain name.

Users report that they cannot receive email sent to the new domain name. You verify that all users have thenew domain name configured as an email address suffix.

You need to ensure that users can receive email sent from the Internet to the new domain name.

What should you create?

A. An Authoritative Accepted Domain.B. An External Relay Accepted Domain.C. A new Receive connector.D. A remote domain.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 75You have a Hub Transport server named Server1 that runs Exchange Server 2010. All Exchange users useIMAP4 to retrieve email.

You need to ensure that all users can send email using SMTP. Your solution must not require any modificationsto the default connectors.

What should you do?

A. Configure IMAP4 clients to send email using TCP port 25.B. Configure IMAP4 clients to send email using TCP port 587.C. Create a new Send connector and configure the connector to use port 110.D. Create a new Send connector and configure the connector to use port 143

Correct Answer: B

Page 62: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Section: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:By default, an HT server already has a suitable connector set up and waiting for you to authenticate and submitmail; the "Client HTServerName" connector. When looking at its properties you will immediately notice the portwhich the connector listens on is port 587. Yes, this is an SMTP connector, but instead of using port 25, thestandard for server to server SMTP, port 587 is used because this is the standard for SMTP mail received fromclient software.

QUESTION 76Your company has a main office and 20 branch offices. Each office contains an Exchange Server 2010 Mailboxserver and an Exchange Server 2010 Hub Transport server.

Each office is configured as a separate Active Directory site. Each branch office site has one IP site link thatconnects to the main office site.

You need to ensure that email sent between offices is routed through the Hub Transport servers in the mainoffice.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, modify the Exchange specific site link costs.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, configure the main office site as a hub site.

Page 63: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. From Active Directory Sites and Services, modify the site link costs.D. From Active Directory Sites and Services, remove all IP site links and then create new SMTP site links.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-AdSite "Site A" -HubSiteEnabled $true

QUESTION 77You have an Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox server. The server contains one mailbox database. You need toview the last logon time of all users in the organization.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run Get-MailboxDatabase.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run Get-MailboxStatistics.C. From the Exchange Management Console, run the Remote Connectivity Analyzer.D. From the Exchange Management Console, create and export a filter.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 78You have an Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox server.

You need to identify which users have the largest mailboxes on the server.

What should you do?

A. Run the Get-MailBoxStatistics cmdlet.B. Run the Get-StoreUsageStatistics cmdlet.C. Add the MSExchangeIS Client performance counters to the Performance Monitor.D. Add the MSExchangeIS Mailbox performance counters to the Performance Monitor.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 79You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains one Mailbox server. All users connect toExchange using Microsoft Office Outlook 2010.

You need to identify the latency of client connections to the Mailbox server.

What should you run?

Page 64: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Exchange Best Practices Analyzer.B. Message Tracking Performance tool.C. Test-OutlookConnectivity cmdlet.D. Test-OutlookWebServices cmdlet.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 80You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to identify the following information for a user's mailbox:The size of items in the Inbox folder

The number of items in the Deleted Items folder

You must achieve this goal using the minimum amount of administrative effort.

Which cmdlet should you run?

A. Get-MailboxFolder.B. Get-MailboxFolderStatistics.C. Get-MailboxStatistics.D. Get-StoreUsageStatistics.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Exam C

QUESTION 81Your company has one office in New York. The office is configured as an Active Directory site.

All domain controllers in the forest run Windows server 2003 SP2. All client computers run Windows XP SP2.

You have an Exchange Server 2003 organization. All servers in the organization run Exchange Server 2003SP1.

You plan to deploy Exchange Server 2010 SP1 servers to the network.

You need to ensure that you can install the first Exchange Server 2010 SP1 server.

What should you do first?

A. Install Windows Server 2008 R2.B. Install Windows 7.C. Add a mail exchanger (MX) record to the public DNS zone.

Page 65: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

D. Run setup /nprs:server5.E. Run setup /mode:upgrade.F. Run setup /r:mt.G. Suppress link state updates.H. Modify the smart host settings.I. Modify the Internet Information (IIS) authentication settings.J. Add a mail exchange (MX) record to the internal DNS zone.K. Install Exchange Server 2003 SP2.L. Run setup /rps:server5.

Correct Answer: KSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:All Exchange Server 2003 servers need to be SP2.

QUESTION 82Your company has one office in New York. The office is configured as an Active Directory site.

All domain controllers in the forest run Windows server 2003 SP2. All client computers run Windows XP SP2.

You have an Exchange Server 2003 organization. All servers in the organization run Exchange Server 2003SP1.

Corporate security policy states that the Exchange servers cannot be managed by using Remote Desktopsessions.

You plan to deploy Exchange Server 2010 SP1 server to the network.

You need to ensure that you can run the Exchange Server 2010 SP1 management tools from a clientcomputer.

What should you do on the client computer?

A. Modify the Internet Information (IIS) authentication settings.B. Suppress link state updates.C. Install Windows 7.D. Run setup /nprs:server5.E. Install Exchange Server 2003 SP2.F. Add a mail exchange (MX) record to the internal DNS zone.G. Run setup /r:mt.H. Install Windows Server 2008 R2.I. Modify the smart host settings.J. Run setup /rps:server5.K. Run setup /mode:upgrade.L. Add a mail exchanger (MX) record to the public DNS zone.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:

Page 66: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Client needs to be running Windows 7 (x64) or Vista SP2 (x64)

QUESTION 83Your company has one office in New York. The office is configured as an Active Directory site.

All domain controllers in the forest run Windows server 2003 SP2. All client computers run Windows XP SP2.

You have an Exchange Server 2003 organization. All servers in the organization run Exchange Server 2003SP1.

Corporate security policy states that the Exchange servers cannot be managed by using Remote Desktopsessions.

You plan to deploy Exchange Server 2010 SP1 server to the network.

You have a server that runs Windows Server 2008 SP2.

You install the Edge Transport server role on the server.

You need to ensure that all email messages sent to the Internet from the Exchange Server 2003 organizationare relayed through the Edge Transport server.

What should you do?

A. Suppress link state updates.B. Install Exchange Server 2003 SP2.C. Add a mail exchange (MX) record to the internal DNS zone.D. Modify the smart host settings.E. Install Windows Server 2008 R2.F. Add a mail exchanger (MX) record to the public DNS zone.G. Run setup /r:mt.H. Run setup /rps:server5.I. Modify the Internet Information (IIS) authentication settings.J. Install Windows 7.K. Run setup /nprs:server5.L. Run setup /mode:upgrade.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Modify the smarthost settings of the Exchange 2003 organization to ensure mail goes via the Edge server. Youwould need to first make sure the Edge transport server can send to the Internet but that is not an option.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124011.aspx

QUESTION 84You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization. The organization contains five servers. The servers areconfigured as shown in the following table:

Page 67: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

All users access their mailbox using Microsoft Outlook 2010. Users report that they cannot download theiroffline address book (OAB). You verify that the users can successfully connect to their mailbox.

You need to identify what is preventing users from downloading the OAB.

Which cmdlet should you run?

A. Test-MapiConnectivity.B. Test-MailFlow.C. Test-SmtpConnectivity.D. Test-ServiceHealth.E. Get-MailboxStatistics.F. Test-OutlookWebServices.G. Get-MailboxFolderStatistics.H. Get-MailboxDatabase.I. Test-MRSHealth.J. Get-Transport.K. Get-Message.

Correct Answer: FSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Test-OutlookWebServices -identity "bobk"

RunspaceId : 5aa084db-b846-4280-9822-b69e1d474e07Id : 1019Type : InformationMessage : A valid Autodiscover service connection point was found. The Autodiscover URL on this object ishttps://SLC-DC01.contoso.com/Autodiscover/Autodiscover.xml.

RunspaceId : 5aa084db-b846-4280-9822-b69e1d474e07Id : 1006Type : InformationMessage : Contacted the Autodiscover service at https://SLC-DC01.contoso.com/Autodiscover/Autodiscover.xml.

RunspaceId : 5aa084db-b846-4280-9822-b69e1d474e07Id : 1016Type : InformationMessage : [EXCH] The AS service is configured for this user in the Autodiscover response received fromhttps://SLC-DC01.contoso.com/Autodiscover/Autodiscover.xml.

RunspaceId : 5aa084db-b846-4280-9822-b69e1d474e07

Page 68: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Id : 1015Type : InformationOAB service is configured for this user in the Autodiscover response received Message : [EXCH] Thefrom https://SLC-DC01.contoso.com/Autodiscover/Autodiscover.xml.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124509.aspx

QUESTION 85You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization. The organization contains five servers. The servers areconfigured as shown in the following table.

All users access their mailbox using Microsoft Outlook 2010.

You discover that email messages take a long time to be delivered to the Internet. You also discover that thereare many email messages waiting in transport queues.

You need to identify how long it takes for an email message to be delivered from Server2 to Server5.

Which cmdlet should you run?

A. Test-MRSHealth.B. Test-SmtpConnectivity.C. Get-MailboxDatabase.D. Get-Message.E. Get-MailboxFolderStatistics.F. Get-MailboxStatistics.G. Test-MapiConnectivity.H. Get-TransportServer.I. Test-MailFlow.J. Test-OutlookWebServices.K. Test-ServiceHealth.

Correct Answer: ISection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Test-Mailflow cmdlet to diagnose whether mail can be successfully sent from and delivered to the Use thesystem mailbox on a computer that has the Mailbox server role installed. You can also use this cmdlet to verifythat emailis sent between Mailbox servers within a defined latency threshold.

This example tests message flow from the server Mailbox1 to the server Mailbox2:

Page 69: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Test-Mailflow Mailbox1 -TargetMailboxServer Mailbox2

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa995894.aspx

QUESTION 86The Exchange organization contains 500 mailboxes. All of the mailboxes are stored on a mailbox databasenamed DB1.

You have a distribution group named Assistants and a Mailbox-enabled user named Manager. You configurethe members of Assistants to moderate the email messages sent to Manager.

You need to prevent the email messages sent by the Assistants members to Manager from being moderated.

Which PowerShell cmdlet should you use?

A. New-ManagementRole.B. New-MailboxAuditSearchLog.C. New-RoleAssignementPolicy.D. New-ManagmentRoleAssignment.E. Add-MailboxPermission.F. Add-ADPermission.G. New-RoleGroup.H. New-ManagementRoleEntry.I. Set-Mailbox.J. New-ManagementScope.K. New-EmailAddressPolicy.L. Set-DistributionGroup.M. Add-ManagementRoleEntry.

Correct Answer: ISection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:If the members of a distribution group (Assistants in this case) moderate the Manager's emails, their emails arealready bypassed, because they ARE the moderators. It's logical. There's just nothing to set up here.They are not going to moderate each other's emails.

Whenever they send an email to Manager, it goes directly to that mailbox, without any delay.

I can think of only one thing here:

Set-Mailbox -Identity "Manager" -BypassModerationFromSendersOrMembers

QUESTION 87You have an Exchange Server SP1 organization. The organization contains five servers. The servers areconfigured as shown in the following table.

Page 70: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

All users access their mailbox by using Microsoft Outlook 2010.

You need to identify the 50 largest mailboxes in database 1. The solution must use the minimum amount ofadministrative effort.

Which cmdlet should you run?

A. Test-MapiConnectivity.B. Test-SmtpConnectivity.C. Test-OutlookWebServices.D. Test-ServiceHealth.E. Get-MailboxStatistics.F. Test-MailFlow.G. Get-Message.H. Get-TransportServer.I. Get-MailboxDatabase.J. Get-MailboxFoderStatistics.K. Test-MRSHealth.

Correct Answer: ESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124612

Examples:Get-MailboxStatistics -Database "Database1" | Sort-Object ItemCount -Descending | Select-Object -First 50 |FT DisplayName,ItemCount

I is right as well but it will require to pipe the results to another command and the question states "minimumamount of administrative effort."Get-MailboxDatabase "Database1" | Get-MailboxStatistics | Sort totalitemsize -desc | Select-Object -First 50 | ftdisplayname, totalitemsize, itemcount

QUESTION 88You have an Exchange Server SP1 organization. The organization contains five servers. The servers areconfigured as shown in the following table.

Page 71: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

All users access their mailbox by using Microsoft Outlook 2010.

You enable litigation hold for a user named User1.

You need to identify the number of email messages in litigation hold for user1.

Which cmdlet should you run?

A. Test-MRSHealth.B. Get-TransportServer.C. Get-Message.D. Test-ServiceHealth.E. Get-MailboxDatabase.F. Get-MailboxStatistics.G. Get-MailboxFolderStatistics.H. Test-MailFlow.I. Test-OutlookWebServices.J. Test-SmtpConnectivity.K. Test-MapiConnectivity.

Correct Answer: GSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Get-MailboxFolderStatistics -Identity "User1" -FolderScope RecoverableItems | Format-List

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ff714343.aspx

QUESTION 89Your company has offices in New York and Montreal. Each Office is configured as an Active Directory site.

You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization. The organization contains five servers. The servers areconfigured as shown in the following table:

Page 72: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Each Mailbox server contains two mailbox databases. All users have a mailbox on their local Mailbox server.Server3 contains a public folder database.

You deploy Outlook Anywhere.

All of the users who connect to their mailbox from the Internet use Outlook Anywhere. All of the users whoconnect to their mailbox from the internal network use RPC.

Some of the users who connect to their mailbox from the Internet report that they are unable to view MailTips.

You verify that all of the users who connect to their mailbox from the internal network can view MailTips.

You need to ensure that all of the users can view MailTips.

What should you modify?

A. The Outlook Web App mailbox policy.B. The email address policy.C. The mailbox databases.D. The EWS virtual directory.E. The Client Access array.F. An Attachment Filter agent.G. The Autodiscover DNS record.H. The mailbox features.I. The Exchange ActiveSync mailbox policy.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:You would modify the authentication settings on the EWS directory.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd297974.aspxhttp://social.technet.microsoft.com/Forums/en-US/exchange2010/thread/55236cec-a6e6-474e-841b-89d7e2adae86/http://blogs.dirteam.com/blogs/davestork/archive/2010/11/25/exchange-2010-mailtips-not-working-with-outlook-anywhere-users.aspx

QUESTION 90Your company has offices in New York and Montreal. Each office is configured as an Active Directory site.

You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization. The organization contains five servers. The servers areconfigured as shown in the following table:

Page 73: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Each Mailbox server contains two mailbox databases. All users have a mailbox on their local Mailbox server.Server3 contains a public folder database.

You create a Client Access array named casarray1.contoso.com.

You need to ensure that all of the users connect to casarray1.contoso.com when they open their mailbox byusing Microsoft Outlook 2010.

What Should you modify?

A. The mailbox database.B. The Exchange ActiveSync mailbox policy.C. An Attachment Filter agent.D. The mailbox features.E. The email address policy.F. The Outlook Web App mailbox policy.G. The Autodiscover DNS record.H. The Client Access array.I. The EWS virtual directory.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-MailboxDatabase <name of DB> -RpcClientAccessServer "outlook.domain.com"

Reference:

http://www.msexchange.org/articles_tutorials/exchange-server-2007/planning-architecture/uncovering-new-rpc-client-access-service-exchange-2010-part1.html

QUESTION 91Your company has offices in New York and Montreal. Each Office is configured as an Active Directory site.

You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization. The organization contains five servers. The servers areconfigured as shown in the following table:

Page 74: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Each Mailbox server contains two mailbox databases. All users have a mailbox on their local Mailbox server.

Server3 contains a public folder database.

You need to prevent users from downloading email attachments from their Windows Phone 7 devices.

What should you modify?

A. The mailbox features.B. The email address policy.C. The EWS virtual directory.D. The Autodiscover DNS record.E. The mailbox databases.F. The Exchange ActiveSync mailbox policy.G. The Client Acess array.H. An Attachment Filter afent.I. The Outlook Web App mailbox policy.

Correct Answer: FSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 92Your company has offices in New York and Montreal. Each Office is configured as an Active Directory site.

Page 75: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization. The organization contains five servers. The servers areconfigured as shown in the following table:

Each Mailbox server contains two mailbox databases. All users have a mailbox on their local Mailbox server.

Server3 contains a public folder database.

You create a new offline address book (OAB) for each office.

You need to ensure that the users in each office download the OAB created for the respective office.

What should you modify?

A. The Outlook Web App mailbox policy.B. The email address policy.C. The Autodiscover DNS record.D. The Client Access array.E. The Exchange ActiveSync mailbox policy.F. The mailbox database.G. The EWS virtual directory.H. An Attachment Filter agent.I. The mailbox features.

Correct Answer: FSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 76: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 93You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization. The organization contains two Mailbox servers that aremembers of a database availability group (DAG). The DAG is configured to use a static IP address.

You need to change the IP address of the DAG.

Which tool should you use?

A. The Set-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup cmdlet.B. The Exchange Control Panel (ECP).C. The Set-DatabaseAvailabilityGroupServer cmdlet.D. The Set-MailboxServer cmdlet.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup -Identity <DatabaseAvailabilityGroupIdParameter> -DatabaseAvailabilityGroupIpAddresses <IPAddress[]>

Example: Set-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup -identity "DAG1" -DatabaseAvailabilityGroupIpAddress 192.168.1.204

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd297934.aspx

QUESTION 94Your network Contains an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization named contoso.com. The organizationcontains a Client Access server name server1.contoso.com and a domain controller named dc1.contoso.com.

All external users access their calender and view their email messaqes by using a web browser.

The users report that they are required to type their domain name when they log in to their mailbox.

You need to ensure that the users are NOT required to type their domain name when they log on.

What should you do?

A. Modify the properties of the Client Access server object.B. Modify the Casredirect.aspx file.C. Run the Set-Imapsettings cmdlet.D. Modify the properties of the Exchange ActiveSync virtual directory.E. Run the New-OwaMailboxPolicy cmdlet.F. Modify the Redirect.aspx file.G. Run the New-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicy cmdlet.H. Modify the properties of the OWA virtual directory.I. Run the Export-ExchangeCertificate cmdlet.J. Run the Set-OfflineAddressBook cmdlet.K. Modify the properties of the offline address book (OAB) virtual directory.L. Run the Set-PopSettings cmdlets.

Correct Answer: H

Page 77: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Section: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 95You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

The network contains two Active Directory sites named Site1 and Site2. Only Site1 is connected to the Internet.Site1 contains five Client Access servers and a Client Access server array named array1.contoso.com.

Users connect to their mailboxes by using Outlook Web App (OWA) from the internal network and from theInternet.

You plan to deploy two Client Access servers and a Client Access server array in Site2.

You need to configure the namespaces for the OWA virtual directories.

What should you do on all of the Client Access servers in Site2?

A. Set the InternalURL to array2.contoso.com. Set the ExternalURL to array1.contoso.com.

Page 78: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

B. Set the InternalURL to the Client Acess server name. Set the ExternalURL to array1.contoso.com.C. Set the InternalURL to the Client Access server name. Set the ExternalURL to $null.D. Set the InternalURL to array2.contoso.com. Set the ExternalURL to $null.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:We have an array in Site2, therefore we would need to set the InternalURL to the name of the array. We canassume the array's name will be array2.contoso.com.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb310763.aspx (Proxying with Network Load Balancing)

QUESTION 96You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

The organization is authorative for a domain named nwtraders.com.

You create a federated trust.

You need to ensure that the federated partner servers can locate the Client Access servers in the organization.

Which record should you create in the external DNS zone?

A. a TXT record for nwtraders.comB. a CNAME record for nwtraders.comC. an A record for autodiscover.nwtraders.comD. an SRV record for _federation._TCP.nwtraders.com

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:You need to add an alias canonical name (CNAME) resource record to your public-facing DNS. The newCNAME record should point to an Internet-facing Client Access server that's running the Autodiscover service.

In the previous Contoso example, the new CNAME record would specify autodiscover.contoso.com as the hostname. For organizations using Microsoft DNS, you can add a CNAME record by using either DNS Manager orthe DNSCmd command. For detailed instructions, see Add an Alias (CNAME) Resource Record to a Zone.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ff601760.aspx (Step 4: Create an Autodiscover DNS record)

QUESTION 97You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

All users have Windows Mobile 6.5 devices that connect to the organization by using Exchange ActiveSync.

A user named User1 reports that she lost her device and successfully performed a remote wipe of the device.

User1 later reports that she located her device.

Page 79: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

User1 configures the device to connect to Exchange ActiveSync and discovers that the connection fails.

You need to ensure that User1 can connect her device by using Exchange ActiveSync.

What should you do?

A. Instruct User1 to perform a hardware reset on the device.B. Instruct user1 to use the Exchange Control Panel (ECP) to modify the device list.C. Run the Set-ActiveSyncDeviceAccessRule cmdlet from the Exchange Management Shell.D. Instruct User1 to change her user account password.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 98You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

You need to prevent a user named User1 from using Outlook Web App (OWA) to access his mailbox.

What should you do?

A. From the properties of User1's mailbox, modify the mailbox settings.B. From the properties of User1's mailbox, modify the mailbox features.C. Create a new OWA Mailbox PolicyD. Modify the default OWA mailbox policy

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)

Page 80: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 99Your network contains one Exchange Server 2010 SP1 Client Access server named Server1.

You have a user named User1.

You need to limit the size of the attachments that User1 can download by using Windows Mobile 6.5 devices.

What should you do first?

A. Create a new Exchange ActiveSync device access rule.B. Create a new managed content settings.C. Modify the message size restriction for user1.D. Create new Exchange ActiveSync mailbox policy.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 81: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 100You have an Active Directory forest that contains one domain named contoso.com. The functional level of boththe forest and the domain is Windows Server 2003.

You have an Exchange Server 2003 organization. All servers have Exchange Server 2003 SP2 installed.

You plan to transition to Exchange Server 2010.

You need to prepare the Active Directory environment for the deployment of the first Exchange Server 2010SP1 server.

What should you run?

A. Setup.com /preparedomainB. Setup.com /prepareadC. Setup.com /preparelegacyexchangepermissionsD. Setup.com /prepareschema

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:/Preparedomain isn't even a correct switch.

You could argue that / preparelegacyexchangepermissions is also correct as this would be the first switch youwould run if running them individually, followed by /prepareschema.

However /preparead will run /preparelegacyexchangepermissions and /prepareschema if it detects they have

Page 82: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

not been run.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb125224.aspx

QUESTION 101You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains five Mailbox servers. The Active Directorydomain contains five domain controllers in a single site.

You create a new mailbox database.

You discover that the database fails to mount.

You need to ensure that the database mounts as soon as possible.

What should you do?

A. Force the replication of the Active Directory Domain partion between all of the domain controllers.B. Configure all domain controllers as global catalog servers.C. Force the replication of the Active Directory Configuration partition between all of the domain controllers.D. Install the Exchange Server 2010 Administration tools on a domain controller.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 102You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

The network contains the computers shown in the following table:

You need to identify which computers can run Exchange Server 2010 SP1 management tools.

Which two computers should you identify? (Each correct answer presents part of the solution. Choose two).

A. Computer5B. Computer1C. Computer3

Page 83: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

D. Computer2E. Computer4

Correct Answer: CDSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 103You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 server that hosts a public folder database named PUBLIC.

You need to move the transaction log files of PUBLIC.

Which cmdlet should you run?

A. Move-DatabasePath.B. Move-StorageGroupPath.C. Set-PublicFolderDatabase.D. Set-MailPublicFolder.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Move-DatabasePath -Identity PUBLIC -LogFolderPath L:\NewFolder

QUESTION 104You have an Exchange organization that contains Exchange Server 2003 SP2 servers. All servers aremembers of one Administrative Group and one Routing Group.

You plan to transition the organization to a hosted Exchange Server 2010 environment.

You need to prepare the Exchange organization for the deployment of Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox, ClientAccess and Hub Transport servers.

What should you do first?

A. Delete all Recipient Update Service (RUS) objects.B. Modify the Active Directory schema.C. Disable the LinkState updates.D. Create a Routing Group connector.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 105You plan to install Exchange Server 2010 SP1 servers in an existing Exchange Server 2007 organization. Allservers will co-exist in a single Active Directory site.

Page 84: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You need to identify which role must be transitioned to Exchange Server 2010 first.

Which role should you identify?

A. Client Access.B. Hub Transport.C. Mailbox.D. Unified Messaging (UM).

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 106You have an Exchange Server 2003 organization.

You install a new Exchange Server 2010 SP1 server in the organization.

You need to ensure that you can modify the default email address policy by using the Exchange ManagementConsole (EMC).

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange System Manager, modify the properties of the default recipient policy.B. Run the Update-EmailAddresPolicy cmdlet.C. From the Exchange Management Console, select the email Address Policies tab, right-click Default Policy,

and then click Apply.D. Run the Set-EmailAddressPolicy cmdlet.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124517.aspx

QUESTION 107You have a server that runs Windows Server 2008 SP2. You plan to install Exchange Server 2010 SP1 on theserver.

You need to install the Exchange Server 2010 SP1 pre-requisites for the Mailbox, Client Access, and HubTransport server roles.

What should you do from the server?

A. Install Microsoft .NET Framework 3.5 SP1

Install Windows Management Framework

Page 85: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Install the Web Server role

Install the RPC over HTTP Proxy component

Run ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP Exchange-Typical.xml

B. Install Microsoft .NET Framework 3.5 SP1

Install Windows Management Framework

Install Message Queuing

Install the Web Server role

Run ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP Exchange-Typical.xml

C. Install Microsoft .NET Framework 3.5 SP1

Install Windows Remote Management (WinRM) 2.0

Run ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP Exchange-Base.xml

D. Install Microsoft .NET Framework 3.5 SP1

Install Windows Remote Management (WinRM) 2.0

Run ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP Exchange-Typical.xml

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:The answer to this one cannot be D, as has previously been said, as WinRM does not include WindowsPowershell, so you cannot run the ServerManagerCmd.exe command. This means the answer can only be A orB (as WMF contains Powershell).I have gone for A as there is absolutely no need for MSMQ on the Exchange Server, whereas IIS (for OWA)and RPC over HTTP (for Outlook Anywhere) are very useful.

Page 86: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

References:

http://exchangeserverpro.com/installing-exchange-server-2010-pre-requisites-on-windows-server-2008 http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb691354.aspx

QUESTION 108You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

You create a retention policy and apply the policy to all of the mailboxes in the organization.

You need to ensure that users can use personal tags that are not linked to the retention policy.

What should you do?

A. Run the Set-Mailbox -identity "user1" -SingleItemRecoveryEnabled $true command.B. Create a Retention Policy Tag that uses the Personal Folders tag type.C. Run the Set-RetentionPolicyTag | Set-RetentionPolicyTag -RetentionEnabled $false command.D. Run the Set-RetentionPolicyTag -identity "never delete" -type Personal command.E. Run the Set-RetentionPolicyTag -identity "never delete" -type All command.F. Modify the management role groups.G. Create a Retention Policy Tag that uses the all other folders tag type.H. Run the Set-Mailbox -identity "user1" -RetentionHoldEnabled $true command.I. Modify the User Role Assignment Policy.

Correct Answer: ISection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Opt-in personal tags

· Users can use ECP to select additional personal tags not linked to their retention policy · NeedsMyRetentionPolicies role

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd876897.aspx

Page 87: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 109You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

You create a retention policy and apply the policy to all of the mailboxes in the organization.

You need to add a default policy tag to a retention policy. The tag must move all email messages automaticallyto a Personal Archive six months after the messages are received.

What should you do first?

A. Run the Set-Mailbox -identity "user1" -RetentionHoldEnabled $true command.B. Create a Retention Policy Tag that uses the Personal Folders tag type.C. Run the Set-RetentionPolicyTag -identity "never delete" -type Personal command.D. Modify the management role groups.E. Create a Retention Policy Tag that uses the all other folders tag type.F. Modify the User Role Assignment Policy.G. Run the Set-RetentionPolicyTag -identity "never delete" -type All command.H. Run the Set-RetentionPolicyTag | Set-RetentionPolicyTag -RetentionEnabled $false command.

Page 88: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

I. Set-Mailbox -identity "user1" -SingleItemRecoveryEnabled $true command.Run the

Correct Answer: ESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:You can't create Retention Policy Tags (RPTs - for default folders such as Inbox and Deleted Items) with theMove to Archive action.

The Move To Archive action is only supported for Default Policy Tag (Type = 'All') or Personal Tags.

The former applies to the entire mailbox. The latter can be used by Outlook 2010/OWA users to tag individualfolders or items.

And you need to create an archive mailbox for the user.

So the correct command is the following:

New-RetentionPolicyTag "InboxMovetoArchive30days" -Type "All/Personal" -Comment "Inbox move to archivein 30 days" -RetentionEnabled $true -AgeLimitForRetention 30 -RetentionAction MovetoArchive

New-RetentionPolicy "ManagedFoldersRetentionPolicy" -RetentionPolicyTagLinks " InboxMovetoArchive30days"

Reference:

Personal Folder Retention Tag not working (Exchange 2010 SP1):http://social.technet.microsoft.com/Forums/en-AU/exchange2010/thread/8289a667-1504-46d7-ac65-ff0560ec3fa0

Create a Retention Tag:http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ff625223.aspx

Exchange 2010 SP1 Possible Bug, Cannot create move to archive retention tag on inbox, but can create a newone and edit and assign inbox to it:http://social.technet.microsoft.com/Forums/en-US/exchange2010/thread/4b87d412-3350-4b0d-9364-03e6366bd35e/

=============Ref#http://blogs.technet.com/b/ianhamer/archive/2009/12/04/curious-about-exchange-2010-retention-policies.aspxPersonal Tags (or Personal Tags) here's where you can created additional tags that your users can apply totheir own customer folders (as well as individual items). They can do this in either Outlook 2010 or OutlookWeb App. In our demo environment, we have created such tags, like "Acquisitions, keep for 5 years"

Page 89: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 110You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

All users use Microsoft Outlook 2010.

A user named User1 reaches her mailbox size limit.

You need to ensure that User1 can archive email messages located in her mailbox and read the archivedmessages when she works offline.

What should you create for User1?

A. An offline store (OST) file.B. A Personal Archive.C. A personal folder (PST) file.D. A managed folder mailbox policy.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Clue is in the question: she needs to be able to read them offline, but for them to not remain in her Inbox.

QUESTION 111You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

Page 90: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You need to determine why a remote SMTP server rejects emails sent from your organization.What should you do?

A. Review the application event logs.B. Review the message tracking logs.C. Set the Protocol logging level to Verbose on the Receive connectors and then review the protocol log files.D. Set the Protocol logging level to Verbose on the Send connectors and then review the protocol log files.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 112You have a database availability group (DAG) that contains two servers named MBX1 and MBX2.

You discover that a mailbox database named DB2 is in a FailedAndSuspended state on MBX2.

You need to reseed DB2 to MBX2. You must achieve this goal by using the minimum amount of administrativeeffort.

What should you do?

A. From the Services console, restart the Microsoft Exchange Replication Service.B. From the Exchange Management Console, run the Add Mailbox Database Copy wizard.C. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Update-MailboxDatabaseCopy cmdlet.D. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Restore-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup cmdlet.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

[PS] C:\>Update-MailboxDatabaseCopy -Identity "DB2\MBX2" -DeleteExistingFiles

QUESTION 113Your network contains two Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox servers.

You create a database availability group (DAG). You need to ensure that the Exchange servers can replicatemailbox databases.

What should you do?

Page 91: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Modify the membership list of the DAG.B. Add the Network Load Balancing feature on both servers.C. Add Active Directory Federation Services (AD FS) on both servers.D. Enable Datacenter Activation co-ordination (DAC) mode for the DAG.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 114You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to prevent internal users from sending messages that contain the phrase "Company Confidential" toexternal users.

What should you create?

A. A Hub Transport rule.B. A Managed Folder Mailbox policy.C. A message classification.D. A Send connector.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 115You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains an accepted domain named fabrikam.com.

You need to automatically forward all email messages sent to fabrikam.com recipients who do not exist in theorganization to another server.

Which properties should you modify?

A. Accepted domain.B. Default email address policy.C. Default Receive connector.D. Default remote domain.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 116You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains an accepted domain named contoso.com.

Page 92: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

The Exchange organization contains a DAG named DAG1. The organization also contains one public folderdatabase called PF1.

You need to configure public folder replication to the other servers in the DAG.

What should you do first?

A. Use the Set-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup cmdlet.B. Use the New-PublicFolderDatabase cmdlet.C. Use the Set-PublicFolderDatabase cmdlet.D. Use the Exchange Management Console (EMC) to modify the properties of PF1.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:A new public folder database is required on all members of the DAG, if you wish to replicate the public folderacross to them:

A public folder database can be hosted on a Mailbox server in a database availability group (DAG), but youmust use multiple public folder databases and public folder replication for data redundancy. When you modify apublic folder or its contents, the public folder database that contains the replica of the public folder that waschanged sends a descriptive email message to the other public folder databases that host a replica of thepublic folder.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb629523.aspx

QUESTION 117You are the Enterprise Administrator of an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization.

Your server is responding to SMTP requests with the address cas1.contoso.com when it should be mail.contoso.com.

What should you use to correct this?

A. Set-TransportServer.B. EMC Hub Transport rule.C. EMC Hub Transport Properties.D. Set-TransportConfig.E. Set-TransportAgent.F. Set-ReceiveConnector.

Correct Answer: FSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-ReceiveConnector -Identity -FQDN mail.fabrikam.comThis should be:

Set-ReceiveConnector "From the Internet" -It's unlikely, but it could also be to do with the banner, so:

Page 93: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Banner "220 Contoso Corporation"

Reference:

http://social.technet.microsoft.com/Forums/en-US/exchange2010hosters/thread/86d80ab2-c45a-4d93- b641-d623cde53e81

Banner Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124740.aspx

QUESTION 118You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization that contains a CAS array. There are two servers,named CAS-01 and CAS-02, in the CAS array.You have a machine on the internal network called Test1. When one Client Access server crashes Test1cannot download the autodiscover details from the Client Access Server array.

Which cmdlet should you use to rectify this?

A. Set-ClientAccessArray.B. Set-ClientAccessServer.C. New-AutodiscoverVirtualDirectory.D. Set-AutodiscoverVirtualDirectory.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-ClientAccessServer -Make sure both CAS in the array have the correct autodiscover information:Identity "CAS-01" -AutoDiscoverServiceInternalUri "https://cas01.contoso.com/autodiscover/ autodiscover.xml"

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb125157

QUESTION 119You are the Enterprise Exchange Administrator of an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization.

You need to give a user in the Sales department access to a mail enabled public folder on Server1.

How would you achieve this?

A. Use the Add-PublicFolderClientPermission cmdlet.B. Use the Set-MailPublicFolder cmdlet.C. Use the Enable-MailPublicFolder cmdlet.D. Use the Update-PublicFolder cmdlet.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:The full cmdlet string needed is: Add-PublicFolderClientPermission -Identity "\Sales Public Folder" - UserSalesUser -AccessRights Reviewer -Server "Server1"

Page 94: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

If you need to give access to all folders beneath the top one, it can also be done withAddUsersToPFRecursive.ps1 -TopPublicFolder "\Sales Public Folder" -User "Sales" -Permission Reviewer,however, this need is not implicitly specified in the question, as far as I recall.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124743

QUESTION 120You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack1 (SP1) installed.

You have a user named User1 that must be the only moderator of a room mailbox.

Which tab should you click to complete this?

A. Resource Information.B. Resource Out-of-Policy Requests.C. Account.D. Mailbox Features.

Page 95: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

E. Resource General.F. Resource In-Policy.G. Resource Policy.H. Mail Flow.

Correct Answer: GSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Exam D

QUESTION 121You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

The network contains an internal root certification authority (CA).

Users on the network use Outlook Anywhere. A Client Access server uses a wildcard certificate issued by atrusted third-party root CA.

Page 96: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You need to ensure that users can send and receive encrypted email messages using S/MIME.

What should you do?

A. Instruct all users to import the third-party root CA certificate.B. Import the internal root CA certificate to the Client Access server.C. Instruct all users to import the internal root CA certificate.D. Issue a certificate to each user from the internal root CA.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 122You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

An external user reports that when he sends email messages to the organization, they are not received.

You suspect that the email messages he sends are getting incorrectly identified as spam.

You need to identify which anti-spam filter is blocking the email messages.

What should you do?

A. Modify the protocol logging level, and then review the protocol logs.B. Modify the connectivity log settings, and the review the connectivity logs.C. Modify the message tracking settings, and then review the message tracking logs.D. Enable pipeline tracing and then review the trace.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb125018.aspxhttp://blogs.technet.com/b/provtest/archive/2010/07/27/exchange-server-2010-sp1-beta-hosting- deployment-part-7-transport-segregation.aspx?PageIndex=2

First step is to configure my email address as the "PipelineTracingSenderAddress" using the Set-TransportServer cmdlet.

Set-TransportServer "hewexch" PipelineTracingSenderAddress "[email protected]"

Page 97: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Second step is to enable pipeline tracing (I am happy with the default location of logs folder).

Set-TransportServer "hewexch" PipelineTracingEnabled $true

QUESTION 123You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installed.

You need to prevent external organizations that do not have sender policy framework (SPF) records fromsending e-mail messages to the organization.

What should you configure?

A. Sender reputation.B. Sender ID filtering.C. An IP block list provider.D. Sender filtering.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa996295.aspx

Page 98: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 124You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization that contains five servers. The servers are configured asshown in the following table:

You deploy a farm of application servers that send email messages to Internet recipients. The applicationservers are configured to send the email messages through the Hub Transport servers.

You deploy a load balancing solution for the Hub Transport servers.

You need to ensure that only the application servers can relay email messages to Internet recipients overSMTP.

What should you do? (Choose all that apply).

A. Create a new Receive connector.B. Create an Edge Transport rule.

Page 99: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. Run the Set-TransportServer cmdlet.D. Create a new Send connector.E. Create a Hub Transport rule.

Correct Answer: ABESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 125Your network contains an Active Directory forest named fabrikam.com. The forest contains an Active Directorysite named Denver. You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization. You have a Client Access servernamed CAS1.

You need to ensure that you can install Outlook Anywhere on CAS1. The Solution must minimize the number offeatures installed on CAS1.

Which features should you install on CAS1?

To answer, select the appropriate feature or features in the answer area.

A. RPC over HTTP Proxy.B. SMTP Server.C. Message Queuing.D. Failover Clustering.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

Page 100: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123741.aspx

QUESTION 126You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization.

Users connect to the organization from Outlook Web App by using the webmail.contoso.com fully qualifieddomain name (FQDN).

http://www.gratisexam.com/

You need to recreate the OWA virtual directory on a server that runs Exchange Server 2010 SP1. The solutionmust ensure that users can connect to Outlook Web App by using the webmail.contoso.com FQDN.

What should you do?

To answer, move the appropriate actions from the list of actions to the answer area and arrange them in thecorrect order.

Page 101: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. From Server Manager, reinstall the Web Server (IIS) server role.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the New-OwaMailboxPolicy cmdlet.C. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the New-OwaVirtualDirectory cmdlet.D. From the Exchange Management Shell, run Import-ExchangeCertificate cmdlet.E. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Remove-OwaVirtualDirectory cmdlet.F. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the OWA virtual directory.

Correct Answer: CEFSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:1. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Remove-OwaVirtualDirectory cmdlet.2. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the New-OwaVirtualDirectory cmdlet.3. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the OWA Virtual Directory.

Reference:

http://exchangeadventures.com/2010/06/18/recreate-exchange-iis-virtual-directories-with-exchange-2010- sp1

QUESTION 127Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization named fabrikam.com.

You have two mailbox-enabled users named User1 and User2.

You need to perform the following tasks:

Page 102: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Ensure that User2 can send email messages as User1.

Ensure that an entry is logged on the server each time User2 sends a message as User1.

Review the list of logged email messages.

What should you do?

A. Create a new Hub Transport rule.B. Create a retention policy.C. Enable litigation hold for user1.D. Modify user1 by using the Set-Mailbox cmdlet.E. Modify user2 by using the Set-Mailbox cmdlet.F. Review the Application log from the Event Viewer.G. Assign permissions to user1 by using the Add-ADPermission cmdlet.H. Assign permissions to User2 by using the Add-AdPermission cmdlet.I. Run a non-owner mailbox access report from the Exchange

Control Panel (ECP).

Correct Answer: DHISection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:

Page 103: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:1. Assign permissions to User2 by using the Add-AdPermission cmdlet.2. Modify user1 by using the Set-Mailbox cmdlet.3. Run a non-owner mailbox access report from the Exchange Control Panel (ECP).

1-This example grants Send As permissions for Aaron Painter to Ellen Adams's mailbox. Add-ADPermission -Identity "Ellen Adams" -User AaronPainter -AccessRights ExtendedRight - ExtendedRights "send as"

2-You need to be assigned permissions before you can perform this procedure. To see what permissions youneed, see the "Mailbox audit logging" entry in the Messaging Policy and Compliance Permissions topic. Thisexample enables mailbox audit logging for Ben Smith's mailbox.Set-Mailbox -Identity "Ben Smith" -AuditEnabled $true3- non-owner mailbox access report ECP

QUESTION 128Your network contains an Active Directory forest named contoso.com. The forest contains an Exchange Server2010 SP1 organization.

A partner company has an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization.

You need to implement federated delegation between your organization and the partner organization.

What should you do first?

A. Create a federation trust.B. Install the Federation Service Proxy role service.C. Create a forest trust.D. Install the Federation Service role service.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 129You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization.

All mailbox-enabled users access their mailbox by using Microsoft Outlook 2010.

You create a custom message classification.

You need to ensure that all of the mailbox-enable users can use the message classification from Outlook 2010.

What should you do? (Choose all that apply).

A. Create a retention policy.B. Deploy Classifications.xml to each client computer.C. Create a retention tag.D. Modify the Outlook 2010 profile settings of each mailbox-enabled user.E. Modify the registry of each client computer.F. Create a transport rule that uses the message classifcation as a condition.

Correct Answer: BESection: (none)Explanation

Page 104: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa998271.aspx

Open the Shell and run the following script from the Program Files\Microsoft\Exchange Server\V14\Scriptsdirectory:./Export-OutlookClassification.ps1 > c:\exports\Classifications.xml

Copy Classifications.xml to c:\ root of the client

The following registry key and related registry settings must be created on all Outlook 2007 computers fromwhich users who have mailboxes hosted on Exchange 2010 send message classifications.

[HKEY_CURRENT_USER\Software\Microsoft\Office\12.0\Common\Policy] "AdminClassificationPath"="c:\\Classifications.xml""EnableClassifications"=dword:00000001"TrustClassifications"=dword:00000001

QUESTION 130You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization that contains five servers. The servers are configured asshown in the following table:

You enable safelist aggregation.

You need to verify whether Edge1 and Edge2 received the list of safe senders.

Which tool should you use?

A. Active Directory Service Interfaces Editor (ADSI Edit).B. The Test-ReplicationHealth cmdlet.C. The Exchange Control Panel (ECP).D. The Exchange Management Console (EMC).

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa998280.aspx

There are three safelist collection attributes for each user object:

msExchSafeRecipientsHash This attribute stores the hash of the Safe Recipients List collection for the user.msExchSafeSendersHash This attribute stores the hash of the Safe Senders List collection for the user.msExchBlockedSendersHash This attribute stores the hash of the Blocked Senders List collection for the user.

Page 105: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 131You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization that contains an Edge Transport server. The server islocated in the perimeter network and contains an Edge Subscription.

Page 106: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Your company has a security policy that has the following requirements:

All email messages sent to the organization must be archived on a company-owned server.

After the email messages are archived, the messages must be forwarded to a hosted anti-spam service

provider.You need to configure the Exchange organization to meet the requirement of the security policy.

What should you do?

A. Delete the default Receive connector.B. Link the RECEIVE_CUSTOM Receive connector to the Delivery Agent connector.C. Link the RECEIVE_CUSTOM Receive connector to the PROVIDER Send connector.D. Create a Delivery Agent connector.E. Create a Send connector named PROVIDER that has a custom address space.F. Create a Foreign connector named FOREIGN that has a custom address space.

Correct Answer: CESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:1. Create a Send connector named PROVIDER that has a custom address space.

Page 107: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

2. Link the RECEIVE_CUSTOM Receive connector to the PROVIDER Send connector.

QUESTION 132You need to modify the internal URL of the Exchange ActiveSync virtual directory.

Which node should you select from the Exchange Management Console (EMC) to make the modification?

To answer, select the appropriate node in the answer area.

A. Select Server Configuration -> Client AccessB. Select Server Configuration -> Hub TransportC. Select Organization Configuration -> Client AccessD. Select Organization Configuration -> Hub Transport

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 108: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 133You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization named contoso.com. The organization contains twoClient Access servers named CAS1 and CAS2. CAS1 and CAS2 are members of a Client Access array namedcasarray1.contoso.com.

The hardware on CAS1 fails. You need to restore CAS1.

You install Windows Server 2008 R2 on a new server named CAS1.

What should you do next?

To answer, move the appropriate actions from the list of actions to the answer area and arrange them in thecorrect order.

Page 109: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Join CAS1 to contoso.com.B. Add CAS1 to casarray1.contoso.com.C. Reset the computer account of CAS1.D. Create a computer account for casarray1.contoso.com.E. From the Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installation files, run setup /r:c.F. From the Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installation files, run setup /m:recoverserver.

Correct Answer: ACFSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:1. Reset the computer account of CAS1.2. Join CAS1 to contoso.com.3. From the Exchange Server 2010 SP1 installation files, run setup /m:recoverserver.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd876880.aspx

QUESTION 134You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization named contoso.com.

You need to ensure that all of the email messages sent between the Exchange mailboxes are InformationRights Management (IRM)-protected automatically.

What should you do?

To answer, move the appropriate actions from the list of actions to the answer area and arrange them in the

Page 110: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

correct order.

A. Create a journal rule.B. Create a transport rule.C. Run the Set-TransportConfig cmdlet.D. Run the Set-IRMConfiguration cmdlet.E. Install Active Directory Federation Services (AD FS).F. Install Active Directory Certificate Services (AD CS).G. Install Active Directory Right Managment Services (AD RMS).H. Configure Transport Layer Security (TLS) on all Send connectors.

Correct Answer: BDGSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:1. Install Active Directory Right Managment Services (AD RMS).2. Run the Set-IRMConfiguration cmdlet.3. Create a transport rule.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd876938.aspx

Page 111: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 135Your company has three departments named Sales, Marketing, and Finance.

The network contains an Active Directory domain named contoso.com. You have an Exchange Server 2010Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization that contains the servers configured as shown in the following table:

You create an Edge Subsciption for Server2.

Your company merges with another company named Fabrikam, Inc.

You need to ensure that your Exchange organization can receive email for fabrikam.com.

What should you create?

A. A new Edge Subscription.B. A new journal rule.C. A new Send connector.D. A Hub Transport rule.E. A remote domain.F. An accepted domain.G. A new organization relationship.H. An attachment filter entry.I. A new Receive connector.J. A new federation trust.

Correct Answer: FSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 136Your company has three departments named Sales, Marketing, and Finance.

The network contains an Active Directory domain named contoso.com. You have an Exchange Server 2010Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization that contains the servers configured as shown in the following table:

You create an Edge Subsciption for Server2.

You need to ensure that all email messages sent by users in the Sales department include a disclaimer.

Page 112: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

What should you create?

A. A new Edge Subscription.B. A new journal rule.C. A new Send connector.D. A Hub Transport rule.E. A remote domain.F. An Edge Transport rule.G. A new organization relationship.H. An attachment filter entry.I. A new Receive connector.J. A new federation trust.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 137Your company has three departments named Sales, Marketing, and Finance.

The network contains an Active Directory domain named contoso.com. You have an Exchange Server 2010Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization that contains the servers configured as shown in the following table:

You create an Edge Subsciption for Server2.

You need to ensure that all email messages created by members of the Sales department are approved by theSales department manager before they are delivered.

What should you create?

A. A new Edge Subscription.B. An accepted domain.C. An IP Block List Provider.D. A new Send connector.E. A new organization relationship.F. A new journal rule.G. A remote domain.H. A Hub Transport rule.I. A federation trust.J. A new Receive connector.

Correct Answer: HSection: (none)

Page 113: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 138Your company has three departments named Sales, Marketing, and Finance.

The network contains an Active Directory domain named contoso.com. You have an Exchange Server 2010Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization that contains the servers configured as shown in the following table:

You create an Edge Subsciption for Server2.

You need to prevent the company's server from accepting email messages from servers on the Internet thatare known to originate spam.

What should you add to the organization?

A. A new Send connector.B. A new Edge Subscription.C. A new federation trust.D. A remote domain.E. An IP Block List Provider.F. A new Receive connector.G. A new organization relationship.H. An Edge Transport rule.I. A new journal rule.J. A attachment filter entry.

Correct Answer: ESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa997658.aspxhttp://exchangeserverpro.com/exchange-2010-edge-transport-server-configuring-ip-block-list-providers

Page 114: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 139Your company has three departments named Sales, Marketing, and Finance.

The network contains an Active Directory domain named contoso.com. You have an Exchange Server 2010Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization that contains the servers configured as shown in the following table:

You create an Edge Subsciption for Server2.

You plan to encrypt all of the email sent to a partner company named A. Datum Corporation by using TransportLayer Security (TLS).

You need to prepare Server1 for the planned configuration.

What should you create?

A. A new federation trust.B. A new Edge Subscription.

Page 115: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. A new journal rule.D. A new organization relationship.E. An attachment filter entry.F. An Edge Transport rule.G. A Hub Transport rule.H. A new Send connector.I. A remote domain.J. A new Receive connector.

Correct Answer: HSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:This question sounds like we are trying to build Domain Security. Partner Send connectors send email topartner domains. This connector is configured to only allow connections to servers that authenticate withTransport Layer Security (TLS) certificates for SMTP domains included in the list of domain-secured domains.You can add domains to this list by using the TLSSendDomainSecureList parameter in the Set-TransportConfig command.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa997285.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124392.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123543.aspx

QUESTION 140You have an Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization.

You have a resource mailbox for a meeting room named Meeting Room 1.

You need to ensure that when a user schedules a meeting for Meeting Room 1, the user receives an e-mailmessage that contains directions to the meeting room.

Which property tab should you modify?

To answer, select the approprate tab in the answer area.

A. Mailbox Features.B. Resource General.C. Resource Policy.D. Resource Information.

Page 116: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 141Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization. The organization has asingle public folder database.

You need to prevent all the members of a group named Sales from accessing the public folders from OutlookWeb App.

What should you do first?

A. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), create a new Outlook Web App mailbox policy.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Add-PublicFolderClientPermission cmdlet.C. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the Segmentation settings of the OWA virtual

directory.

Page 117: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

D. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-CasMailbox cmdlet.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd335191.aspx#EMC

QUESTION 142Your network contains an Active Directory domain named fabrikam.com.

You have an Exchagne Server 2010 Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization that contains four servers. The serversare configured as shown in the following table:

Edge1 is located in the perimeter network.

You need to replicate the transport configurations to Edge1.

Page 118: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

What should you do first?

A. From Hub1, run the Get-EdgeSubscription cmdlet and specify the FileName parameter.B. From Edge1, run the Get-EdgeSubscription cmdlet and specify the FileData parameter.C. From Hub1, run the New-EdgeSubscription cmdlet and specify the FileData parameter.D. From Edge1, run the New-EdgeSubcription cmdlet and specify the FileName parameter.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123800.aspx

QUESTION 143You have an internal network and a perimeter network. The network contains the servers configured as shownin the following table:

You need to configure the firewall that separates the internal network and the perimeter network. Theconfiguration must meet the following requirements:

Ensure that inbound email messages can be relayed to Server1.

Ensure that outbound email messages can be relayed to Server3.

Ensure that the list of Exchange recipients is replicated to Server3.

Page 119: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. 25 Outbound.B. 25 Inbound.C. 389.D. 443.E. 636.F. 3389.G. 50636.

Correct Answer: ABGSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Port 25 needs to be going both ways for sending and receiving mail over SMTP. Then port 50636 is used forthe LDAP connection necessary to transfer the list of Exchange recipients to Server3.

QUESTION 144You have an Exchange Server 2003 organization that contains a server named EX_Server. You install a servernamed Server1 that runs Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack 1 (SP1). You create a public folder database onServer1.

A user named User1 has a mailbox on Server1.

User1 creates a public folder on Server1 and posts content to the public folder. From Outlook Web App, User1attempts to access the public folders on EX_Server and receives and error message.

You need to ensure that User1 can access all of the public folders in the organization from Outlook Web App.

What should you do? (Each correct answer presents a complete solution. Choose all that apply).

A. From Exchange System Manager on EX_Server, modify the replica list of the public folders.B. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the Outlook Web App mailbox

policy.C. Instruct User1 to use Outlook Web Access (OWA).D. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the addreplicatopfrecursive.ps1 script.E. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the default public folder database of the mailbox

database.

Correct Answer: ADSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:This question is actually about replication. Once the public folders on EX_Server are replicated to Server1,User1 will be able to access them.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd335168.aspxhttp://blogs.technet.com/b/agobbi/archive/2010/08/04/how-to-move-public-folder-from-exchange-2003-to-exchagne-2010.aspx

QUESTION 145

Page 120: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Your network contains an Active Directory domain named contoso.com. The domain contains an ExchangeServer 2010 Service Pack 1 (SP1) organization.

The domain contains an organizational unit (OU) named Sales.

You need to configure Outlook Web App to meet the following requirements:

Allow only members of the Sales OU to change their password by using the Exchange Control Panel

(ECP).Prevent all other users from changing their password by using the ECP.

What should you do?

To answer, move the appropriate actions from the list of actions to the answer area and arrange them in thecorrect order.

A. Create a New Outlook Web App mailbox policy named Accounting.B. Modify the Authentication settings of the ECP virtual directory.C. From the Exchange Management Shell, run Get-mailbox | where-object {$_.distinguishedname -like

'*ou=accounting,dc=contoso,dc=com'} | Set-CasMailbox-OWAMailboxPolicy:Accounting.D. From the Exchange Management Shell, run Get-mailbox | where-object {$_.distinguishedname -like

'*ou=accounting,dc=contoso,dc=com'} | Set-Mailbox-RoleAssignmentPolicy:Accounting.E. Run the configure External Client Access Domain wizard.

Page 121: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

F. Modify the Segmentation settings of the default Outlook Web App mailbox policy.G. Modify the Authentication settings of the OWA virtual directoy.

Correct Answer: ACFSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:1. Create a New Outlook Web App mailbox policy named Accounting.2. From the Exchange Management Shell, run Get-mailbox | where-object {$_.distinguishedname -like'*ou=accounting,dc=contoso,dc=com'} | Set-CasMailbox-OWAMailboxPolicy:Accounting.3. Modify the Segmentation settings of the default Outlook Web App mailbox policy.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd335142.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd335191.aspx

QUESTION 146Your network contains an Active Directory forest named fabrikam.com. All servers run Windows Server 2008R2 SP1.

You have two servers named Mail1 and Edge1. Mail1 is located on the internal network. Edge1 is located onthe perimeter network. The internal network and the perimeter network are separated by a firewall.

You plan to deploy Exchange Server 2010 SP1 to Mail1 and Edge1. Mail1 will have the Mailbox, Hub Transport,and Client Access server roles installed. Edge1 will have the Edge Transport server role installed.

You need to ensure that you can install the Edge Transport server role on Edge1. The solution must minimizethe amount of software installed on Edge1.

What should you install on Edge1? (Choose all that apply).

A. The Web Server (IIS) server role.B. The SMTP Server feature.C. Microsoft .NET Framework 3.5 SP1.D. Remote Server Administration Tools (RSAT).E. Active Directory Lightweight Directory Services (AD LDS).

Correct Answer: CDESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb691354.aspx

QUESTION 147You have a hosted Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 ServicePack 1 (SP1) installed.

You have a user named User1 and a user named User2.

You need to ensure that User1 can add User2 to the From field when he sends email messages. Messagesthat have User2 in the From field must display only User2 as the message sender to recipients who receive the

Page 122: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

messages.

What should you use?

A. Microsoft Outlook.B. Exchange Management Console (EMC).C. Active Directory Users and Computers.D. Exchange Control Panel (ECP).

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb676368.aspx

QUESTION 148You have a hosted Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 ServicePack 1 (SP1) installed.

You have 3 mailbox servers in a DAG. You want to enable Datacenter Activation Co-ordination on exiting theDAG.

Which cmdlet should you use?

A. Set-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup.B. Get-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup.C. New-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup.D. Add-MailboxDatabaseCopy.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Page 123: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:The command looks like this:

Set-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup -Identity DAG1 -DatacenterActivationMode DagOnly

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd297934.aspx

----Datacenter Activation Coordination (DAC) Mode is a property of a DAG which can be turned on or off. DACmode is disabled by default and should only be enabled for DAGs with three or more DAG members that havebeen deployed in a multi-datacenter configuration. DAC mode shouldn't be enabled for

2 member DAGs where each member is in a different AD site2-16 member DAGs where all members are in the same AD site

QUESTION 149You have a hosted Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 ServicePack 1 (SP1) installed.

Select the proper DNS record to create when you deploy federated delegation. (Choose all that apply).

A. A record.B. MX (mail exchange record).C. MG (mail group record).D. TXT record.

Correct Answer: ADSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Create a TXT record for federated delegation.The A record should actually be a CNAME, according to Technet. However, in the strictest sense, an A recordwould need to have been created in DNS to map the IP to the external server name, then the CNAME recordwould be created so the federated partner can access your network. For example:

A record maps server IP to company name (i.e., 64.4.6.100 to contoso.com). CNAME sets next record fordiscovery (i.e., autodiscover.contoso.com).

It is unlikely that your exam will give you the option of an A record, but if there is no mention of a CNAME gowith A and TXT. Otherwise, always go with CNAME and TXT.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ff601760.aspx

QUESTION 150You have an Exchange 2010 SP1 organization, with servers in the following configuration:

Server1 - Mailbox, Hub Transport server.

Server2 - Client Access server.

Page 124: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Server1 holds the public folder database.

You deploy a new server named Server4 and Outlook 2010 clients.

Which command would you use to ensure that all new public folders are created only on Server4?

A. Set-MailboxDatabase.B. Remove-StoreMailbox.C. Get-MailboxDatabase.D. New-MailboxDatabase.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-MailboxDatabase -Identity "Mailbox Database" -PublicFolderDatabase "PublicFolderDB1"

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb629522.aspx

QUESTION 151Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox server. The server has one mailbox database. A usernamed User1 reports that several mails have been lost from his mailbox.

You need to recover User1's email messages. The solution must not delete any other email messages in themailbox database.

What should you do?

A. Create a database availability group (DAG), restore a backup of the mailbox database file, and then run theRestore-Mailbox cmdlet.

B. Create a new Mailbox Recovery Database, restore a backup of the database file, and then run the Export-Mailbox cmdlet.

C. Create a database availability group (DAG), restore a backup of the mailbox database file, and then run theNew-MailboxExportRequest cmdlet.

D. Create a new Mailbox Recovery Database, restore a backup of the database file, and then run the New-MailboxExportRequest cmdlet.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 152You have two Exchange Server 2010 servers named Server1 and Server2. Both servers have the ClientAccess, Hub Transport, and Mailbox server roles installed. The servers are members of a database availabilitygroup (DAG).

You need to ensure that all Microsoft Office Outlook users automatically connect to an available Client Accessserver if a single server or service fails.

What should you do?

Page 125: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Create a Client Access server array. Create a new DNS record and add the IP addresses of both ClientAccess servers to the new DNS record.

B. Deploy a hardware load balancer. Create a DNS record for the virtual IP address of the load balancer.Create and configure a Client Access server array.

C. Install the Network Load Balancing feature on both servers. Assign a second IP address to each server.Create a Client Access server array and a new DNS record for the array.

D. Remove Server2 from the DAG. Create a Client Access server array, and then enable Datacenter Activationco-ordination. Install the Network Load Balancing feature on both servers.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 153You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains five Mailbox servers and five Client Accessservers. All users in the organization connect to their mailboxes using Outlook Anywhere.

You create a Client Access server array. You need to ensure that all users can connect to the Client Accessserver array.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-Mailbox cmdlet.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-MailboxDatabase cmdlet.C. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of each mailbox database.D. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of each Client Access server

object.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Get-MailboxDatabase | Set-MailboxDatabase -RPCClientAccessServer "Client.msglab.local"

QUESTION 154You have an Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox server named Server1.

Server1 fails.

You install Windows Server 2008 on a new server named Server2. You need to perform an Exchange Server2010 recovery installation.

What should you do before you perform the recovery installation?

A. Rename the Server1 computer account to Server2.

Join Server2 to the domain.

B. Rename Server2 to Server1.

Page 126: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Reset the Server1 computer account.

Join Server1 to the domain.

C. Delete the computer account for Server1.

Join Server2 to the domain.

Rename Server2 to Server1.

D. Delete the computer account for Server1.

Rename Server2 to Server1.

Create a new computer account for Server1.

Join Server1 to the domain.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 155You have two Exchange Server 2010 Client Access servers named CAS1 and CAS2.

CAS1 and CAS2 are in an Active Directory site named Site1. Both servers are members of a Client Accessserver array.

CAS1 fails.

You install a new Client Access server named CAS3 in a new site. You need to ensure that CAS3 is a memberof the Client Access server array.

What should you do?

A. Move CAS3 to Site1.B. Run the Set-ClientAccessArray cmdlet.C. Run the Setup /M:RecoverServer command.D. Modify the DNS record of the Client Access server array.

Correct Answer: A

Page 127: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Section: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 156You have an Active Directory forest that runs Windows Server 2008. You have an Exchange Server 2010organization that contains a Hub Transport server named Hub1.

Hub1 fails.

An administrator deletes the computer account and all other references of Hub1 from Active Directory.

You need to replace the Hub Transport server role on a new server. You must achieve this goal by using theminimum amount of administrative effort.

What should you do?

A. On the new server, run Setup /M:RecoverServer.B. On the new server, run the Exchange Server installation program and then select the Hub Transport role.C. From Ntdsutil, perform an authoritative restore and then create a managed service account named Hub1.D. From Ntdsutil, perform an authoritative restore and then create a CNAME record for Hub1 that points to the

new server.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 157Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 server. All users access their mailboxes using only MicrosoftOffice Outlook 2010.

You create a policy that archives all email messages that are older than 365 days.

You need to ensure that all users can retain certain email messages for up to five years. The solution mustallow users to specify which email messages are retained.

Which two object types should you create? (Each correct answer presents part of the solution. Choose two).

A. A managed folder mailbox policy.B. A retention hold.C. A retention policy.D. Managed custom folders.E. Retention tags.

Correct Answer: CESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 158

Page 128: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Your network contains Mailbox servers that run Exchange Server 2007 and Exchange Server 2010.

You need to ensure that all email messages located in the Inbox folders of all users are deleted after 120 days.

What should you create first?

A. A new managed custom folder.B. A new message classification.C. A new retention policy.D. New managed content settings.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Managed folders are a messaging records management (MRM) feature introduced in Microsoft ExchangeServer 2007 that's also available in Exchange Server 2010. Using managed folders, you can specify retentionsettings for default folders such as Inbox, Deleted Items, and Sent Items, and create custom managed folderswith their own retention settings. Managed folders rely on users to classify messages for retention, and movethe messages to appropriate managed folders based on retention requirements.

http://www.msexchange.org/articles_tutorials/exchange-server-2010/management-administration/exchange-server-compliancy.html

QUESTION 159You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization named contoso.com. All users have a Personal Archive.

You need to ensure that messages that are older than 90 days are moved from the user's mailbox to theirPersonal Archive.

What should you do?

A. Create a retention tag.

Assign the retention tag to a retention policy.

Apply the retention policy to all users.

B. Create a retention tag.

Assign the retention tag to a retention policy.

Create a journal rule.

C. Create a managed custom folder.

Run the New Managed Content Settings wizard.

Page 129: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Create a journal rule.

D. Run the New Managed Content Settings wizard.

Create a new managed folder mailbox policy.

Apply the policy to all users.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 160You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. All users run Microsoft Office Outlook 2010. You need toprevent internal users from sending email messages that contain the phrase "Internal Private" to external users.

What should you configure?

A. Content filtering.B. Message classifications.C. Outlook protection rules.D. Transport rules.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Exam E

QUESTION 161You have an Exchange Server 2010 SP1 organization.

You need to ensure that all emails sent to User1 are also delivered to the Compliance mailbox.

Which option should you choose?

A. Organization Configuration -> Mailbox.B. Organization Configuration -> Client Access.C. Organization Configuration -> Hub Transport.D. Server Configuration -> Mailbox.E. Server Configuration -> Client Access.F. Server Configuration -> Hub Transport.G. Recipient Configuration -> Mailbox.

Page 130: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

H. Recipient Configuration -> Client Access.I. Recipient Configuration -> Hub Transport.

Correct Answer: GSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 162What command would you use to block messages from servers that are known for sending spam?

A. Test-IPBlockListProvider.B. Set-IPBlockListProvider.C. Add-IPBlockListEntry.D. Set-IPAllowListProvider.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Page 131: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:You use the Add-IPBlockListProvider, Set-IPBlockListProvider, and Remove-IPBlockListProvider cmdlets tomanage the IP Block List Provider services you use in your organization.

The following example adds a new IP Block List provider service called "Contoso IP Block List Provider", andconfigures it to use bitmask matching for 127.0.0.1 (block messages from IP addresses that are on the blocklist):Add-IPBlockListProvider -Name "Contoso IP Block List Provider" -LookupDomain "contoso.com" -BitMaskMatch 127.0.0.1

The following example configures the same IP Block List provider service to use a custom rejection response:Set-IPBlockListProvider "Contoso IP Block List Provider" -RejectionMessage "Your message was rejectedbecause the IP address of the server sending your message is in the block list of contoso.com IP Block List Provider service"

You use the Add-IPBlockListEntry and Remove-IPBlockListEntry cmdlets to manage the addresses in the IPBlock list. You can specify individual IP addresses, IP subnets using the CIDR notation, or IP ranges. Thefollowing example adds the IP address 192.168.0.100 to the IP Block list.Add-IPBlockListEntry -IPAddress 192.168.0.100

QUESTION 163You have an Exchange 2010 SP1 organization with the following configuration:

Server1 - Mailbox , Hub Transport server

Server2 - Client Access server

Server1 holds the public folder database.

Which command would you use first to remove the public folder database?

A. Set-MailboxDatabase.B. Remove-PublicFolder.C. Remove-PublicFolderDatabase.D. Get-MailboxDatabase.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:You have to remove all the public folders from a public folder database before you remove the database.

Remove-PublicFolder -Identity "\My Public Folder" -Recurse: $True Then, before you remove the database youmust make sure it is not the default public folder database for the mailbox database. If so, you must set anotheras default before removing it.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa997202.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd876883.aspx

QUESTION 164

Page 132: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You deploy a Monitor Server named SrvApp1.

You want to allow the server to send notification emails to an administrator through the relay domain.

Which option should you use?

A. A Hub Transport rule.B. A Send connector.C. A Receive connector.D. An Edge Subscription.E. An accepted domain.F. A remote domain.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:We have a server that will need to send emails to an external administrator. We would have to build a Receiveconnector for use by that server.

Reference:

http://exchangeserverpro.com/how-to-configure-a-relay-connector-for-exchange-server-2010

QUESTION 165You need to ensure that 10 new room mailboxes automatically accept meeting requests.

Which cmdlet should you run?

A. Set-CalendarNotification.B. Set-CalendarProcessing.C. Set-MailboxAutoReplyConfiguration.D. Set-MailboxCalendarConfiguration .

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-CalendarProcessing -Identity "Conf 212" -AutomateProcessing AutoAccept -DeleteComments $true -AddOrganizerToSubject $true -AllowConflicts $false

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd335046.aspx

QUESTION 166You have an Exchange Server 2003 organization. You install a new Exchange Server 2010 server in theorganization.

You need to ensure that you can modify the default email address policy by using the Exchange ManagementConsole (EMC).

What should you do?

Page 133: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Run the Set-EmailAddressPolicy cmdlet.B. Run the Update-EmailAddressPolicy cmdlet.C. From the Exchange System Manager, modify the properties of the default recipient policy.D. From the EMC, select the Email Address Policies tab, right-click Default Policy, and then click Apply.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:When going from Exchange 2003 to Exchange 2010, you'll want to upgrade the default email address policy.To do so, you must run the following command:

Set-EmailAddressPolicy "Default Policy" -IncludedRecipients AllRecipients

Once upgraded, you'll be able to use the EMC to manage it.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd351283.aspx

QUESTION 167You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack1 (SP1) installed.

You need to add a delegate to a room mailbox.

What should you do from the properties of the mailbox?

A. Configure the Resource Information settings.B. Configure the Resource Out-of-Policy Requests settings.C. Configure the Account settings.D. Configure the Mailbox Features settings.E. Configure the Resource Policy settings.F. Configure the Resource In-Policy settings.G. Enable the Resource Booking Attendant.H. Configure the Mail Flow settings.

Correct Answer: ESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 134: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 168You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack1 (SP1) installed.

You need to ensure that a user can use a .pst file to access all of the email messages in a mailbox stored in arecovery database.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the New-MailboxExportRequest cmdlet.B. Create a retention policy and rentention tag.C. From the properties of the mailbox database, select the This database can be overwritten by a restore

check box.D. From the properties of the mailbox, enable single item recovery.E. From the properties of the mailbox server, modify the System Settings.F. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Export-Mailbox cmdlet.G. From the properties of the mailbox database, modify the maintenance schedule.H. From the properties of the mailbox, enable retention hold.I. From the properties of the mailbox database, modify the Deletion Settings.

Page 135: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

J. From the Exchange Management Shell, run Set-MailboxDatabase -DumpsterStatistics $true.K. Create a managed custom folder and managed content settings.L. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the New-MailboxSearch cmdlet.M. From the properties of the mailbox, enable litigation hold.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:New-MailboxExportRequest -Mailbox AylaKol -FilePath \\MBX-01\PSTFileShare\Ayla_Recovered.pst

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ff459227.aspx

QUESTION 169You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack1 (SP1) installed.

You create a retention policy and apply the policy to all of the mailboxes in the organization.

You need to prevent the retention policy from being applied to a user named User1.

What should you do?

A. Create a Retention Policy Tag that uses the Personal Folders tag type.B. Modify the management role groups.C. Run the get-retentionpolicytag | set-retentionpolicytag -retentionenabled $false command.D. Run the set-mailbox -identity 'user1' -retentionholdenabled $true command.E. Modify the User Role Assignment Policy.F. Run the set-retentionpolicytag -identity 'never delete' -type Personal command.G. Run the set-mailbox -identity 'user1' -singleitemrecoveryenabled $true command.H. Run the set-retentionpolicytag -identity 'never delete' -type all command.I. Create a Retenetion Policy Tag that uses the All other folders tag type.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123981.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd335168.aspx

QUESTION 170You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack1 (SP1) installed. All servers run Windows Server 2008 R2.

The organization contains Mailbox servers, Client Access servers, and Hub Transport servers only.

You need to identify why a server on the Internet rejects email messages sent from users in the organization.

Page 136: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

What should you do?

A. Review the connectivity logs.B. Run the Exchange Server User Monitor (ExMon).C. Run the Get-MailboxFolderStatistics cmdlet.D. Modify the Log Settings from the properties of the Hub Transport server.E. Review the Application event log.F. Run the Set-AdminAuditLogConfig cmdlet.G. Run the Set-EventLogLevel cmdlet.H. Run the Get-User cmdlet.I. Modify the Server Diagnostic Logging Properties.J. Run the Exchange Best Practices Analyzer.K. Enable SMTP protocol logging.L. Run the Get-MailboxStatistics cmdlet.

Correct Answer: KSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124531.aspx

QUESTION 171You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to ensure that items in a user's Inbox folder that are older than 60 days are moved to a custom folder.

What should you do first?

A. Create a managed custom folder.

Create a transport rule.

B. Create a new mail folder by using Microsoft Office Outlook.

Create a journal rule.

C. Create a managed custom folder.

Run the Managed Content Settings wizard from the Inbox managed default folder.

D. Create a new mail folder by using Microsoft Office Outlook.

Run the Managed Content Settings wizard from the Inbox managed default folder.

Page 137: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ee364744.aspx

http://blogs.perficient.com/microsoft/2008/08/exchange-2007-and-unified-messaging-retention-policies/

New-ManagedFolder -Name 'Business Critical' -FolderName 'Business Critical' -StorageQuota '10Gb' -Comment 'Messages in this folder are retained for 3 years' -MustDisplayComment $true

Page 138: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 172You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to prevent internal users from sending messages that contain the phrase "Company Confidential" toexternal users.

What should you create? (Choose two options).

A. A Hub Transport rule.B. A Managed Folder Mailbox policy.C. A message classification.D. A Send connector.E. A Receive connector.F. An Edge Transport rule.

Correct Answer: ACSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124737.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd351127.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123498.aspx

QUESTION 173You have an Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox server. All users use Microsoft Office Outlook 2010 to access theirmailboxes. You implement a policy that automatically deletes email messages that are older than 90 days.

You need to provide users with an alternate location to store email messages that are older than 90 days.

Page 139: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Administrators must be able to find the messages in both locations when they perform multi-mailbox searches.

What should you create?

A. A .pst file for each user that is stored in a shared folder.B. An archive mailbox for each user.C. A journal rule.D. A retention policy.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd979795.aspx

QUESTION 174You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. Users on the network use HTTPS to connect to Outlook WebAccess (OWA). The Client Access Server uses a certificate issued by an internal certification authority (CA).

You plan to deploy an email encryption solution for all users. You need to ensure that users can send andreceive encrypted email messages by using S/MIME from OWA.

What should you do?

A. Issue a certificate to each user.B. Instruct all OWA users to import a root CA certificate.C. Modify the authentication settings of the OWA virtual directory.D. Configure the Client Access server to use a certificate issued by a third party CA.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb738140.aspx

QUESTION 175Your company has an Exchange Server 2010 Hub Transport server named Hub1. Hub1 receives all email sentto the company from the Internet. You install the antispam agents on Hub1.

You need to ensure that Hub1 only accepts messages sent to email addresses listed in Active Directory.

What should you do?

A. Modify the properties of the Sender Filtering agent.B. Modify the properties of the Recipient Filtering agent.C. Modify the properties of the default accepted domain.D. Modify the properties of the default Receive connector.

Page 140: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123891.aspx

QUESTION 176You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to configure the organization so that it rejects all e-mail messages that have a spam confidence level(SCL) that is greater than 7.

What should you configure?

A. Content filtering.B. Recipient filtering.C. Sender filtering.

Page 141: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

D. Sender reputation.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Refence:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa995744.aspx

QUESTION 177You have an Exchange organization that contains Exchange 2000 servers and Exchange Server 2003 ServicePack 2 (SP2) servers.

You plan to transition the organization to Exchange Server 2010. You need to prepare the Exchangeorganization for the deployment of Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox, Client Access, and Hub Transport servers.

What should you do first?

A. Install the Active Directory Connector (ADC).B. Delete all Recipient Update Service (RUS) objects.C. Deploy an Exchange Server 2010 Edge Transport server.D. Remove all Exchange 2000 servers from the organization.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Exchange 2000 is not supported in an Exchange 2010 organization.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa998604.aspx

QUESTION 178You have an Active Directory forest that contains three sites named Site1, Site2, and Site3. Each site containstwo Exchange Server 2007 Client Access servers, two Mailbox servers, and two Hub Transport servers. AllExchange Server 2007 servers have Exchange Server 2007 Service Pack 1 (SP1) installed.

Page 142: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You need to ensure that you can deploy Exchange Server 2010 servers in Site1. You must achieve this goal byusing the minimum amount of administrative effort.

What should you do?

A. Upgrade all Client Access servers in the organization to Exchange Server 2007 Service Pack 2 (SP2).B. Upgrade all Exchange Server 2007 servers in Site1 to Exchange Server 2007 Service Pack 2 (SP2).C. Upgrade all Exchange Server 2007 servers in the organization to Exchange Server 2007 Service Pack 2

(SP2).D. Upgrade all Exchange Server 2007 servers in Site1 and all Client Access servers in the organization to

Exchange Server 2007 Service Pack 2 (SP2).

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:The key to this question is the fact that you must use the minimum amount of administrative effort. MicrosoftTechnet therefore gives us the answer, as follows:

The Client Access server role can co-exist with Exchange 2007 Client Access servers. Before you upgrade thefirst Active Directory site, you must install Exchange 2007 Service Pack 2 (SP2) on all Exchange 2007 ClientAccess servers within your organization.

You can add an Exchange 2010 Hub Transport server to an existing Exchange organization after yousuccessfully deploy Exchange 2010 Client Access servers. After you introduce Exchange 2010 Hub Transportservers to your Exchange 2007 environment, you still need to maintain your Exchange 2007 Hub Transportservers. Exchange 2010 Mailbox servers can only communicate with Exchange 2010 Hub Transport servers,and Exchange 2007 Mailbox servers can only communicate with Exchange 2007 Hub Transport servers. Whena message is sent from a mailbox on an Exchange 2010 Mailbox server to a mailbox on an Exchange 2007Mailbox server, the message is first submitted to the closest Exchange 2010 Hub Transport server in the site.This server then relays the message to an Exchange 2007 Hub Transport server in the same site, which finallydelivers the message to the Exchange 2007 Mailbox server.

The Exchange 2010 Mailbox server role can co-exist with Exchange 2007 Mailbox servers.

You can replicate public folder data between Exchange 2010 and Exchange 2007 public folder databases.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd638158.aspx

QUESTION 179You have a server that runs Windows Server 2008 R2. You plan to install Exchange Server 2010 on the server.

You need to install the Exchange Server 2010 pre-requisites for the Unified Messaging (UM), Mailbox, ClientAccess, and Hub Transport server roles.

What should you run?

A. Setup.com /AnswerFile:Exchange-All.xml.B. Setup.com /Roles:HT, MB, UM, CA, MT.C. ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP Exchange-All.xml.D. ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP Exchange-CADB.xml.

Correct Answer: C

Page 143: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Section: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb691354.aspxhttp://exchangeserverpro.com/installing-exchange-server-2010-pre-requisites-on-windows-server-2008-r2

QUESTION 180You have a computer that runs Windows 7.

You need to install the Exchange 2010 management tools on the computer.

What should you do first?

A. Install the telnet client.B. Run the Exchange Best Practices Analyzer.C. Set the Net.TCP Port Sharing service to Automatic.D. Install Microsoft .NET Framework 3.5.1 and the Internet Information Services (IIS) 6.0 Management

console.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb691354.aspx

QUESTION 181You have an Exchange organization that contains the Exchange servers shown in the following table:

You plan to move all mailboxes from Server2 to Server3. You need to ensure that all users can send andreceive email messages after their mailboxes are moved to Server3.

What should you do?

A. Install the Exchange Server 2010 Hub Transport server role.B. Install the Exchange Server 2010 Edge Transport server role.C. Remove all Exchange Server 2003 servers.D. Remove the Exchange Server 2003 front-end server. Install a new Exchange Server 2010 Client Access

server.

Page 144: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa998604.aspx

QUESTION 182You have an Exchange organization. The Exchange servers in the organization are configured as shown in thefollowing table:

You deploy a new Exchange Server 2010 Client Access server named Server4 and successfully update therequired DNS records for Server4.

You need to ensure that all users on Server3 can successfully access their mailboxes by using ExchangeActiveSync.

What should you do?

A. On Server1, set the authentication type for the Microsoft-Server-ActiveSync virtual directory to IntegratedWindows Authentication.

B. On Server1, set the authentication type for the Microsoft-Server-ActiveSync virtual directory to anonymous.C. From the Exchange Management Shell on Server4, run New-ActiveSyncDeviceAccessRule - QueryString *

-Characteristic DeviceModel -AccessLevel Allow.D. From the Exchange Management Shell on Server3, run Set-ActiveSyncVirtualDirectory -Identity "Server3\

Microsoft-Server-ActiveSync (default web site)" -Basicauthentication:$true.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://blogs.technet.com/b/exchange/archive/2009/11/20/3408856.aspx

QUESTION 183You have an Exchange Server 2010 server that has the Mailbox, Hub Transport, and Client Access server rolesinstalled.

You need to ensure that users can send and receive email by using Windows Live Mail or Microsoft OutlookExpress.

What should you do on the server?

A. Install and then configure the SMTP server feature.B. Start the Microsoft Exchange POP3 service and then set the startup type to Automatic.

Page 145: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. Modify the properties of the MSExchangePOP3 (TCP-in) Windows Firewall rule.D. Modify the properties of the MSExchangeMailSubmission - RPC (TCP-in) Windows Firewall rule.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:By default, POP3 is set to manual.

QUESTION 184You have an Exchange Server 2010 server named Server1. Server1 hosts a mailbox database named DB1that contains 25 user mailboxes. You create a new public folder database named PUB2.

You need to configure PUB2 as the default public folder database for each mailbox on DB1.

Which properties should you modify?

A. Modify the properties of each mailbox.B. Modify the properties of DB1.C. Modify the properties of Server1.D. Modify the properties of PUB2.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb629522.aspx

QUESTION 185You have an Exchange Server 2010 server that has a single mailbox database named DB1.

You need to move the transaction log files of DB1.

Page 146: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Which cmdlet should you run?

A. Move-DatabasePath.B. Movemailbox.C. Set-ExchangeServer.D. Set-MailboxDatabase.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd351168.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124742.aspx

QUESTION 186You have an Exchange Server 2010 server named Server1. Server1 has a single mailbox database namedDB1. You configure deleted items to be retained for 30 days.

You need to ensure that each item that passes the retention period is removed daily between 2:00 and 6:00.

What should you do?

A. Run the Set-RetentionPolicy cmdlet.B. Run the Start-ManagedFolderAssistant cmdlet.C. Modify the maintenance schedule for DB1.D. Modify the messaging records management (MRM) schedule for Server1.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

In the question it says nothing about a Retention policy. To configure deleted items to be retained for 30 dayswe can do it on a database level, using this cmdlet:

Set-MailboxDatabase -Identity "DB1" -DeletedItemRetention 30.00:00:00

And after the above, configure the maintenance of DB1 using the Set-MailboxDatabase cmdlet with the -MaintenanceSchedule parameter.

QUESTION 187You have an Exchange Server 2010 server named Server1. Server1 has a single mailbox database namedDB1 that contains 300 mailboxes.

You need to ensure that a warning message is issued when a mailbox exceeds 2 GB. The solution must usethe minimum amount of administrative effort.

What should you do?

A. From the properties of DB1, configure options on the Limits tab.

Page 147: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

B. From the properties of each mailbox, modify the storage quotas.C. From the properties of Server1, configure options on the Messaging Records Management tab.D. From Managed Default Folders, modify the properties of the Entire Mailbox managed folder.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd297937.aspx

QUESTION 188You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains 1,500 mailboxes. The average size of eachmailbox is a 750 MB. All users run either Microsoft Office Outlook 2010 or Outlook Web App to access theiremail. All users who run Outlook 2010 are configured to use Cached Exchange Mode.

You need to configure a mailbox solution for the organization to meet the following requirements:

Ensure that administrators can search and find any message.

Reduce the size of the offline store (OST) for each user.

Provide access to all email messages by using either Outlook 2010 or Outlook Web App.

What should you do?

A. Create a Personal Archive for each user and then create a retention policy. Instruct users to compact theOST file.

Page 148: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

B. Create a personal folder (PST) file for each user. Store all PST files on a network share. Instruct users tocompact the OST file.

C. Create a second disabled user account and a second mailbox for each user. Configure journal rules tojournal all the messages for each user to the user's second mailbox.

D. Create a new disabled user account and a new mailbox named Journaling Mailbox.

Configure journal rules to journal all the messages for each user to Journaling Mailbox.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:There is only one possible answer to this: it cannot be a PST or a disabled user because access must beavailable from OWA.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd979795.aspx

Cached Exchange Mode saves a copy of your mailbox on your computer which provides quick access to yourdata and is frequently updated with the server that runs Microsoft Exchange.

QUESTION 189You have an Exchange Server 2007 organization. You install a new Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox server.

You need to move all mailboxes to the Exchange Server 2010 server.

What are two possible ways to achieve this goal? (Each correct answer presents a complete solution.Choose two).

A. From the Exchange Server 2007 Exchange Management Shell, run the Movemailbox cmdlet.B. From the Exchange Server 2010 Exchange Management Shell, run the New-MoveRequest cmdletC. From the Exchange Server 2007 Exchange Management Console (EMC), run the Move Mailbox wizard.D. From the Exchange Server 2010 Exchange Management Console (EMC), run the New Local Move Request

wizard.

Correct Answer: BDSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 149: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

When moving mailboxes, consider the following:

You can't use the Exchange System Manager or Active Directory Users and Computers to move

mailboxes from Microsoft Exchange Server 2003 to Exchange Server 2010. You can't use the Movemailboxcmdlet in Exchange Server 2007 to move mailboxes from Exchange

2007 to Exchange 2010.When you move mailboxes, users won't be able to view their message tracking information.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd298174.aspx

QUESTION 190You have an Active Directory domain named contoso.com. You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.You have a server named Server1 that runs Windows Server 2008 R2 and has the Exchange 2010management tools and Microsoft Office Outlook 2010 installed.

A support technician named User1 performs management tasks on Server1. From the Exchange ManagementShell on Server1, User1 runs Export-Mailbox Identity [email protected] PSTFolderPath E:\PSTFiles\User2.pst and receives the following error message: "The term `Export- Mailbox' is not recognized as thename of a cmdlet, function, script, or operable program. Check the spelling of the name, or if a path wasincluded, verify that the path is correct and try again."

You need to ensure that User1 can successfully run the command.

Page 150: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

What should you do?

A. Assign User1 the Mailbox Import Export role.B. Assign User1 Full Access permissions for the mailbox of User2.C. Add User1 to the Recipient Management security group.D. Add User1 to the View-Only Organization Management security group.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:New-ManagementRoleAssignment -Name "Import Export_Enterprise Support" -SecurityGroup "EnterpriseSupport" -Role "Mailbox Import Export"

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ee633452.aspx

QUESTION 191You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to ensure that users in the organization are notified before they send email messages to externalrecipients.

Which cmdlet should you run?

A. Set-Mailbox.B. Set-OrganizationConfig.C. Set-TransportAgent.D. Set-TransportConfig.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:You would run the following command:

Set-OrganizationConfig -MailTipsExternalRecipientsTipsEnabled $true.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd638109

QUESTION 192You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. You need to create Personal Archives.

Which tool should you use?

A. Active Directory Users and Computers.B. The Exchange Control Panel (ECP).C. The Exchange Management Console (EMC).D. Microsoft Office Outlook.

Page 151: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 193You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

A user named User1 connects to his mailbox using Microsoft Office Outlook. User1 reports that he is unable tosend encrypted email messages to an external recipient named User2. You verify that User1 and User2 haveemail encryption certificates. You need to ensure that User1 can send encrypted email messages to User2.

What should you do first?

A. Instruct User2 to add a delegate.B. Instruct User2 to send a signed email message to User1.C. Instruct User1 to send a signed email message to User2.D. Instruct User1 to modify the sensitivity settings of the email message.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 194You have an Exchange Server 2010 Edge Transport server named Server1.

A partner organization has an Exchange Server 2010 Edge Transport server named Server2.

You need to encrypt SMTP communication between Server1 and Server2. The solution must ensure that bothservers use a trusted certificate.

What should you do?

A. Enable Domain Security authentication.B. Enable Exchange Server authentication.C. Enable Externally Secured authentication.D. Disable the Anonymous users permission group.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

http://www.msexchange.org/articles_tutorials/exchange-server-2010/security-message-hygiene/exchange-2010-domain-security-part1.html

QUESTION 195Your company has an Exchange Server 2010 organization. The network contains an internal root certificationauthority (CA).

Page 152: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You plan to add a disclaimer to all email messages sent by users in the company. You need to ensure that thedisclaimer can be added to encrypted email messages.

What should you do?

A. Instruct users to encrypt email messages by using IRM only.B. Instruct users to encrypt email messages by using S/MIME only.C. Enable the Content Filter agent on all of the Hub Transport servers.D. Modify the priority of the Transport Rule agent on all of the Hub Transport servers.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 196Your company has an Exchange Server 2010 Hub Transport server named Hub1. Hub1 receives all of theemail sent to the company from the Internet.

You install antispam agents on Hub1. You need to ensure that Hub1 only accepts messages sent to emailaddresses listed in Active Directory.

What should you modify?

A. The antispam settings of Hub1.B. The antispam settings of the organization.C. The email address policy of the organization.D. The properties of Hub1's default Receive connector.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 153: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 197You install a new Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains a single server named Server1. Usersreport that they receive a large number of unsolicited commercial email (UCE) messages.

You need to reduce the amount of UCE messages that the users in the organization receive.

What should you do?

A. Run the AntispamCommon.ps1 script.B. Run the InstallAntispamAgents.ps1 script.C. Run the Set-ContentFilterConfig -Enabled $true command.D. Run the Set-TransportServer -AntispamAgentsEnabled $true command.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 198

Page 154: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You have an Exchange 2010 Edge Transport server named Server1.

You discover that antispam updates have not been applied to Server1 for one month.

You need to ensure that the most current antispam updates are installed on Server1.

What should you do?

A. At the command prompt, run the Wuauclt.exe /DetectNow command.B. At the command prompt, run the Wuauclt.exe /SelfUpdateManaged command.C. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Get-AntispamUpdates cmdlet.D. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Enable-AntispamUpdates -UpdateMode Automatic

command.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 199You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

A user named User1 reports that many of the email messages sent to him from the Internet are not delivered tohis mailbox.

You suspect that the email messages are incorrectly identified as spam.

You need to temporarily disable antispam filtering for all email messages sent to User1.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-Mailbox cmdlet.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-TransportConfig cmdlet.C. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the content filtering properties.D. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the recipient filtering properties.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-Mailbox -Identity John -AntispamBypassEnabled $true

QUESTION 200You have a computer that runs Windows 7.

You need to ensure that you can install the Exchange 2010 management tools on the computer.

Which two actions should you perform? (Each correct presents part of the solution. Choose two).

A. Install Microsoft .NET Framework 3.5.1.B. Install Microsoft Message Queue (MSMQ) Server.C. Install the Internet Information Services (IIS) 6.0 Management console.

Page 155: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

D. Set the Net.TCP Port Sharing service to Automatic.E. Set the Net.TCP Port Sharing service to Automatic (Delayed start).

Correct Answer: ACSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Exam F

QUESTION 201You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com.

You need to ensure that a room mailbox automatically accepts meeting requests.

What should you do?

A. Modify the mailbox permissions.B. Enable moderation for the mailbox.C. Assign a managed folder mailbox policy.D. Enable the Resource Booking Attendant.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 156: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 202You have an Exchange 2010 organization. The organization contains a distribution group named Group1.

You need to ensure that a user named User1 can add and remove members from Group1. You must preventUser1 from modifying all other groups.

What should you do first?

A. Add User1 to Group1's Managed by list.B. Assign User1 as a group moderator for Group1.C. Assign the Distributions Groups management role to User1.D. Assign the MyDistributionGroups management role to User1.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 157: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 203You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization named contoso.com. All users configure internal and externalOut Of Office messages.

You need to ensure that internal Out Of Office messages are sent to senders from the fabrikam.com domain.

What should you create and configure?

A. A new accepted domain.B. A new Receive connector.C. A new remote domain.D. A new Send connector.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 158: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 204You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization named contoso.com. Your company acquires a companynamed Fabrikam, Inc.

You plan to create new mailboxes for each user from Fabrikam. You need to ensure that each new mailbox canreceive email messages sent to fabrikam.com. The solution must not prevent the organization from receivingemails sent to contoso.com.

What should you do?

A. Create an accepted domain and then create a new email address policy.B. Create a remote domain and then modify the default email address policy.C. Create a Receive connector and then create a managed folder mailbox policy.D. Modify the default accepted domain and then modify the default email address policy.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 205You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

Your network contains an Edge Transport server named Edge1 and a Hub Transport server named Hub1. Youconfigure EdgeSync synchronization between Hub1 and Edge1.

Page 159: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A month later, you install a second Hub Transport server named Hub2 in the same Active Directory site.

You need to ensure that Edge1 synchronizes information from Hub1 and Hub2.What should you do?

A. Create a new subscription file and then import the new subscription file to Hub1 and Hub2.B. Remove the Edge Subscription from Edge1 and then run the ImportEdgeConfig.ps1 script on Hub2.C. Copy the subscription file from Hub1 to Hub2 and then run the New-EdgeSubscription cmdlet on Hub2.D. Move Hub2 to a separate Active Directory site. Create a new subscription file on Edge1 and then run the

New-EdgeSubscription cmdlet on Hub2.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:B is incorrect as the ImportEdgeConfig.ps1 script creates a clone of the Edge Transport server. C is incorrectas we need to create a new subscription file before we can copy it to Hub2. (If we use the old file, it won't work.There is a TTL of 24 hours that would have expired by now). D is incorrect because Edge Transport serverscan only be associated with one AD site at a time.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa997438 (there is a note about 3/4 down the article that mentionsthis as the correct step).

QUESTION 206You have an Exchange Server 2003 organization. You install an Exchange Server 2010 Edge Transport serveron the network.

You need to ensure that the Edge Transport server can send and receive email messages from the Internet forthe organization.

You configure the Exchange Server 2003 servers to send all emails for external recipients to the EdgeTransport servers.

What should you do next?

A. Create and configure a sharing policy.B. Install the Exchange Server 2010 schema extensions.C. Create an Edge Subscription file. Copy the file to the Exchange Server 2003 servers.D. Create and configure a Send connector on the Edge Transport server. Create and configure a Receive

connector on the Edge Transport server.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124011.aspx

QUESTION 207You have an Exchange 2010 organization named contoso.com. The organization contains two servers namedServer1 and Server2.

Page 160: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Server1 has the Client Access, Hub Transport, and Mailbox server roles installed. Server2 has the EdgeTransport server role installed.

You need to verify whether Server2 successfully replicates recipient data and configuration information fromServer1.What should you do?

A. From Server2, run the Test-ReplicationHealth cmdlet.B. From Server2, run the Get-OrganizationConfig cmdlet.C. From Server1, run the Test-EdgeSynchronization cmdlet.D. From Server1, run the Get-EdgeSyncServiceConfig cmdlet.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa996925.aspx

QUESTION 208You install an Exchange Server 2010 Hub Transport server named Hub1.

You need to ensure that Hub1 can receive email messages sent from Internet hosts.

What should you do?

A. Enable the Anonymous users permission group for the Client Hub1 Receive connector.B. Enable the Anonymous users permission group for the Default Hub1 Receive connector.C. Create a Receive connector and set the intended use to Client. Modify the port for the connector.D. Create a Receive connector and set the intended use to Custom. Modify the remote IP addresses range for

the connector.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Reference:

Page 161: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb738138.aspx

QUESTION 209You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization named contoso.com that contains a mail-enabled groupnamed Group1.

Users from outside the organization report that email messages sent to [email protected] generate a non-delivery report (NDR).

You need to ensure that users outside the organization can successfully send email to group1 @ contoso.com.

What should you modify?

A. The authentication settings for the Client Receive connector.B. The message delivery restrictions for Group1.C. The moderation settings for Group1.D. The remote IP address range for the Client Receive connector.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 210You need to modify the Exchange-specific cost for a site link named Link1.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-ADSite cmdlet.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-ADSiteLink cmdlet.C. From the Active Directory Sites and Services snap-in, create a site link bridge.D. From the Active Directory Sites and Services snap-in, modify the properties of Link1.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-AdSiteLink -Identity Link1 -ExchangeCost 10

Page 162: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb266946.aspx

QUESTION 211You have an Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox server that contains multiple mailbox databases.

You need to ensure that you receive an email alert if the volume that contains the mailbox database files hasless than 25 percent of free space.

What should you do?

A. Create a new Data Collector Set.B. Create a new Event Viewer Subscription.C. Attach a new task to the Application event log.D. Modify the properties of the mailbox database objects.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 212You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

An internal user named User1 sends a message to another internal user named User2. User1 does not haveany administrative privileges in the organization. User1 needs to identify whether the message was successfullydelivered.

What should you instruct User1 to do?

A. Open Outlook Web App and then click Options.B. Open Microsoft Outlook and then run Office Diagnostics.C. Install the Exchange 2010 management tools and then run the Get-MessageTrackingReport cmdlet.D. Install the Exchange 2010 management tools and then run the Search-MessageTrackingReport cmdlet.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://help.outlook.com/en-gb/140/bb847825.aspx

Page 163: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 213You deploy a new Exchange Server 2010 organization. You send a test message to an external recipient andimmediately receive the following non-delivery report (NDR):

"Delivery has failed to these recipients or groups: [email protected] ([email protected]). The recipient'semail system isn't accepting messages now. Please try resending this message later or contact the recipientdirectly."

You verify that you can successfully send an email message to [email protected] from an external emailsystem.

You need to ensure that you can send emails to external recipients from within the Exchange organization.

What should you create?

A. A Send connector.B. An accepted domain.C. An MX record.D. An SMTP site link.

Correct Answer: A

Page 164: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Section: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb232045.aspx

QUESTION 214You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. You install a new Client Access server in the organization.

You need to verify whether users can access the new Client Access server by using Outlook Web App.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Best Practices Analyzer, run a baseline scan.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Test-OwaConnectivity cmdlet.C. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), examine the properties of the default Outlook Web App

mailbox policy.D. From the Internet Information Services (IIS) Manager, view the session state settings for the Outlook Web

Access virtual directory.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/aa997682.aspx

QUESTION 215You have an Exchange Server 2010 server named Server1.

You need to verify whether users can connect to Server1 by using Outlook Anywhere.

What should you do?

A. Run the Mail Flow Troubleshooter.B. Run the Test-OWAConnectivity cmdlet.C. Run the Exchange Remote Connectivity Analyzer.D. Review the properties of the WEB Outlook Provider.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 165: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 216You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to view a list of mailboxes on all servers that are larger than 1 GB.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Get-Mailbox cmdlet.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Get-MailboxStatistics cmdlet.C. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), create a recipient filter.D. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), view the properties of the mailbox database.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 217You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to determine why a remote SMTP server rejects email sent from your organization.

What should you do?

Page 166: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Review the application event logs.B. Review the message tracking logs.C. Set the Protocol logging level to Verbose on the Receive connectors and then review the protocol log files.D. Set the Protocol logging level to Verbose on the Send connectors and then review the protocol log files.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Protocol logging records the SMTP conversations that occur between email servers as part of messagedelivery. These SMTP conversations occur on Send connectors and Receive connectors configured on serversrunning Microsoft Exchange Server 2010 that have the Hub Transport server role or the Edge Transport serverrole installed. You can use protocol logging to diagnose mail flow problems.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124531.aspx

QUESTION 218Your network contains an Active Directory forest that contains one domain.

You plan to delegate the installation of an Exchange Server 2010 server to an external consultant namedUser1. User1 is a member of the Server Operators group and the Account Operators group only.

You need to ensure that User1 can install the Exchange Server 2010 server in the forest.

What should you run from the Exchange Server 2010 installation media?

A. Setup /PrepareAD.B. Setup /PrepareDomain.C. Setup /PrepareLegacyPermissions.D. Setup /PrepareSchema.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:PrepareAD will run preparelegacyexchangepermissions and prepareschema if it detects they have not beenrun.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb125224.aspx

QUESTION 219You plan to deploy an Exchange Server 2010 Client Access server on a new server. The server will be amember of a database availability group (DAG).

You need to identify the operating system required for the planned deployment. The solution must minimizesoftware costs.

Which operating system should you identify?

Page 167: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Windows Server 2008 R2 Foundation.B. Windows Server 2008 R2 Standard.C. Windows Server 2008 Service Pack 2 (SP2) Enterprise.D. Windows Server 2008 Service Pack 2 (SP2) Web.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:DAGs use Windows Failover Clustering technology, and as a result, they require the Enterprise version ofWindows.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd638104.aspx#SoftReq

QUESTION 220You have an Exchange organization that contains the Exchange servers shown in the following table:

You plan to move all mailboxes from Server2 and Server3 to Server4.

You need to ensure that all users can send and receive email messages after their mailboxes are moved toServer4.

What should you do?

A. Create an SMTP Site link.B. Create a Routing Group and a Routing Group Connector.C. Install the Exchange Server 2010 Hub Transport server role on Server4.D. Install the Exchange Server 2010 Edge Transport server role on a new server.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd638130.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124350.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/gg232715.aspx

QUESTION 221You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to configure the organization to reject all email messages that have a spam confidence level (SCL)

Page 168: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

that is greater than 7.

What should you configure?

A. Content filtering.B. Recipient filtering.C. Sender filtering.D. Sender reputation.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 222You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack1 (SP1) installed

You need to ensure that an administrator can recover hard-deleted email messages from a user's mailboxindefinitely.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the New-MailboxSearch cmdlet.B. From the properties of the mailbox, enable retention hold.C. From the properties of the mailbox, enable litigation hold.D. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the New-MailboxExportRequest cmdlet.E. Create a managed custom folder and manager content settings.F. From the properties of the mailbox database, modify the Deletion Settings.G. From the properties of the mailbox, enable single item recovery.H. Create a retention policy and a renetion tag.I. From the properties of the mailbox database, select the This database can be overwritten by a restore

check box.J. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Export-Mailbox cmdlet.K. From the Exchange Management Shell run Set-MailboxDatabase -DumpsterStatistics $true cmdlet.L. From the properties of a Mailbox server, modify the System Settings.M. From the properties of the mailbox database, modify the maintenance schedule.

Page 169: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 223You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack(SP1) installed.

You need to ensure that a user can use a .pst file to access all of the email messages in a mailbox stored in arecovery database.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the New-MailboxExportRequest cmdlet.B. Create a retention policy and rentention tag.C. From the properties of the mailbox database, select the This database can be overwritten by a restore

check box.D. From the properties of the mailbox, enable single item recovery.E. From the properties of the mailbox server, modify the System Settings.F. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Export-Mailbox cmdlet.G. From the properties of the mailbox database, modify the maintenance schedule.H. From the properties of the mailbox, enable retention hold.

Page 170: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

I. From the properties of the mailbox database, modify the Deletion Settings.J. From the Exchange Management Shell, run Set-MailboxDatabase -DumpsterStatistics $true.K. Create a manager custom folder and managed content settings.L. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the New-MailboxSearch cmdlet.M. From the properties of the mailbox, enable litigation hold.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 224You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack(SP1) installed.

You create a retention policy and apply the policy to all of the mailboxes in the organization.

You need to ensure that users can use personal tags that are not linked to the retention policy.

What should you do?

A. Create a Retention Policy Tag that uses the Personal Folders tag type.B. Modify the management role groups.C. Run the get-retentionpolicytag | set-retentionpolicytag -retentionenabled $false command.D. Run the set-mailbox -identity 'user1' -retentionholdenabled $true command.E. Modify the User Role Assignment Policy.F. Run the set-retentionpolicytag -identity 'never delete' -type Personal command.G. Run the set-mailbox -identity 'user1' -singleitemrecoveryenabled $true.H. Run the set-retentionpolicytag -identity 'never delete' -type all.I. Create a Retenetion Policy Tag that uses the All other folders tag type.

Correct Answer: ESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Opt-in personal tags:

· Users can use ECP to select additional personal tags not linked to their retention policy.· Needs MyRetentionPolicies role.

Page 171: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd876897.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd297955.aspx

QUESTION 225You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack1 (SP1) installed. All servers run Windows Server 2008 R2.

The organization contains Mailbox servers, Client Access servers, and Hub Transport servers only.

You need to identify why a server on the Internet rejects email messages sent from users in the organization.

What should you do?

A. Review the connectivity logs.B. Run the Exchange Server User Monitor (ExMon).C. Run the Get-MailboxFolderStatistics cmdlet.D. Modify the Log Settings from the properties of the Hub Transport server.

Page 172: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

E. Review the Application event log.F. Run the Set-AdminAuditLogConfig cmdlet.G. Run the Set-EventLogLevel cmdlet.H. Run the Get-User cmdlet.I. Modify the Server Diagnostic Logging Properties.J. Run the Exchange Best Practices Analyzer.K. Enable SMTP protocol logging.L. Run the Get-MailboxStatistics cmdlet.

Correct Answer: KSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124531.aspx

QUESTION 226You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack1 (SP1) installed. All servers run Windows Server 2008 R2.

The organization contains Mailbox servers, Client Access servers, and Hub Transport servers only.

You need to ensure that you can review any changes made by administrators to the Exchange configuration.The solution must identity which administrator performed each change.

What should you do?

A. Review the connectivity logs.B. Run the Exchange Server User Monitor (ExMon).C. Run the Get-MailboxFolderStatistics cmdlet.D. Modify the Log Settings from the properties of the Hub Transport server.E. Review the Application event log.F. Run the Set-AdminAuditLogConfig cmdlet.G. Run the Set-EventLogLevel cmdlet.H. Run the Get-User cmdlet.I. Modify the Server Diagnostic Logging Properties.J. Run the Exchange Best Practices Analyzer.K. Enable SMTP protocol logging.L. Run the Get-MailboxStatistics cmdlet.

Correct Answer: FSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:To configure the cmdlet auditing list, you need to run Set-AdminAuditLogConfig - AdminAuditLogCmdletsfollowed by the cmdlet name to be audited.

For instance, to audit cmdlets that contain the keyword "mailbox" within the cmdlet name, run:

Page 173: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Set-AdminAuditLogConfig -AdminAuditLogCmdlets *mailbox*

Reference:

http://www.exchangeinbox.com/article.aspx?i=151

QUESTION 227You have an Exchange organization. All servers in the organization have Exchange Server 2010 Service Pack1 (SP1) installed.

You need to ensure that an equipment mailbox automatically accepts all meeting requests.

What should you do from the properties of the mailbox?

A. Configure the Resource Information settings.B. Configure the Resource Out-of-Policy Requests settings.C. Configure the Account settings.D. Configure the Mailbox Features settings.E. Configure the Resource Policy settings.F. Configure the Resource In-Policy settings.G. Enable the Resource Booking Attendant.H. Configure the Mail Flow settings.

Correct Answer: GSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 174: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 228You have an Exchange 2010 organization. You have an administrative user named Admin1.

You need to ensure that Admin1 can move mailboxes in the organization. The solution must assign theminimum amount of permissions to Admin1.

What should you do?

A. Create a local move request.B. Create a custom Management role. Assign the role to Admin1.C. Add Admin1 to the Organization Management role group.D. Add Admin1 to the Recipient Management security group.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 175: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 229You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to ensure that all users in the organization can automatically schedule the use of a projector.

What should you do?

A. Create a new sharing policy.B. Create an equipment mailbox.C. Modify the schedule for the Managed Folder Assistant.D. Modify the properties of the Calendar managed default folder.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 230You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. A user reports that some meetings are missing from hercalendar.

You need to recover the missing calendar items. The solution must ensure that the missing calendar items arerecovered automatically.

What should you do?

A. Create and then configure a sharing policy.B. Set the schedule for the Managed Folder Assistant.C. Run the Set-MailboxCalendarConfiguration cmdlet.D. Set the schedule for the Calendar Repair Assistant (CRA).

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:This example sets the CRA to check all mailboxes on the server MBX02 every seven days and to process allcalendars that require repairs every day in that seven day cycle. Set-MailboxServer -Identity MBX02 -CalendarRepairWorkCycle 7.00:00:00 - CalendarRepairWorkCycleCheckpoint 1.00:00:00

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ee633469.aspx

QUESTION 231You have an Exchange organization that contains the Exchange servers shown in the following table:

Server Name Role Version

Server1 Front-end Exchange server 2003 Service Pack2 (SP2)

Server2 Back-end Exchange server 2003 SP2

Server3 Client Access,Mailbox,Hub Transport Exchange Server 2007 Service Pack2 (SP2)

Page 176: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Server4 Client Access,Mailbox Exchange Server 2010

You plan to move all mailboxes from Server2 and Server3 to Server4.

You need to ensure that all users can send and receive email messages after their mailboxes are moved toServer4.

What should you do?

A. Create an SMTP Site link.B. Create a Routing Group and a Routing Group Connector.C. Install the Exchange Server 2010 Hub Transport server role on Server4.D. Install the Exchange Server 2010 Edge Transport server role on a new server.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 232You have two Exchange Server 2010 servers named Server1 and Server2.

Server1 has the Mailbox server role installed. Server2 has the Hub Transport and Client Access server rolesinstalled.

You need to ensure that users can send and receive email using Windows Live Mail or Microsoft OutlookExpress.

What should you do?

A. From the Command Prompt on Server1, run net start MSExchangePOP3.B. From the Command Prompt on Server2, run net start MSExchangePOP3.C. On Server1 and Server2, modify the properties of the MSExchangePOP3 (TCPin) Windows Firewall rule.D. On Server1, modify the properties of the MSExchangeIMAP4 (TCPin) Windows Firewall rule.

On Server2, modify the properties of the Client Receive connector.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 233You have an Active Directory forest named contoso.com.

You install a new Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains a Client Access server named CAS1.

You need to configure certificates in the organization to support the following client connections:

Page 177: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Autodiscover

Outlook Anywhere

Exchange ActiveSync

Your solution must minimize costs.

What should you do?

A. Re-issue a self-signed certificate to CAS1.B. Restore a previous version of the default self-signed certificate to CAS1.C. Issue a trusted certificate that contains a single subject alternate name.D. Issue a trusted certificate that contains multiple subject alternate names.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 234You install a new Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains two Hub Transport servers named Hub1and Hub2.

Hub1 and Hub2 are configured as mail servers for your organization in the public DNS zone.

You notice that Hub2 rejects all SMTP connections from Internet hosts. You need to ensure that Hub2 canreceive email messages sent from Internet hosts.

What should you do?

A. Uninstall the antispam agents from Hub1.B. Install the same trusted public certificate on Hub1 and Hub2.C. Modify the permissions for the Client Hub2 Receive connector.D. Modify the permissions for the Default Hub2 Receive connector.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 235Your network contains an Active Directory forest. All domain controllers run Windows Server 2008.

You need to ensure that you can install an Exchange Server 2010 server in the Active Directory forest.What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Server 2010 installation media, run setup /ps.

Page 178: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

B. From the Exchange Server 2010 installation media, run setup /NewProvisionedServer.C. From the Windows Server 2008 installation media, run adprep.exe /forestprep.D. From the Windows Server 2008 installation media, run adprep.exe /domainprep.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 236You plan to deploy Exchange Server 2010 on a new server. The server will be a member of a databaseavailability group (DAG).

You need to identify the operating system that can be installed on the server to support Exchange Server 2010.Your solution must minimize costs.

Which operating system should you identify?

A. Windows Server 2003 R2 Standard Edition.B. Windows Server 2008 R2 Standard Edition.C. Windows Server 2003 Service Pack 2 (SP2) Enterprise Edition.D. Windows Server 2008 Service Pack 2 (SP2) Enterprise Edition.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 237Your Exchange Server 2010 organization contains several Mailbox servers. You need to identify the messagelatency between the Mailbox servers.

What should you do?

A. Run the Test-Mailflow cmdlet.B. Run the Test-OutlookConnectivity cmdlet.C. Increase the MSExchangeTransport diagnostic logging level to Expert.D. Increase the MSExchangeMailSubmission diagnostic logging level to Expert.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 238Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 server.

You need to prevent email messages that contain specific words from being sent between users in theorganization.What should you do?

Page 179: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Create a transport rule.B. Create an Outlook Protection Rule.C. Configure the content filtering feature.D. Configure the sender reputation feature.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 239You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You discover that many large email messages prevent average-size email messages from being sent to theInternet.

You need to delete the large messages from the Hub Transport servers.

Which tool should you use?

A. The Exchange Control Panel (ECP).B. Message tracking.C. The Queue Viewer.D. Windows Explorer.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 240You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization named contoso.com.

You need to add a disclaimer to all email messages sent by members of a mail-enabled group named Group1.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Control Panel (ECP), configure a MailTip.B. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), create a transport rule.C. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-TransportConfig cmdlet.D. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the New-SystemMessage cmdlet.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Exam G

QUESTION 241

Page 180: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a forestwith a domain named ABC.com. The forest and domain functional levels are set at Windows Server 2003.

The environment of ABC.com currently makes use of Microsoft Exchange Server 2003 Service Pack 2 (SP2)as their messaging solution. You receive instruction from ABC.com to migrate the messaging system toExchange Server 2010.

What action must you take to prepare for the first Microsoft Exchange Server 2010 server?

A. You should run the adprep.exe /forestprep command.B. You should run the adprep.exe /domainprep command.C. You should run the setup.com /AnswerFile:Exchange-All.xml command.D. You should run the setup.com /PrepareAD command.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 242You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com.

ABC.com currently makes use of Exchange 2000 Server and Exchange Server 2003 Service Pack 2 (SP2) intheir messaging system. You receive instruction from ABC.com to migrate the messaging system to ExchangeServer 2010 with Client Access, Mailbox and Hub Transport servers.

What actions must you take?

A. You should remove the Exchange 2000 Server servers from the environment.B. You should configure EdgeSync synchronization in the environment.C. You should run the setup /NewProvisionedServer in the environment.D. You should run the Migration Preparation Tool from the other servers in the environment.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 243You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com.

The ABC.com network has a mail server named ABC-EX01 that has Windows Server 2008 installed. Youreceive instruction from ABC.com to deploy Exchange Server 2010 on ABC-EX01 to support the followingroles:

Hub Transport role.

Client Access role.

Page 181: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Mailbox role.

Unified Messaging (UM) server role.

What action must you take?

A. You should run setup /NewProvisionedServer on ABC-EX01.B. You should run ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP Exchange-All.xml on ABC-EX01.C. You should run adprep.exe /domainprep on ABC-EX01.D. You should run Setup.com /PrepareAD on ABC-EX01.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 244You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com.

The ABC.com network has a mail server named ABC-EX02 that has Microsoft Server 2008 with Service Pack 2installed. You receive instruction from ABC.com to deploy Exchange Server 2010 on ABC-EX02 to support theHub Transport, Client Access, and Mailbox server roles.

What action must you take? (Choose all that apply).

A. You should deploy Microsoft .NET Framework 3.5 Service Pack 1.B. You should deploy the Active Directory Connector (ADC).C. You should deploy Windows Management Framework.D. You should delete all Recipient Update Service (RUS) objects.E. You should run ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP Exchange-Typical.xml.F. You should run ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP Exchange-CADB.xml.

Correct Answer: ACESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 245You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com. The ABC.com network has a client computer named ABC-WS662 that has MicrosoftWindows 7 installed.

How can you proceed with the deployment of management tools for Exchange 2010 on ABC-WS662?

A. You should run the Test-ServiceHealth cmdlet.B. You should deploy Microsoft .NET Framework 3.5.1.C. You should run the ACLDIAG and the scanforfeature command.

Page 182: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

D. You should deploy Internet Information Services (IIS) 6.0 Management console.E. You should run the wuauclt.exe /detectnow command.

Correct Answer: BDSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 246You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com. The ABC.com network has a mail server named ABC-EX01.

What actions must you take to run an unattended installation of Exchange Server 2010 server on ABC- EX01?

A. You should add recipient filter.B. You should add create Send connectors.C. You should run setup /ps.D. You should add setup.com in the script.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 247You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server 2010 as their messaging solution.

The ABC.com network contains a server named ABC-EX10. You receive instruction from ABC.com to add theHub Transport Server role on ABC-EX10.

What command can be used for installing the Hub Transport Server role?

A. You should run setup /ps.B. You should run setup.com /M:Install /R:HT.C. You should run setup.exe.D. You should run scanforfeature.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

The following are examples of using Setup.com:

Setup.com /mode:Install /role:Mailbox,HubTransport /TargetDir:"C:\Exchange 2010" This command installs theMailbox server role, the Hub Transport server role, and the management tools to the C:\Exchange 2010directory.

Setup.com /r:M,C,UThis command installs the Mailbox server role, Client Access server role, Unified Messaging server role, and

Page 183: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

the management tools.

Setup.com /mode:Uninstall /role:HTThis command removes the Hub Transport server role from the server.

Setup.com /mode:UninstallThis command completely removes Exchange 2010 from the server and removes this server's Exchangeconfiguration from Active Directory.

Setup.com /mode:Install /role:Mailbox,HubTransport /OrganizationName:MyOrg This command creates anExchange organization in Active Directory called MyOrg and also installs the Mailbox server role, Hub Transportserver role, and the management tools.

Setup.com /mode:UpgradeThis command upgrades an existing version of Exchange. The upgrade parameter is used for service packinstallations.

Setup.com /PrepareAD /on:"My Org"This command creates an Exchange organization called My Org and prepares Active Directory for Exchange2010.C:\Exchange2010\bin\Setup.com /m:Install /r:C /SourceDir:d:\amd64 This command adds the Client Accessserver role to an existing Exchange 2010 server using D:\amd64 as the source directory.

Setup.com /role:Mailbox,HubTransport /UpdatesDir:"C:\Exchange2010\New Patches" This command updatesExchangeServer.msi with patches from the specified directory, and then installs the Mailbox server role, HubTransport server role, and the management tools.

Setup.com /mode:Install /role:Mailbox,HubTransport /DomainController:DC01 This command uses the domaincontroller DC01 to query and make changes to Active Directory while installing the Mailbox server role, HubTransport server role, and the management tools.

Setup.com /mode:Install /role:Mailbox /AnswerFile:c:\ExchangeConfig.txt This command installs the Mailboxserver role by using the settings in the ExchangeConfig.txt file.

Setup.com /mode:Install /role:EdgeTranport /DoNotStartTransport This command installs the Edge Transportserver role and the management tools. After installation, Exchange doesn't start the Microsoft ExchangeTransport service.

Setup.com /mode:Install /role:Mailbox,HubTransport /TargetDir:"C:\Exchange2010" /EnableLegacyOutlook Thiscommand installs the Mailbox server role, Hub Transport server role, and the management tools into the C:\Exchange2010 directory. This command also creates a public folder database on the Mailbox server.

Setup.com /mode:Install /role:Mailbox,HubTransport /TargetDir:"C:\Exchange2010" /LegacyRoutingServer:Ex2003.contoso.comThis command installs the Mailbox server role, Hub Transport server role, and the management tools into theC:\Exchange2010 directory. This command also creates a routing group connector from the Hub Transportserver to the specified legacy Exchange server, and creates a routing group connector from the legacyExchange server to the Hub Transport server.

Setup.com /mode:Install /role:Mailbox,HubTransport /EnableErrorReporting This command installs the Mailboxserver role, Hub Transport server role, and the management tools. This command also enables error reporting.

Setup.com /mode:Install /role:ClientAccess /NoSelfSignedCertificates This command installs the Client Accessserver role and the management tools and doesn't create a self- signed certificate.

Setup.com /r:ET /AdamLdapPort:50390 /AdamSslPort:50640This command installs the Edge Transport server role and the management tools and configures the ActiveDirectory Lightweight Directory Services (AD LDS) instance to use port 50390 for LDAP and port 50640 forSSL.

Page 184: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Setup.com /rprs:Exchange03This command removes the object Exchange03 from Active Directory.

Setup.com /mode:Install /languagepack:<"C:ExchangeLanguagePack"> /role:Mailbox,HubTransport Thiscommand installs the language pack bundle and the Mailbox and Hub Transport server roles.

Setup.com /AddUmLanguagePack:ko-KRThis command installs the Korean Unified Messaging language pack from the %ExchangeSourceDir%\ServerRoles\UnifiedMessaging directory.

QUESTION 248You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com.The ABC.com network has three mail servers named ABC-SR11, ABC-SR12 and ABC-SR13 in the followingconfiguration:

ABC-SR11 has the Front-end role installed and is running Exchange Server 2003 SP2.

ABC-SR12 has the Back-end role installed and is running Exchange Server 2003 SP2.

ABC-SR13 has the Client Access role and the Mailbox role installed and is running Exchange Server

2010.

How can you perform the migration of the mailboxes from ABC-SR12 to ABC-SR13 and ensure the availabilityof the mailboxes?

A. You should implement recipient filtering.B. You should configure EdgeSync synchronization.C. You should implement Transport protection rules.D. You should deploy the Exchange Server 2010 Hub Transport server role.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 249You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server 2010.

The ABC.com network contains a server named ABC-EX10 configured with the following roles:

Client Access role.

Hub Transport role.

Mailbox Server role.

Page 185: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

What action must you take to guarantee email availability to ABC.com users who are are utilizing regular mailclients like Microsoft Outlook Express or Windows Live Mail?

A. You should use Security/Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions (S/MIME).B. You should use the Windows Management Instrumentation Command-line (WMIC).C. You should use the Automatic setting of the Microsoft Exchange POP3 service.D. You should use setup /NewProvisionedServer.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 250You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

The ABC.com network contains a server named ABC-EX10 that contains a mailbox named KingMail.

What action must you take to shift the transaction log files of KingMail?

A. You should use msiexec.exe.B. You should run ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP Exchange-All.xml.C. You should use the Move-DatabasePath cmdlet.D. You should use the Move-SBSDataStore KingMail cmdlet.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 251You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

The ABC.com network contains a Mailbox server named ABC-EX10.

What action must you take to have mailboxes retained for 8 weeks after deletion?

A. You must create a legal hold.B. You must change the mailbox database properties.C. You must create Transport protection rules.D. You must create Personal archives.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 186: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 252You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2003 as their messaging solution.

You have added a new server to the network and deployed Exchange Server 2010 on it with the defaultsettings.

What command must be used to change the default email address policy?

A. You must use setup /NewProvisionedServer.B. You must use lpsetupui.exe.C. You must use Set-EmailAddressPolicy.D. You must use Setup.com /AnswerFile:Exchange-All.xml.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-EmailAddressPolicy "Default Policy" -IncludedRecipients AllRecipients

Please Review:http://blog.morecoffeeany1.com/2010/03/26/upgrade-exchange-2003-default-address-policy-address-lists- to-exchange-2010/

QUESTION 253You work as the enterprise exchange administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com.

The ABC.com network has two mailbox servers named ABC-EX01 and ABC-EX02. ABC-EX01 is runningExchange Server 2007 and ABC-EX02 is running Exchange Server 2010. What actions must you take to shift amailbox on ABC-EX01 to ABC-EX02?

A. You must use msiexec.exe from ABC-EX01.B. You must use the New-MoveRequest cmdlet from ABC-EX02.C. You must use wecutil qc from ABC-EX02.D. You must use wuauclt.exe /detectnow from ABC-EX02.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Explanation:

QUESTION 254You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server 2010 as their messaging solution.

What action must you take to stop a user named Mia Hamm from removing information from her mailbox?

A. You must use log transactions.B. You must use a legal hold.C. You must use Outlook protection rules.

Page 187: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

D. You must use the Set-Mailbox Mia Hamm -LitigationHoldEnabled $true cmdlet.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 255You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2007 as their messaging solution.

ABC.com has acquired a new mailbox server named ABC-EX03 that is running Exchange Server 2010.

How can you shift the mailboxes to ABC-EX03?

A. You must use the New-MoveRequest cmdlet.B. You must use Exchange Server Jetstress 2010.C. You must use the Exchange Server Remote Connectivity Analyzer (ExRCA).D. You must run ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP Exchange-All.xml.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 256You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com.

What actions must you take to use administrative delegation on a series of cmdlets?

A. You must implement log transactions.B. You must set up new management role.C. You must implement Mailbox journaling.D. You must set up a Role Based Access Control (RBAC) role.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 257You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

What actions must you take to allow a user named Mia Hamm to access the resource mailbox? (Choose allthat apply).

A. You must change the resource mailbox's properties.B. You must use log transactions.

Page 188: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. You must use Outlook protection rules.D. You must use the Set-Mailbox Mia Hamm -LitigationHoldEnabled $true cmdlet.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:The creation of a resource mailbox creates an associated Active Directory user account that is disabled bydefault, so clearly no-one is supposed to be logging onto Active Directory using this user account. It wouldtherefore be typical to ensure that a nominated user has delegate access to this mailbox and for that user tomanage the resource requests that come into the resource mailbox. This can be easily configured on theResource Policy tab found in the properties of a resource mailbox in the Exchange Management Console,

http://www.msexchange.org/articles_tutorials/exchange-server-2010/management-administration/resource-mailboxes-exchange-2010-part2.html

QUESTION 258You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution. ABC.com has a Research department.

Page 189: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

ABC.com currently only has one electronic microscope that the staff must share. You receive instruction fromABC.com to implement a solution so that all the employees are able to automatically calendar the use of theelectronic microscope.

How can you achieve the goal?

A. You must use an equipment mailbox.B. You must use a local use request.C. You must use a managed folder mailbox policy.D. You must use Personal Archives.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 259You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network is running in aMicrosoft Exchange Server 2010 environment.

ABC.com has a distribution group named KingData. You receive instruction from ABC.com to allow anemployee Mia Hamm to review all mail to KingData and approve it. Mia Hamm must not be able to changegroup membership.

How can you ensure that the above goal is achieved?

A. You must modify the properties of KingData.B. You must enable folder redirection.C. You must set Mia Hamm as a group moderator for KingData.D. You must implement recipient filtering.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 260You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

Which of the following options can be used in order to change the permission settings for a public folder?

A. Active Directory Users and Computers.B. Microsoft Office Outlook.C. The Mail Flow Troubleshooter.D. Exchange Server Jetstress 2010.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Page 190: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:This is an option , so B is correct , review the Q12 Tha I changed its Answer

QUESTION 261You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

What action must you take to restrict the amount of data in a particular public folder without impacting on theother public folders?

A. You must use an equipment mailbox.B. You must use the Mail Flow Troubleshooter.C. You must use the Public Folder Management Console.D. You must use Exchange Server Jetstress 2010.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 262You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

It has come to the attention of the ABC.com management that a network user named Rory Allen is usingExchange ActiveSync to abuse the company's email policy by downloading huge attachments that do notpertain to his work detail. Consequently you receive instruction from ABC.com to restrict the attachments sizefor Rory Allen to 100 KB.

How can you achieve the goal and ensure that only Rory Allen is restricted?

A. You must set up a new ActiveSync Device Access rule.B. You must set up a managed folder mailbox policy.C. You must set up a new role assignment policy.D. You must set up Outlook protection rules.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 263You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com. ABC.com has acquired a new server named ABC-EX01 that is running Microsoft ExchangeServer 2010.

What action must you take to give employees access to ABC-EX01 from the Internet using ExchangeActiveSync?

A. You must enable recipient filtering.B. You must use Send connectors.C. You must change the Microsoft-Server-ActiveSync virtual directory's external URL.

Page 191: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

D. You must use DNS forwarding.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 264You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of one forestwith one site.

The ABC.com network has two Exchange Server 2010 Client Access servers named ABC-EX14 and ABC-EX15 that have IMAP4 installed. Remote users from the Internet currently make use of IMAP4 to connect toboth ABC-EX14 and ABC-EX15.

What action must you take to block IMAP4 access to the mailboxes on ABC-EX15?

A. You must implement Outlook protection rules.B. You must implement Transport protection rules.C. You must set up a Public Folder Management Console.D. You must deselect the IMAP4 mailbox feature in ABC-EX15.

Page 192: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Use this PowerShell cmdlet to disable POP and IMAP for all users in Exchange 2007/2010:Get-CASMailbox | Set-CASMailbox -PopEnabled $false -ImapEnabled $false

You can then enable the POP and IMAP features for specific users via the GUI or by using this cmdlet:Set-CASMailbox -Identity adam.rush -PopEnabled $true -ImapEnabled $true

QUESTION 265You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

You have received instructions from the CEO to enable Autodiscover for Internet users by creating a resourcerecord in DNS.

What action must you take?

A. You must set up recipient filtering.B. You must set up a Host (A) record.C. You must use a TXT record.D. You must use a Pointer (PTR) record.E. You must use a Mail exchange (MX) record.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 266You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

What action must you take to allow your environment to utilize the wildcard certificate so that it can be used forOutlook Anywhere?

A. You must change recipient filtering.B. You must change the DNS forwarding.C. You must change the Outlook protection rules.D. You must change the EXPR Outlook Provider's properties.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 267You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains three Mailbox servers. All Mailbox servers aremembers of a database availability group (DAG) and have a public folder database.

Page 193: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

The Active Directory forest contains one site. You create a new site and install new Exchange Server 2010servers in the site.

You need to ensure that public folders are stored on servers in both sites.

What should you do?

A. Create a public folder database on a server in the new site.

Modify the replication settings for all public folders.

B. Create a public folder database on a server in the new site.

Set-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup cmdlet from a server in the new site.Run the

C. Configure clustered continuous replication (CCR) on two servers in the new site.

Modify the replication settings for all public folder databases.

D. Configure standby continuous replication (SCR) on a server in the new site.

Run the Enable-StorageGroupCopy cmdlet from a server in the new site.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 268You have an Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox server. The server is a member of a database availability group(DAG).

The server fails.

You install the operating system on a new server and use the same computer name. You join the server to thedomain.

You need to reinstall Exchange Server 2010 on the server. The solution must ensure that previous Exchangeserver configurations are applied to the new server.

What should you do?

A. Run setup /RecoverCMS.B. Run setup /RecoverServer.C. Restore the system state from the previous server.

Page 194: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

D. Install the Exchange management tools and then run the Restore-Computer cmdlet.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 269Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 Edge Transport server named Server1. You install a newExchange Server 2010 Edge Transport server named Server2.

You need to copy the Edge Transport configurations from Server1 to Server2.

What should you do on Server1?

A. Run the ExportEdgeConfig.PS1 script.B. Run the New-EdgeSyncServiceConfig cmdlet.C. Back up the system state.D. Back up the Active Directory Lightweight Directory Services (AD LDS) database.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:besides Export-TransportRuleCollection cmdlet. would be used , but it is not an option.

QUESTION 270Your company acquires a new Internet domain name. You need to ensure that all users can receive emailmessages sent to the new domain name.

Which two actions should you perform? (Each correct answer presents part of the solution. Choose two).

A. Create a sharing policy.B. Create a remote domain.C. Create an accepted domain.D. Create an email address policy.E. Modify the properties of the default Receive connector.

Correct Answer: CDSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 271You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You acquire a new Internet domain name. Users report that they cannot receive email sent to the new domainname.

You verify that all users have the new domain name configured as an email address suffix.

Page 195: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You need to ensure that users can receive email sent from the Internet to the new domain name.

What should you create?

A. an Authoritative Accepted Domain.B. an External Relay Accepted Domain.C. a new Receive connector.D. a remote domain.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 272Your network contains an internal network and a perimeter network. You have one Exchange Server 2010server on the internal network.

You install Windows Server 2008 R2 on a new server in the perimeter network. You need to ensure that youcan install the Edge Transport server role on the new server.

http://www.gratisexam.com/

What should you do?

A. Join the new server to an Active Directory domain.B. Install Active Directory Lightweight Directory Services on the new server.C. Run ImportEdgeConfig.ps1 on the existing Exchange Server 2010 server.D. Open TCP port 389 and TCP port 3268 on the firewall between the perimeter network and the internal

network.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 273You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to modify the path for the message queue database on a Hub Transport server.

What should you do?

A. Run the Set-TransportServer cmdlet.B. Run the Set-TransportConfig cmdlet.C. Modify the EdgeTransport.exe.config file.D. Modify the MSExchangeTransport.exe.config file.

Page 196: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

1. Create the directory where you want to keep the queue database. Make sure that the correct permissions areapplied to the directory.2. Open the following file by using Notepad: C:\Program Files\Microsoft\Exchange Server\V14\Bin\EdgeTransport.exe.config.3. Modify the following line in the <appSettings> section.- <add key="QueueDatabasePath" value="<LocalPath>" />This example changes the location to C:\Queue\QueueDB.- <add key="QueueDatabasePath" value="C:\Queue\QueueDB" />4. Save and close the EdgeTransport.exe.config file.5. Stop the Microsoft Exchange Transport service.6. Copy the files Mail.que and Trn.chk from the original location to the new location.7. Start the Microsoft Exchange Transport service.8. Remove the unused Mail.que and Trn.chk files from the original location.

QUESTION 274You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains an Edge Transport server named Edge1. Allemail messages to the Internet are sent from Edge1.

You need to prevent all members of a group named Group1 from sending email messages to the Internet.

Your solution must provide a custom non-delivery report (NDR) message to the users when they send an emailmessage to the Internet.

What should you create?

A. A custom MailTip and a transport rule.B. A custom MailTip and a remote and a Send connector.C. A custom Delivery Status Notification message and a transport rule.D. A custom Delivery Status Notification message and a Send connector.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 275Your company has a main office and 20 branch offices. Each office contains an Exchange Server 2010 Mailboxserver and an Exchange Server 2010 Hub Transport server.

Each office is configured as a separate Active Directory site. Each branch office site has one IP site link thatconnects to the main office site.

You need to ensure that all email sent between offices is routed through the Hub Transport server in the mainoffice.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-ADSite cmdlet.

Page 197: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-ADSiteLink cmdlet.C. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the Receive connector for the Hub Transport

server in the main office.D. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), create a new Send connector for each branch office.

Configure the Hub Transport server in the main office as a source server for each Send connector.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Set-AdSite cmdlet :to configure an Active Directory site as a hub site to override the default message routing behavior of acomputer that has the Hub Transport server role installed.

Set-AdSiteLink cmdlet :to assign an Exchange-specific cost to an Active Directory IP site link. You can also use this cmdlet to configurethe maximum message size that can pass across an Active Directory IP site link.

Reference:http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb123696.aspxhttp://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb124548

QUESTION 276You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You discover that messages sent to the Internet include internal Exchange routing information in the messageheader.

You need to prevent internal routing information from being sent to external recipients.

What should you do?

A. Create a new remote domain.B. Modify the permissions of the Send connector.C. Modify the properties of the sender reputation feature.D. Enable domain security on the default Receive connector.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:http://social.technet.microsoft.com/Forums/en-US/exchangesvrsecuremessaging/thread/41a64e09-ed49-405e-9a37-de4ca13c2217

Get-SendConnector "Connector Name" | Remove-ADPermission -AccessRight ExtendedRight -ExtendedRights "ms-Exch-Send-Headers-Routing" -user "NT AUTHORITY\Anonymous Logon" then restart theExchange Transport services on all exchange Servers

QUESTION 277You install an Exchange Server 2010 Hub Transport server named Hub1.

You need to ensure that Hub1 can receive email messages sent from Internet hosts.

Page 198: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

What should you do?

A. Enable the Anonymous users permission group for the Client Hub1 Receive connector.B. Enable the Anonymous users permission group for the Default Hub1 Receive connector.C. Create a Receive connector and set the intended use to Client. Modify the port for the connector.D. Create a Receive connector and set the intended use to Custom. Modify the remote IP addresses range for

the connector.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 278You have an Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox server.

You need to view the last logon time and the number of email messages in the mailbox of each user in theorganization.

Which cmdlet should you run?

A. Get-LogonStatistics.B. Get-MailboxMessageConfiguration.C. Get-MailboxStatistics.D. Get-StoreUsageStatistics.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 279You have an Exchange Server 2010 database availability group (DAG) that contains five members and amailbox database named DB1.

You need to identify which servers have a copy of DB1. The solution must also identify the log replay lag timesfor each copy.

Which command should you run?

A. Get-AvailabilityConfig -Identity DB1 | FL.B. Get-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup -Identity DB1 | FL.C. Get-MailboxDatabase -Identity DB1 | FL.D. Get-MailboxDatabaseCopyStatus -Identity DB1 | FL.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 199: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 280You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to view the replication status of a mailbox database copy.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Test-ServiceHealth cmdlet.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Get-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup cmdlet.C. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), view the properties of the database copy.D. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), view the properties of the Mailbox server.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Exam H

QUESTION 281You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

Employees at ABC.com use Outlook Web App to access their mailboxes.

You receive a complaint from a ABC.com employee named Mia Hamm that her mailbox is unavailable.

What actions must you take to resolve this problem?

A. You must change the WEB Outlook Provider.B. You must change Mia Hamm's mailbox features.C. You must change the EXPR Outlook Provider.D. You must change the DNS forwarding.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 282You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server 2010 as their messaging solution.

You have to have the Application Identifier of ABC.com stored in a DNS record. The Application Identifier isused for the federated trust.

What actions must you take on the DNS?

A. You must set up recipient filtering.B. You must set up a Host (A) record.C. You must use a TXT record.D. You must use a Pointer (PTR) record.E. You must use a Mail exchange (MX) record.

Page 200: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:To provide proof of ownership of the registered Internet domain, you must create a text (TXT) record in theDomain Name System (DNS) zone of each accepted domain you want to federate. The TXT record containsthe federated domain proof encryption string generated when you run the Get- FederatedDomainProof cmdletfor each domain.

You can create a TXT record by using DNS Manager on a server running Windows Server 2008 that has theDNS server role installed. Your organization may use DNS server software from another vendor or use aservice provider to host the DNS zone for the domain. Many Internet domain registrars host DNS zones forcustomers and most service providers offer Web-based management tools so that customers can manageDNS records for their domains. To learn more about the DNS server role, see DNS Server Role.

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ee423548.aspx

QUESTION 283You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

How can you configure Outlook Web App (OWA) to block ABC.com employees changing passwords?

A. You must use IP Block list.B. You must change the properties of the OWA virtual directory.C. You must use an Outlook Web App mailbox policy.D. You must set up recipient filtering.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:This question is confusing as two answers are correct. If you wish to disable the changing of passwordsthrough OWA for all domain users, then you would use the following command:

Set-OwaVirtualDirectory -Identity <OWAVirtualDirectoryName> -ChangePasswordEnabled $false

However, if you wish to prevent certain users from changing their passwords through OWA, then you use theSegmentation tab of the OWA mailbox policy in the EMC. Or, alternatively, you could use the followingcommand:

New-OWAMailboxPolicy -Name 'OWA Mailbox Policy Name' | Set-OWAMailboxPolicy -ChangePasswordEnabled $false

I have gone for the former answer as it does not specify that it should only be configured for certain individualusers.

QUESTION 284You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

What actions must you take to allow employees to change their passwords using Microsoft Windows but notOutlook Web App?

Page 201: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. You must up an IP Block list.B. You must use an Outlook Web App Mailbox policy.C. You must set up the Segmentation tab settings.D. You must set up recipient filtering.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Again, the wording of this question is a bit vague. The Segmentation tab is found within the OWA mailbox policyin EMC.

AhmadSabry:You can enable or disable the Change Password feature for a single user by configuring the user's mailbox, orfor multiple users by configuring the /owa virtual directory or another virtual directory that's used for OutlookWeb App. You can enable or disable the Change Password feature by using segmentation. For moreinformation

Ref: http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb684904.aspx ----------------------------------------

QUESTION 285You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

A new ABC.com usage policy prohibits the employees from using certain words in internal email messages.

What actions must you take to have the policy implemented?

A. You must set up an IP Block list.B. You must set up sender filtering.C. You must set up managed folders.D. You must build a transport rule.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 286You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

The ABC.com network has a DNS server named ABC-SR04.

What action must you take to prevent the Hub Transport servers using ABC-SR04 to resolve names on theInternet?

A. You must change the DNS forwarding.B. You must change the Hub Transport server object properties.C. You must amend the Transport protection rules.D. You must set the Net.TCP Port Sharing service to Automatic.

Page 202: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 287You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com.

ABC.com has an Exchange Server 2010 server named ABC-EX01 that has the Hub Transport server roleinstalled.

What actions must you take to allow ABC-EX01 to receive email from the Internet?

A. You must change the properties of the MSExchangePOP3 (TCP-in) Windows Firewall rule.B. You must create and export a filter from the Exchange Management Console.C. You must select the Anonymous user's permission group for the Default ABC-EX01 Receive connector.D. You must configure Outlook Anywhere.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)

Page 203: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 288You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

What actions must you take to change the Exchange-specific cost for a site link?

A. You must configure the Host (A) resource records.B. You must add and configure an IPSec Enforcement Network policy.C. You must create an Outlook Web App Mailbox policy.D. You must use the Set-ADSiteLink cmdlet.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 289You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution.

The ABC.com network contains an Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox server named ABC-EX02.

What actions must you take to check when employees last logged on to ABC-EX02?

A. You must configure real time block lists (RBLs).B. You must use the Exchange Server User Monitor (ExMon).C. You must use the Get-MailboxStatistics.D. You must use the administrator audit logging.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 290You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network consists of a domainnamed ABC.com and contains an Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox server named ABC-EX01.

How can you list the mailbox sizes of all employees?

A. You must use the Get-MailboxDatabase cmdlet.B. You must use the Get-MailBoxStatistics cmdlet.C. You must use Exchange Server User Monitor (ExMon).D. You must use ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP Exchange-CADB.xml.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)

Page 204: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 291You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. ABC.com is using Microsoft Exchange Server2010 as their messaging solution. The ABC.com network has two Mailbox servers named ABC-EX01 and ABC-EX02.

During the course of the week you receive instructions from the CEO to determine the amount of time it takesfor the delivery of messages between ABC-EX01 and ABC-EX02. Which of the following commands can beused to achieve this goal?

A. You must use the Test-ServiceHealth cmdlet.B. You must use the Test-Mailflow cmdlet.C. You must use the Get-MailboxStatistics cmdlet.D. You must use the Get-MailboxDatabase cmdlet.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 292You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network is running in aMicrosoft Exchange Server 2010 environment.

You are responsible for managing a Mailbox server named ABC-EX02. The employees at ABC.com useMicrosoft Office Outlook 2010 to access the Exchange environment.

What actions must you take to determine the amount of lag for connections to ABC-EX02?

A. You must use the Test-Mailflow cmdlet.B. You must use MSExchangeTransport diagnostic logging.C. You must use the Test-ServiceHealth cmdlet.D. You must use the Test-OutlookConnectivity cmdlet.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 293You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network is running in aMicrosoft Exchange Server 2010 environment.

You are responsible for managing an Exchange Server 2010 server named ABC-EX02.

What command can be used to determine if the employees can use Outlook Anywhere to access ABC- EX02?

A. You must use the Test-ImapConnectivity cmdlet.B. You must use the Test-OutlookConnectivity cmdlet.

Page 205: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. You must use the Get-MessageTrackingReport cmdlet.D. You must use the Exchange Remote Connectivity Analyzer.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Explanation:

QUESTION 294You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network is running in aMicrosoft Exchange Server 2010 environment.You are responsible for managing an Exchange Server 2010 server named ABC-EX02 that has IMAP4installed.

What action must you take to determine if users are able to email hosts on the Internet?

A. You must connect to port 587, from a workstation.B. You must use the Get-MessageTrackingReport cmdlet.C. You must enable the Receive connectors and Send connectors.D. You must use the Remote Connectivity Analyzer.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Exchange 2010 delivers a default receive connector for alternative eMail Clients (Client <Servername>), thisconnector listens on Port 587 and not on the default SMTP Port 25

Port 587 is the SMTP submission port, intended for use by e-mail clients. It, is encrypted (using TLS) andrequires an authenticated user at the client side (which allows the sender to use your server as a SMTP relay).

QUESTION 295You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network is running in aMicrosoft Exchange Server 2010 environment.

How can you find all mailboxes that exceed 2 GB in size?

A. You can use the Get-MailboxStatistics cmdlet.B. You can use the Test-Mailflow cmdlet.C. You can use the Get-StoreUsageStatistics cmdlet.D. You can use the Test-ServiceHealth cmdlet.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Explanation:

QUESTION 296

Page 206: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network is running in aMicrosoft Exchange Server 2010 environment.

A SMTP server on the Internet has rejected some emails sent from ABC.com.

What actions must you take to determine why this happened? (Choose all that apply).

A. You must use the Windows Remote Management (WinRM) over SSL.B. You must access the Send connectors and use the Verbose setting in Protocol logging.C. You must configure EdgeSync synchronization.D. You must check the protocol log files.E. You must implement a new managed content setting.

Correct Answer: BDSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 297You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network is running in aMicrosoft Exchange Server 2010 environment.

You are responsible for managing an Exchange Server 2010 server named ABC-EX01. ABC- EX01 supportsmessage tracking.

What actions must you take to change the location of the log file used with the message tracking?

A. You must change the Hub Transport server object properties.B. You must set up recipient filtering.C. You must configure EdgeSync synchronization.D. You must change the Outlook protection rules.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 298You work as the Enterprise Exchange Administrator at ABC.com. The ABC.com network is running in aMicrosoft Exchange Server 2010 environment.

The ABC.com network has two Mailbox servers named ABC-EX01 and ABC-EX02. You are busy implementinga database availability group (DAG).

What actions must you take to guarantee mailbox database replications on ABC-EX01 and ABC- EX02?

A. You must implement a custom Send connector.B. You must install the Active Directory Connector (ADC).C. You must change the Database paths.D. You must change the membership list of the DAG.

Correct Answer: D

Page 207: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Section: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 299You work as an Exchange Administrator for ABC Inc. The company has a Windows 2008 Active Directory-based network. The network contains an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

The CEO has requested you to ensure that all emails with JPEG attachments be filtered so that they are notallowed into the users' mailboxes. You decide to use the Exchange Management Shell.

Which of the following commands will you use to accomplish the task?

A. Add-AttachmentFilterEntry -Name *.jpeg -Type ContentType.B. Add-AttachmentFilterEntry -Name *.exe -Type FileName.C. Add-AttachmentFilterEntry -Name image/jpeg -Type ContentType.D. Add-AttachmentFilterEntry -Name image/jpeg -Type FileName.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Explanation:

QUESTION 300You work as an Exchange Administrator for ABC Inc. The company has a Windows 2008 Active Directory-based network. The network contains an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You have deployed Hub Transport, Client Access, Unified Messaging, and Mailbox servers in the messagingorganization. You have not deployed any Edge Transport servers in the organization.

Which of the following servers can be used to send and receive email traffic across the Internet?

A. The server configured with the Unified Messaging server role.B. The server configured with the Client Access server role.C. The server configured with the Mailbox server role.D. The server configured with the Hub Transport server role.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 301You work as an Exchange Administrator for ABC Inc. The company has a Windows 2008 Active Directory-based network. The network contains an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to create a mailbox for a user named Sam in the Exchange organization. The user account of Sam isalready created in the ABC.com domain.

Which of the following actions will you perform to accomplish this task?

Page 208: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Use the Enable-Mailbox cmdlet to create a mailbox for Sam.B. Use the Restore-Mailbox cmdlet to create a mailbox for Sam.C. Use the Set-Mailbox cmdlet to create a mailbox for Sam.D. Use the New-Mailbox cmdlet to create a mailbox for Sam.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 302You work as an Exchange Administrator for ABC Inc. The company has a Windows 2008 Active Directory-based network. The network contains an Exchange Server 2003 organization.

The management instructs you to deploy Exchange Server 2010 in your network. You decide to prepare theschema and domain first.Which of the following commands should you run prior to performing the normal schema and domainpreparation?

A. Setup /PrepareSchema.B. Setup /PrepareLegacyExchangePermissions.C. Setup /PrepareAD.D. Setup /PrepareLegacyExchangePermissions:child.ABC.com.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Setup /PrepareLegacyExchangePermissions followed by Setup /PrepareSchema if you You would runwere to run them separately. However, in reality you would just run Setup /PrepareAD as this runs through boththe aforementioned actions if they have not previously been run.

QUESTION 303You recently took over as the Exchange 2010 Server Administrator for ABC.com. The previous administratorallowed users to pick the email addresses of their choice. This caused much confusion, as each user wanted adifferent email address.

You want to standardize the email addresses across the entire organization. You have determined that thenaming convention will be the first letter in their first name, followed by their last name. For example, the emailaddress for John Smith would be [email protected].

What should you do to enforce this standard?

A. Make sure all administrators manually change the email addresses to comply with standards.B. Instruct Active Directory administrators to change all email addresses to comply with this standard.C. Create an email address policy.D. Create a transport rule.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Page 209: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 304You work as an Exchange Administrator for ABC Inc. The company has a Windows 2008 Active Directory-based network. The network contains an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to enable automatic booking for a room mailbox called TrainingRoom.

Which of the following commands will you enter in the Exchange Management Shell to accomplish this task?

A. New-CalendarProcessing TrainingRoom -AutomateProcessing:AutoAccept.B. Set-CalendarProcessing TrainingRoom -AutomateProcessing:AutoAccept.C. Set-MailboxCalendarSettings TrainingRoom -AutomateProcessing:None.D. New-Mailbox -UserPrincipalName [email protected] -database "Mailbox Database" - Name

"Training Room" -OrganizationalUnit Users -DisplayName "Training Room" - ResetPasswordOnNextLogon$false -Room -AutomateProcessing:AutoAccept.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Use the Set-CalendarProcessing cmdlet to modify calendar-related processing configuration properties for thetarget mailbox, which include Calendar Attendant, resource booking assistant, and calendar configuration.

The Set-MailboxCalendarSettings cmdlet lets you enable calendar processing for a mailbox. You can configureparameters for automatic resource booking or Calendar Attendant processing.

QUESTION 305You work as an Exchange Administrator for ABC.com. The company has a Windows 2008 Active Directory-based network. You have just finished deploying an Exchange 2010 server and migrating all mailboxesincluding resource mailboxes from Exchange Server 2003.

After the migration from the Exchange 2003 server was complete, you noticed that the resource mailboxeswere showing up as shared mailboxes and not resource mailboxes.

You realize that you need to convert the shared mailboxes to Exchange 2010 resource mailboxes. Whilelogged into the Exchange Management Console, you do not see any option to convert a mailbox.

What should you use to convert the Exchange 2010 shared mailboxes to Exchange 2010 resource mailboxes?

A. Exchange Troubleshooting Assistant.B. Exchange System Manager.C. Exchange Management Shell.D. Command prompt.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:This example converts the shared mailbox ConfRoom1to a room mailbox.

Page 210: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Set-Mailbox ConfRoom1 -Type RoomYou can use the following values for the Type parameter:

RegularRoomEquipmentShared

QUESTION 306You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. The organization contains a distribution group namedGroup1.

You need to ensure that a user named User1 can review and approve all messages sent to Group1.

You must prevent User1 from modifying the membership of Group1.

What should you do?

A. Add User1 to Group1's Managed by list.B. Assign User1 as a group moderator for Group1.C. Assign the Message Tracking management role to User1.D. Add User1 to Group1 and then create a new journal rule.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 307You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You have a group named Group1 that contains 10,000 members.

You need to ensure that an informative message is displayed when users add Group1 to the recipient list of anemail message.

What should you do?

A. Configure a MailTip.B. Create a transport rule.C. Create a Send connector.D. Configure an expansion server.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 308You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization named contoso.com. All users from your company have [email protected] email address suffix.

You need to configure a public folder named Folder1 so that Internet users can post content by sending an

Page 211: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

email to [email protected].

What should you do?

A. Mail enable Folder1.B. Assign the author role to Anonymous.C. Create a new mail contact that has the email address [email protected], and then create a transport

rule.D. Create a new mailbox that has the email address [email protected], and then create a transport rule.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 309Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 server.

You need to prevent a user named User1 from downloading attachments larger than 50 KB when usingExchange ActiveSync. Your solution must not affect other users.

What should you do first?

A. Create a new ActiveSync Device Access rule.B. Create a new Exchange ActiveSync Mailbox policy.C. Modify the properties of User1's mailbox.D. Modify the properties of the default Exchange ActiveSync Mailbox policy.

Correct Answer: B

Page 212: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Section: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 310You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains a Mailbox server named MBX1, a Client Accessserver named CAS1, and a Hub Transport server named Hub1.

Some users report that they have performance issues when they use Microsoft Office Outlook.

You need to gather the RPC performance data from the servers.

What should you do?

A. From CAS1 and HUB1, run the Mail Flow Troubleshooter.B. From CAS1 and HUB1, run the Get-MessageTrackingLog cmdlet.C. From MBX1 and CAS1, run the Exchange Best Practice Analyzer.D. From MBX1 and CAS1, run the Exchange Troubleshooting Assistant.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 311You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

An internal user named User1 sends a confidential message to another internal user named User2. User1 doesnot have any administrative privileges in the organization.

You need to ensure that User1 can identify whether the message was successfully delivered.

What should you instruct User1 to do?

A. View the message headers in the Sent Items folder.B. Open Microsoft Office Outlook and modify the read receipt settings.C. Open Microsoft Office Outlook and modify the delivery receipt settings.D. Open the Exchange Control Panel (ECP) and select Organize EMail.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 312You deploy a new Exchange Server 2010 organization. You send a test message to an external recipient andimmediately receive the following nondelivery report (NDR):

"Delivery has failed to these recipients or groups: [email protected] ([email protected]). Therecipient's email system isn't accepting messages now. Please try resending this message later or contact therecipient directly."

Page 213: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You verify that you can successfully send an email message to [email protected] from an external emailsystem.

You need to ensure that you can send email messages to external recipients from within the Exchangeorganization.

What should you do?

A. Create a remote domain.B. Create a Send connector.C. Configure the Hub Transport server to use an Internet DNS server.D. Modify the remote IP address range of the default Receive connector.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 313You deploy an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains one Mailbox server in a lab environment.The lab environment is not connected to the Internet.

You need to verify that Autodiscover is configured correctly for client connectivity.

What should you run?

A. the Best Practice Analyzer.B. the Remote Connectivity Analyzer.C. the Test-MapiConnectivity cmdlet.D. the Test-OutlookWebServices cmdlet.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 314You have an Exchange Server 2010 server that has IMAP4 enabled. All users connect to the Exchange serverusing an IMAP4 client.

You need to verify whether users can send email to the Internet using the Exchange server.

What should you do?

A. From the server, run the Test-ImapConnectivity cmdlet.B. From the server, run the Test-OutlookConnectivity cmdlet.C. From a client, attempt a connection to TCP port 143 using telnet.D. From a client, attempt a connection to TCP port 587 using telnet.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)

Page 214: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 315You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to identify whether an administrator has made a configuration change in the Exchange organization.

What should you run?

A. Get-EventLogLevel.B. Get-ExchangeServer.C. Exchange Best Practices Analyzer.D. Microsoft Baseline Security Analyzer (MBSA).

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 316You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains five Mailbox servers.

You need to identify all of the mailboxes that are larger than 5 GB.

Which command should you run?

A. Get-AddressList -identity "All Users" | Get-MailboxFolderStatistics | fl.B. Get-MailboxDatabase | Get-MailboxFolderStatistics | ft name,totalitemsize.C. Get-Mailbox | Get-MailboxStatistics | ft displayname,totalitemsize.D. Get-MailUser | Get-MailboxStatistics | ft identity,totalitemsize.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 317You have an Exchange Server 2010 server that has message tracking enabled.

You need to modify the storage location of the message tracking logs.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-EventLogLevel cmdlet.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-TransportConfig cmdlet.C. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the mailbox database.D. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the Hub Transport server object.

Correct Answer: D

Page 215: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Section: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 318You have a database availability group (DAG) that contains two servers named MBX1 and MBX2.

You discover that a mailbox database named DB2 is in a FailedAndSuspended state on MBX2.

You need to reseed DB2 to MBX2. You must achieve this goal by using the minimum amount of administrativeeffort.

Which cmdlet should you run?

A. Restore-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup.B. Resume-MailboxDatabaseCopy.C. Set-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup.D. Update-MailboxDatabaseCopy.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

If the database has been offline for an extended period, you may have to reseed it. To do this, follow thesesteps:

1- Suspend replication to the database if it is not already suspended. To do this, run the following command:Suspend-MailboxDatabaseCopy <databaseName>\<ReplicaServerName>

2- Reseed the database copy. To do this, run the following command:Update-MailboxDatabaseCopy <databaseName>\<ReplicaServerName> -SourceServer <ActiveServerName> -DeleteExistingFiles:$True

3- Resume replication. To do this, run the following command:Resume-MailboxDatabaseCopy <databaseName\<ReplicaServerName>

Page 216: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 319Your network contains two offices named Office1 and Office2. The offices are connected by a WAN link.Each office is configured as an Active Directory site.

You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. The organization contains four Mailbox servers that aremembers of a database availability group (DAG). Two servers are located in each site.

All Exchange and non-Exchange servers in Office1 become unavailable. Users in both offices report that theycannot access their mailboxes.

You notice that all Mailbox database copies in Office2 have a Failed status. You need to mount all Mailboxdatabase copies in Office2.

What should you do first?

A. Run Cluster.exe /ForceQuorum on the Mailbox server in Office2.B. Run the Set-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup cmdlet on the Mailbox server in Office2.C. Evict the Mailbox server from Office2 from the cluster.D. Configure an Alternate File Share Witness for the DAG.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:http://www.extropy.com/forums/knowledge-bases-extropedia/microsoft/exchange-2010-manually-fix-down-exchange-organization-us

Because Exchange 2010 relies heavily on Microsoft FCS (Failover Clustering Service) and AD (ActiveDirectory), there are many scenarios where these distributed decision making functions can fail. When all theservers fail in the primary data center, the second data center takes over as it should, and when the primarydata center comes back online, it does not automatically fail back; this is by design (per Microsoft). I have foundthat to fail services back, you must do two crucial things:1- Manually restart clustering services on the Exchange servers in the primary datacenter with this command"net start clussvc /forcequorum"

2- Restart the DAG in the primary data center with the command "Start-DatabaseAvailabilityGroup -

Page 217: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

ActiveDirectorySite '[site name]' -Identity '[DAG name]'"

3- If necessary because errors are preventing the previous two, use the GUI tool for failover clustermanagement to evict the node in the secondary datacenter

4- In some cases it may be necessary to forcibly re-mount some databases with this command: 'mount-database -identity '[name of database]'Exam I

QUESTION 320You work as an Exchange Administrator for ABC Inc. The company has a Windows 2008 Active Directory-based network.

The management instructs you to prepare an Exchange organization. You decide to prepare the ActiveDirectory schema and domains by using a computer running Windows Server 2008.

Which of the following actions will you perform prior to preparing the schema or domains?

A. Run the Setup /PrepareLegacyExchangePermissions command on the Windows Server 2008 computer.B. Install the Active Directory management tools on the Windows Server 2008 computer.C. Install Windows Remote Management (WinRM) 2.0 on the Windows Server 2008 computer.D. Install Microsoft .NET Framework 3.5 Service Pack 1 (SP1) on the Windows Server 2008 computer.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:If Active Directory is not installed on the machine, this would be a necessity in the first instance.

QUESTION 321You work as an Exchange Administrator for ABC Inc. The company has a Windows 2008 Active Directory-based network. The network contains an Exchange Server 2010 organization. The Exchange environment hastwo Edge Transport servers and two Hub servers.

The CEO wants you to filter a list of IP addresses and requests that you add these IP addresses to the blocklist. You log into one of the Edge Transport servers and add the list of IPs to the block list.

The next day the CEO informs you that the IP addresses he gave you are still able to send messages into theExchange environment.

What changes should you make to ensure these IP addresses are blocked?

A. Restart the SMTP service.B. Reboot the Edge Transport server.C. Add the list to the second Edge Transport server.D. Restart IIS.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 322

Page 218: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You work as an Exchange Administrator for ABC Inc. The company has a Windows 2008 Active Directory-based network.

You have recently transitioned the messaging organization to Exchange 2010 from Exchange Server 2007SP2. You need to move the mailboxes from the old messaging organization to the new messagingorganization.

What cautions and prerequisites will you take when moving mailboxes? (Each correct answer represents acomplete solution. Choose all that apply).

A. The Movemailbox cmdlets in Exchange 2007 cannot be used to move mailboxes from Exchange 2007 toExchange 2010.

B. The mailboxes from Exchange 2007 SP1 or earlier cannot be moved. The source mailbox server must beExchange 2007 SP2 or later.

C. The antivirus and anti-spam updates have to be disabled prior to moving the mailboxes.D. The Exchange System Manager or Active Directory Users and Computer consoles cannot be used to move

mailboxes from Exchange 2003 to Exchange 2010.

Correct Answer: ABDSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 323You work as an Exchange Administrator for ABC Inc. The company has a Windows 2008 Active Directory-based network. The network contains an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

There are 150 mailboxes in the messaging organization, which are stored in a mailbox database namedMailboxDatabase. You have set the storage quota limit to 200 MB for all mailboxes in the databaseMailboxDatabase.

When the limit of a mailbox reaches 180 MB, the corresponding user gets a warning message. After reachingthe limit, the users are not able to send and receive any email.

The manager of your company, John Smith, asks you to change the storage limit for his mailbox to 280 MB.

Which of the following commands will you enter in the Exchange Management Shell to accomplish the task?

A. Set-Mailbox -Identity [email protected] -IssueWarningQuota 188743680 - ProhibitSendReceiveQuota293601280 -UseDatabaseQuotaDefaults $true.

B. Set-Mailbox -Identity [email protected] -IssueWarningQuota 188743680 - ProhibitSendReceiveQuota293601280 -UseDatabaseQuotaDefaults $false.

C. Set-Mailbox -Identity [email protected] -IssueWarningQuota 188743680 - ProhibitSendReceiveQuota293601280.

D. Set-Mailbox -Identity [email protected] -IssueWarningQuota 188743680 - ProhibitSendQuota293601280 -UseDatabaseQuotaDefaults $false.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 324BlingbyAlex.com was known several years ago by the name AlexBling.com. At times, the sales staff still

Page 219: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

receives orders from clients at the AlexBling.com address. Both names are owned by the company.

After you successfully deploy an Exchange 2010 server configuration, which includes two Hub Transportservers, the sales staff informs you that they are no longer able to receive mail at the AlexBling.com address.

What should you do so that they can receive email from both domains?

A. On the Hub Transport server, use the New Accepted Domain Wizard to add AlexBling.com.B. On the Mailbox server, use the New Accepted Domain Wizard to add AlexBling.com.C. Use Active Directory to add an email alias to each user's account for AlexBling.com.D. On the Client Access server, use the New Accepted Domain Wizard to add AlexBling.com.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 325You work as an Exchange Administrator for ABC Inc. The company has a Windows 2008 Active Directory-based network. The network contains an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

The management instruct you to ensure that a universal distribution group named "Account Dept" does notreceive any email. The management also instruct you that in future, the group might be needed again.

Which of the following actions will you perform to accomplish the task?

A. Configure recipient filtering for the members of the group.B. Remove all members from the group.C. Remove the group.D. Disable the group.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 326You work as an Exchange Administrator for ABC.com. The company has a Windows 2008 Active Directory-based network. The network contains an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

An employee named John has recently left the company. You need to delete the mailbox and the user accountfor John. You also need to remove the mailbox from the Exchange database.

Which of the following commands will you enter in the Exchange Management Shell to accomplish the task?

A. Deletemailbox -Identity [email protected]. Removemailbox -Identity [email protected] -Permanent $true.C. Removemailbox -Identity [email protected]. Disablemailbox [email protected].

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)

Page 220: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 327You work as an Exchange Administrator for ABC.com. The company has a Windows 2008 Active Directory-based network. The network contains an Exchange Server 2010 organization. The name of your company isrecently changed to ABC Inc.

The customers complain that whenever they send emails to ABCInc.com, they are bounced back. However,when they send an email to ABC.com, it is delivered.

Which of the following actions will you perform to resolve the issue?

A. Add ABCInc.com as an internal relay domain in accepted domain.B. Add ABC.com as an internal relay domain in accepted domain.C. Add ABCInc.com as an authoritative domain in accepted domain.D. Add ABC.com as an authoritative domain in accepted domain.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 328You are the Exchange Administrator for the ABC Corporation's Exchange 2010 organization. People fromoutside your organization make inquiries to ABC's Tax department.

You create a Tax distribution group that contains all members of the Tax department so people can sendquestions to the members of the department.

You have a number of additional requirements:

A user named George must be able to review and approve all messages sent to the Tax distribution

group.When George sends a message to the distribution group it should be delivered immediately, without his

approval being required.

What should you do? (Choose all that apply).

A. Check Messages sent to this group have to be approved by a moderator on the properties page of the Taxdistribution group.

B. Add George's account as group moderator of the Tax distribution group.C. Remove George's account from the Tax distribution group, add him to another distribution group, and add

that group as a member of the Tax distribution group.D. Add George's account as a sender that does not require message approval.E. Check Notify senders in your organization only when their messages aren't approved.

Correct Answer: ABD

Page 221: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Section: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 329You are the Exchange Administrator of the ABC Corporation's Exchange 2010 organization. You are concernedabout the total size of items that are stored in a public folder named ExpenseReport.

Which of the following techniques should you use to determine the size of items and the attachments in thepublic folder?

A. Run the following script: Get-PublicFolderItemStatistics -Identity "\ExpenseReport\2009".B. Click on the Statistics tab in the properties of the public folder with the Public Folder Management Console.C. Use the MSExchangeIS Public object in System Monitor.D. Use the MSExchangeIS object in System Monitor.

Page 222: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 330You are the Exchange Administrator of the ABC Corporation's Exchange organization. All clients on thenetwork use computers with Windows Vista and Outlook 2003 installed or Windows 7 and Outlook 2007 toaccess their mailbox.

Your company acquires the Verigon Corporation, which has its own Active Directory domain named verigon.com. You want to allow out-of-office messages from your organization to be delivered to the verigon.comdomain. You also want to block read receipts that are sent from your organization to the verigon.com domain.

You configure the verigon.com domain as a remote domain. What should you do next?

A. Run the Set-RemoteDomain cmdlet with the AllowedOOFType parameter set to ExternalLegacy and theDeliveryReportEnabled parameter set to $False.

B. Run the Set-RemoteDomain cmdlet with the AllowedOOFType parameter set to External and theDeliveryReportEnabled parameter set to $False.

C. Run the Set-RemoteDomain cmdlet with the AllowedOOFType parameter set to ExternalLegacy and theNDREnabled parameter set to $False.

D. Run the Set-RemoteDomain cmdlet with the AllowedOOFType parameter set to External and theNDREnabled parameter set to $False.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:This example allows external out-of-office messages and out-of-office messages set by Outlook 2003 or earlierclients or sent by Exchange 2003 or earlier servers. Set-RemoteDomain "RemoteDomain" -AllowedOOFTypeExternalLegacy

This example disables delivery reports to the remote domain. By default, this setting is enabled. Set-RemoteDomain -Identity Contoso -DeliveryReportEnabled $false

QUESTION 331You are the Exchange Administrator of the ABC Corporation's Exchange 2010 organization.

You need to retrieve all messages from Ann's mailbox that have the word "classified" in the message body andthe subject of "New Project". The message may be in either the Calendar or Inbox folders.

What should you do? (Choose two. Each correct answer is part of the solution).

A. Use the Exchange Management Console to create a recovery storage group.B. Use the Exchange Management Shell to create a recovery storage group.C. Use the Exchange Management Console to create a recovery database.D. Use the Exchange Management Shell to create a recovery database.E. Use the Restoremailbox cmdlet to restore only messages that the word "classified" in the message body

and the subject of "New Project".F. Use the Export-Message cmdlet to restore only messages that the word "classified" in the message body

and the subject of "New Project".

Page 223: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: DESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 332You are the Exchange Administrator for your organization.

You need to move a user's mailbox from the mailbox server role of an Exchange 2007 SP2 server to themailbox server role of an Exchange 2010 server in the same forest. You must ensure that the end-user can stillaccess their email account.

What action should you take?

A. Run the Movemailbox cmdlet.B. Run the New-MoveRequest cmdlet.C. Use the Exchange Management console to issue a New Remote Move Request.D. Run the Set-MailboxDatabaseCopy cmdlet.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 333You work for the ABC Corporation. You are planning to install Exchange 2010 in all domains of the ABC.comforest. The forest structure is shown in the diagram below:

What command should you run to prepare the domains in the ABC.com forest for Exchange 2010?

A. Setup /PrepareAD /on:ABC.com.B. Setup /PrepareDomain:ABC.com.C. Setup /pad.D. Setup /ps.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 224: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Run setup /PrepareAllDomains or setup /pad to prepare all domains in your organization.

setup /PrepareSchema is automatically perform the PrepareLegacyExchangePermissions step , not an option

QUESTION 334You are the Exchange Administrator for ABC Corporation's Exchange 2010 organization.

Jennifer Brown is a user in the Accounting department who will be on leave for 30 to 40 days. You would like toforward all mail for Jennifer Brown's mailbox to Ann Garcia during her absence. When Jennifer returns fromleave, she should be able to see all the messages that were forwarded to Ann Garcia.

What should you configure?

A. Set-Mailbox -Identity "Jennifer Brown" -ForwardingAddress "[email protected]" -DeliverToMailboxAndForward $false.

B. Set-Mailbox -Identity "Jennifer Brown" -ForwardingAddress "[email protected]" -DeliverToMailboxAndForward $true.

C. Add-ADPermission -Identity 'CN=Jennifer Brown,OU=Accounting,DC=ABC,DC=com' - User 'ABC \Ann' -ExtendedRights 'Send-as'.

D. Add-MailboxPermission -Identity 'CN=Jennifer Brown,OU=Accounting,DC=ABC,DC=com' -User 'ABC\Ann' -AccessRights 'FullAccess'.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 335You are the Exchange Administrator for ABC Corporation's Exchange 2010 organization. ABC has recentlymerged with another corporation. The Exchange organization must comply with new legal and regulatoryrequirements.

You must ensure that all email messages that contain at least one recipient or sender who is a member of [email protected] distribution list, and which pass through the Hub Transport server in the ABC Corporation, willstore a copy of the message in an auditor's mailbox.

Which cmdlet should you use?

A. Set-JournalRule -Name "Tax Communications" -JournalEmailAddress'[email protected]' - Scope Internal -Recipient [email protected] -Enabled $True.

B. Set-JournalRule -Name "Tax Communications" -JournalEmailAddress'[email protected]' - Scope Global -Recipient [email protected] -Enabled $True.

C. Set-JournalRule -Name "Tax Communications" -JournalEmailAddress'[email protected]' - Scope External-Recipient [email protected] -Enabled $True.

D. New-JournalRule -Name "Tax Communications" -JournalEmailAddress'[email protected]' - Scope Global -Recipient [email protected] -Enabled $True.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 336

Page 225: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You are the Exchange Administrator of ABC Corporation's Exchange 2010 organization. You create a publicfolder named PublicFolder1 on a Mailbox server named MBX55 and enable users to post messages.

You want your assistant, Josh, to configure PublicFolder1 to replicate with the Mailbox servers in other offices.To achieve this, you want Josh to run the Set-PublicFolder cmdlet to configure the replication schedule.

You must delegate appropriate permissions to Josh to enable him to run the Set-PublicFolder cmdlet.What should you do?

A. Add Josh to the local Server Operators group.B. Delegate the Exchange Recipient Administrators role to Josh.C. Delegate the Exchange Public Folder Administrators role to Josh.D. Delegate the Exchange View-Only Administrators role to Josh.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 337You are the Exchange Administrator for ABC Corporation's Exchange 2010 organization.

You want to test connectivity for Outlook Anywhere through the Autodiscover service. What should you use totest it?

A. Mail Flow Troubleshooter.B. The Test-OutlookConnectivity cmdlet.C. Message Tracking.D. Performance Troubleshooter.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 338You are the Exchange Administrator of ABC Corporation's Exchange organization.

You have a Mailbox server in a cluster continuous replication (CCR) environment. When a lossy failover occurs,the system automatically re-delivers the recent email messages sent to users on the failed clustered mailboxserver.

You want to ensure that if another lossy failover occurs, then all mail will be re-delivered, even if there were alarge amount of messages sent before the lossy failover occurred. You also want to increase the time amessage will be retained by a Hub Transport Server to ensure that messages are not lost in transit.

What should you configure?

A. Use the New-JournalRule cmdlet with the WhatIf switch.B. Use the Set-TransportConfig cmdlet with the MaxDumpsterTime parameter.C. Use the Set-TransportRule cmdlet with the FromScope switch.D. Use the Set-MailboxDatabase cmdlet with the MailboxRetention switch.

Page 226: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 339You are the Exchange Administrator for ABC Corporation's Exchange 2010 organization. All servers in theforest must have anti-virus software that contains a file level virus scanner.

After you implement the anti-virus software, several users report that they cannot access their mailbox. Whatshould you do? (Choose two. Each correct answer is part of the solution).

A. Restart the Microsoft Exchange Mail Submission service.B. Run the ESEUTIL utility on the Exchange databases.C. Exclude *.edb and *.log files from the virus scanner.D. Restart the Microsoft Exchange Transport service.E. Restart the Microsoft Exchange Information Store service.

Correct Answer: BCSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 340You are the Exchange Administrator of ABC Corporation's Exchange 2010 organization. You have configured aDatabase Availability Group (DAG) named DAG01. You need to change the replication port used by the DAG.

What are two things that you must do? (Choose two).

A. Use the Exchange Management Console (EMC) to change the TCP port used for replication.B. Use the Exchange Management Shell to change the TCP port used for replication.C. Modify the Windows Firewall exceptions on each member of the DAG to open the replication port.D. Modify the Windows Firewall exceptions on the witness server of the DAG to open the replication port.E. Use the Exchange Management Shell to configure the DAG IP address of 0.0.0.0.F. Use the Exchange Management Shell to change the DAG IP address to 127.0.0.1.

Correct Answer: BCSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:1. Review the current Exchange 2010 DAG (Database Availability Group) Replication Port:

Get-DatabaseAvailabilitygroup MyDagName status |fl ReplicationPort

The default port: TCP 64327

2. Use netstat na or TCPView to verify that the new replication port isn't used by other application.

3.Change Exchange 2010 DAG (Database Availability Group) Replication Port to TCP 60000:

Page 227: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

DatabaseAvailabilityGroup -identity MyDagName -ReplicationPo

QUESTION 341You are the administrator of ABC Corporation's Exchange 2010 organization.

You notice that all messages sent to recipients in the verigon.com domain, the east.verigon.com domain, andother sub-domains of verigon.com were not delivered. You investigate the problem and you notice that themessages were not delivered because the routing path for delivery was temporarily modified.

You have repaired the routing path. You want to resubmit all messages stored on the server namedExchange55 that were not sent to verigon.com and related domains.

Which of the following commands should you use?

A. Resume-Message -Filter {FromAddress -eq "*verigon.com"}.B. Retry-Queue -Identity "Exchange55\verigon.com" -Resubmit $true.C. Retry-Queue -Identity "Exchange55\Poison" -Resubmit $true.D. Retry-Queue -Identity "Exchange55\Unreachable" -Resubmit $true.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 342You are the Exchange Administrator of ABC Corporation's Exchange 2010 organization. You are concernedthat users' mailboxes are reaching capacity.

You want a report in a table format of all users who have a mailbox on DB01 and their send quotas.

Which of the following should you do?

A. Use the MSExchangeIS Mailbox object in System Monitor, and specify DB01 as the instance.B. Use the MSExchange Database object in System Monitor.C. Run the following script: Get-MailboxStatistics -Database DB01 | ft DisplayName, SendQuota.D. Run the following script: Get-Mailbox -Database DB01 | Format-Table Name, ProhibitSendQuota,

Database.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:

Page 228: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 343Your network contains an internal network and a perimeter network. You have an Exchange Server 2003organization on the internal network.

You install Windows Server 2008 on a new server in the perimeter network.

You need to ensure that you can install the Edge Transport server role on the new server.

What should you do?

A. Install Active Directory Application Mode (ADAM) on the new server.B. Install Active Directory Lightweight Directory Services (AD LDS) on the new server.C. Open TCP port 25 and TCP port 636 on the firewall between the perimeter network and the internal

network.D. Open TCP port 587 and TCP port 3268 on the firewall between the perimeter network and the internal

network.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

To install the Edge Transport server pre-requisites open an elevated Windows PowerShell prompt and run thefollowing command.PS C:\> Import-Module ServerManager

Next run this command to install the required roles and features for the Edge Transport server. PS C:\> Add-WindowsFeature NET-Framework,RSAT-ADDS,ADLDS -Restart

Note that using the -Restart parameter will cause the server to restart automatically to complete the installationof the roles and features.

QUESTION 344You have an Active Directory forest that contains one domain named contoso.com. The functional level of boththe forest and the domain is Windows Server 2003.

You have an Exchange Server 2003 organization. All servers have Exchange Server 2003 Service Pack 2(SP2) installed. You plan to transition to Exchange Server 2010.

You need to prepare the Active Directory environment for the deployment of the first Exchange Server 2010server.

What should you run?

A. Setup.com /PrepareAD.B. Setup.com /PrepareDomain.C. Setup.com /PrepareLegacyExchangePermissions.D. Setup.com /PrepareSchema.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:

Page 229: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 345You install a new Exchange Server 2010 server.

You need to ensure that users can connect from the Internet to the server by using Exchange ActiveSync.

What should you do on the Exchange server?

A. Modify the internal URL for the Microsoft-Server-ActiveSync virtual directory.B. Modify the external URL for the Microsoft-Server-ActiveSync virtual directory.C. Enable Anonymous Authentication for the Microsoft-Server-ActiveSync virtual directory.D. Enable Windows Integrated Authentication for the Microsoft-Server-ActiveSync virtual directory.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 346You have an Active Directory domain named contoso.com.

You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains a Client Access server named CAS1. Usersconnect to CAS1 from the Internet using mail.contoso.com.

The organization contains the following mobile clients:

Windows Mobile 5.0

Windows Mobile 6.1

Windows Mobile 6.5

You plan to install a certificate on CAS1.

You need to ensure that all clients can connect to CAS1 from the Internet using Exchange ActiveSync.

Which name should you include in the certificate?

A. *.contoso.comB. CAS1.contoso.comC. EAS.contoso.comD. mail.contoso.com

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 230: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 347You have an Active Directory forest that contains a single Active Directory site.

Your organization contains the Exchange Server 2010 servers shown in the following table:

Server1 has the Hub Transport and Client Access server roles installed.

Server2 has the Mailbox, Hub Transport and Client Access server roles installed.

All clients connect to Server1 and Server2 from the Internet using IMAP4. You need to prevent some usersfrom using IMAP4 to connect to their mailboxes on Server2.

What should you do?

A. Modify the IMAP4 retrieval settings on Server2.B. Disable the IMAP4 mailbox feature for the mailboxes on Server2.C. On Server1, configure Windows Firewall to block TCP port 25 and TCP port 110.D. On Server2, configure Windows Firewall to block TCP port 110 and TCP port 995.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 348You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization named contoso.com.

You have a Client Access server named cas1.contoso.com that is accessible on the Internet.

You access cas1.contoso.com on the Internet by using the following domain names:

mail.contoso.com

autodiscover.contoso.com

You need to ensure that mobile devices can use Autodiscover on the Internet.

What should you do?

A. Set the external URL for Microsoft-Server-ActiveSync to $NULL.B. Set the external URL for Microsoft-Server-ActiveSync to https://cas1.contoso.com/Microsoft-Server-

ActiveSync.C. Set the external URL for Microsoft-Server-ActiveSync to https://mail.contoso.com /Microsoft-Server-

ActiveSync.D. Set the external URL for Microsoft-Server-ActiveSync to http://autodiscover.contoso.com/Microsoft- Server-

ActiveSync.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)

Page 231: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 349You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. The organization contains two Mailbox servers namedServer1 and Server2. Both servers are members of a database availability group (DAG) named DAG1.

Server1 and Server2 have a copy of a mailbox database named DB1.

You need to remove the copy of DB1 from Server1.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run Clean-MailboxDatabase -Identity DB1.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run Remove-MailboxDatabase -Identity DB1\Server1.C. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), right-click the database copy and select Remove.D. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), right-click DAG1 and select Manage Database

Availability Group Membership. Remove Server1 from the list and click Manage.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:NAMERemove-MailboxDatabaseSYNOPSISUse the Remove-MailboxDatabase cmdlet to delete a mailbox database object. -------------------------- EXAMPLE1 -------------------------- This example removes the mailbox database MailboxDatabase01.

Remove-MailboxDatabase -Identity MailboxDatabase01

NAMERemove-MailboxDatabaseCopySYNOPSISUse the Remove-MailboxDatabaseCopy cmdlet to remove a mailbox database copy from an existing database.You can't use this cmdlet to remove the last copy of a mailbox data base. To remove the last copy of a mailboxdatabase, you must use the Remove-MailboxDatabase cmdlet.

-------------------------- EXAMPLE 1 -------------------------- This example removes a copy of mailbox database DB1from the Mailbox server EXMBX3.

Remove-MailboxDatabaseCopy -Identity DB1\EXMBX3 -Confirm:$false

QUESTION 350Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox server. The server has one mailbox database.

A user named User1 reports that he has multiple corrupted email messages in his mailbox.

You need to recover User1's email messages. The solution must not delete any other email messages in themailbox database.

What should you do?

A. Create a new Mailbox Recovery Database, restore a backup of the database file, and then run the Export-

Page 232: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Mailbox cmdlet.B. Create a new Mailbox Recovery Database, restore a backup of the database file, and then run the Restore-

Mailbox cmdlet.C. Create a database availability group (DAG), restore a backup of the mailbox database file, and then run the

Restore-Mailbox cmdlet.D. Create a database availability group (DAG), restore a backup of the mailbox database file, and then run the

Export-Mailbox cmdlet.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 351You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains a single Mailbox server. The Mailbox servercontains a mailbox database named Database1.

Database1 fails. You need to restore a backup of Database1.

What should you do before you restore Database1?

A. Create a recovery storage group.B. Create a Recovery Mailbox database.C. Set the Recovery parameter on Database1 to $true.D. Set the Allow-FileRestore parameter on Database1 to $true.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Creating an Exchange Server 2010 Recovery Database

The next stage of the recovery process is creating the Recovery Database. Launch the Exchange ManagementShell. Run the New-MailboxDatabase cmdlet with the following parameters:1-Recovery:$true (specifies that the database will be a Recovery Database) 2-EdbFilePath (the path to therestored mailbox database file) 3-LogFolderPath (the path to be used for transaction log files, which must be anempty folder) 4-Server (the server that the recovery is being performed on)

In this example the following command is run.[PS] D:\>New-MailboxDatabase RecoveryDB -Server EX2 -Recovery:$true -EdbFilePath 'D:\Recovery\D_ \Data\EX201\Mailbox Database EX2 01.edb' -LogFolderPath 'D:\Recovery\E_\Logs\EX201-RecoveryDB'

WARNING: Recovery database 'RecoveryDB' was created using existing file

D:\Recovery\D_\Data\EX201\Mailbox Database EX2 01.edb. The database

must be brought into a clean shutdown state before it can be mounted.

Name Server Recovery ReplicationType---- ------ -------- ---------------RecoveryDB EX2 True NoneNote the warning about the database not being in a clean shutdown state. Since we've already brought thedatabase to a clean shutdown state we can now mount the recovery database.[PS] D:\>Mount-Database RecoveryDB

Page 233: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 352You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains a Mailbox server named Server1.

From Server1, a user named Admin1 runs the Export-Mailbox -Identity "User1" -PSTFolderPath C:\Folder\User1.pst command.

Admin1 reports that she receives the following error message: "The term Export-Mailbox is not recognized asthe name of a cmdlet."

You need to ensure that Admin1 can run the command successfully.

Which two actions should you perform? (Each correct answer presents part of the solution. Choose two).

A. Create a Personal Archive for User1.B. Create a Personal Archive for Admin1.C. Install Microsoft Office Outlook 2010 on the Mailbox server.D. Add Admin1 to the Exchange Recipient Administrators security group.E. Run the New-RoleGroup cmdlet, and then run the New-ManagementRoleAssignment cmdlet.

Correct Answer: CESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 353You have an Exchange Server 2010 server that contains a single mailbox database. All users run MicrosoftOffice Outlook and Outlook Web App.

You discover that users cannot restore email messages from the Recover Deleted Items folder. You need toensure that users can restore email messages from the Recover Deleted Items folder.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the mailbox database.B. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the Mailbox server object.C. From the Exchange Management Shell, create a management role and then assign the role to all users.D. From the Exchange Management Shell, create a retention policy and then assign the policy to all users.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 234: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 354Your network contains two Exchange Server 2010 Client Access servers named CAS1 and CAS2 and twoMailbox servers named MBX1 and MBX2.

You have one mailbox database and one public folder database. You need to ensure that the public folders areavailable if MBX1 fails.

What should you do?

A. Create a Failover Cluster and then add MBX1 and MBX2 to the Failover Cluster.B. Create a database availability group (DAG) and then add MBX1 and MBX2 to the DAG.C. Create a public folder database on MBX2 and then modify the replication settings on each public folder.D. Create a public folder database on MBX2 and then modify the replication settings on the public folder

database.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 355You deploy a new Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains three Mailbox servers. Each server islocated in a separate datacenter.You create a public folder named Public1. You need to ensure that a copy of Public1 is stored in eachdatacenter.

Which two actions should you perform? (Each correct answer presents part of the solution. Choose two).

Page 235: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. From the Public Folder Management Console, modify the properties of Public1.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Update-PublicFolder cmdlet.C. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), create a database availability group (DAG).D. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), create a public folder database on all of the Mailbox

servers.E. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), add each of the Mailbox servers to a database

availability group (DAG).

Correct Answer: ADSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 356You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains five Mailbox servers.

A Mailbox server named Server1 hosts a mailbox database named DB1. DB1 contains 300 user mailboxes.

You create a new public folder database named PUBLIC2 on Server1. You need to ensure that all users thathave mailboxes in DB1 store new public folders in PUBLIC2.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Console, modify the properties of DB1.B. From the Exchange Management Console, modify the properties of PUBLIC2.C. From the Exchange Management Console, modify the properties of Server1.D. From the Exchange Management Shell, modify the properties of each mailbox.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 236: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 357You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to prevent users from changing their password by using Outlook Web App (OWA).

What should you do?

A. Create a Group Policy Object.B. Create an Outlook Web App Mailbox policy.C. Modify the authentication settings of the OWA virtual directory.D. Modify the authentication settings of the IISADMPWD virtual directory.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:AhmadSabry:You can enable or disable the Change Password feature for a single user by configuring the user's mailbox, orfor multiple users by configuring the /owa virtual directory or another virtual directory that's used for OutlookWeb App. You can enable or disable the Change Password feature by using segmentation. For moreinformation

Ref: http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/bb684904.aspx ----------------------------------------

This question is confusing as two answers are correct. If you wish to disable the changing of passwordsthrough OWA for all domain users, then you would use the following command:

Set-OwaVirtualDirectory -Identity <OWAVirtualDirectoryName> -ChangePasswordEnabled $false

However, if you wish to prevent certain users from changing their passwords through OWA, then you use theSegmentation tab of the OWA mailbox policy in the EMC. Or, alternatively, you could use the followingcommand:

Page 237: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

New-OWAMailboxPolicy -Name 'OWA Mailbox Policy Name' | Set-OWAMailboxPolicy -ChangePasswordEnabled $falseI have gone for the former answer as it does not specify that it should only be configured for certain individualusers.

QUESTION 358You configure Outlook Web App (OWA) to require SSL. A user named User1 reports that when she connectsto OWA, she receives a Web site security certificate warning message.

You need to prevent User1 from receiving the warning message when she connects to OWA.

What should you do?

A. On User1's computer, install the server's root certificate into the Trusted Root Certification Authorities store.B. On the Client Access server, install the server's root certificate into the Trusted Root Certification Authorities

store.C. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), assign an Outlook Web App mailbox policy to User1.D. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), open the OWA (Default Web Site) Properties.

Configure the logon format to use the user principal name (UPN).

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Exam J

QUESTION 359You have a server that runs Windows Server 2008 Service Pack 2 (SP2). You plan to install Exchange Server2010 on the server.

You need to install the Exchange Server 2010 prerequisites for the Mailbox, Client Access, and Hub Transportserver roles.

What should you do on the server?

A. Install Microsoft .NET Framework 3.5 Service Pack 1 (SP1).

Install Windows Management Framework.

Run ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP ExchangeTypical.xml.

B. Install Microsoft .NET Framework 3.5 Service Pack 1 (SP1).

Install Windows Remote Management (WinRM) 2.0.

Run ServerManagerCmd.exe -IP ExchangeBase.xml.

C. Install Windows Management Framework.

Page 238: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Install Message Queuing.

Install the Web Server role.

D. Install Windows Management Framework.

Install the Web Server role.

Install the RPC over HTTP Proxy component.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 360You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to ensure that you can install the Exchange Server 2010 administration tools on a desktop computerthat runs Windows 7.

What should you install first?

A. IIS 6 Management Console.

Microsoft .NET Framework 3.5.1.

B. IIS 6 Metabase.

Remote Server Administration Tools.

C. Internet Explorer 8.

Windows Process Activation Service.

D. Management Service.

Microsoft Message Queue (MSMQ) Server.

Page 239: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 361Your company has a main office and a branch office.

All branch office administrators are members of a custom management role group. The role group is configuredto allow members to manage recipients.The branch office administrators are also members of the Domain Administrators security group. Theorganization contains one Exchange Server 2010 server.

You discover that the branch office administrators can manage recipients in both offices.

You need to ensure that the branch office administrators can manage recipients in their assigned branch officeonly.

What should you do?

A. Create a new management role entry for the role group.B. Create a management role assignment policy and associate the policy to the role group.C. Create a management scope and associate the scope to the role group.

Set a recipient filter for the management scope.

D. Remove the branch office administrators from the Domain Admins group.

Add the branch office recipients to the role group.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 362You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains 20 mailbox databases. You configure eachdatabase to retain all deleted items for 30 days.

You need to ensure that all items that pass the retention period are permanently deleted daily between 02:00and 06:00.

Which cmdlet should you use?

A. Set-MailboxDatabase.B. Set-MailboxServer.C. Set-OrganizationConfig.

Page 240: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

D. Set-RetentionPolicy.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 363You have two Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox servers named Server1 and Server2.

You need to move a user's mailbox from Server1 to Server2. Your solution must minimize downtime for theuser.

Which cmdlet should you run?

A. Movemailbox.B. Export-Mailbox.C. Set-MoveRequest.D. New-MoveRequest.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 364You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization named contoso.com. Your company is investigating a usernamed User1.

You need to prevent User1 from permanently deleting items from his mailbox.

What should you run?

A. Set-Mailbox User1 LitigationHoldEnabled $true.B. Set-Mailbox User1 ModerationEnabled $true.C. Set-Mailbox User1 RetainDeletedItemsUntilBackup $true.D. Set-Mailbox User1 RetentionHoldEnabled $true.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 365You need to group a set of cmdlets for administrative delegation.

What should you create?

A. A managed folder mailbox policy.B. A new distribution group.

Page 241: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. A new management role.D. A new role assignment policy.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:A management role assignment is the link between a management role and a role assignment policy.Assigning a management role to a role assignment policy grants the ability to use the cmdlets and parametersdefined in the management role. When you create a role assignment between a role assignment policy and amanagement role, you can't specify any scope. The scope applied by the assignment is based on themanagement role and is either Self or MyGAL.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd638100.aspx

QUESTION 366You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to ensure that a user can open a resource mailbox.

What are two possible ways to achieve this goal? (Each correct answer presents a complete solution.Choose two).

A. From Microsoft Office Outlook, modify the properties of the resource mailbox.B. From the Exchange Management Console, create a new sharing policy.C. From the Exchange Management Shell, set the ResourceDelegates parameter for the resource mailbox.D. From the Active Directory Users and Computers console, reset the password for the account associated to

the resource mailbox, and then provide the password to the user.

Correct Answer: ACSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 367You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to ensure that all users in the organization can view the availability of a company projector.

What should you create for the projector?

A. A distribution group.B. A mailbox.C. A mailenabled contact.D. A sharing policy.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:

Page 242: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 368You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

A user named User1 reports that some of the meetings in her calendar display incorrect start times. You verifythat the meeting organizers have the correct start times for all of the meetings.

You need to ensure that all of the meetings in User1's calendar have the correct start times.

What should you do?

A. Run the Set-MailboxCalendarConfiguration cmdlet.B. Set the schedule for the Calendar Repair Assistant (CRA).C. From User1's computer, run Outlook.exe /CleanFreeBusy.D. From the properties of User1's mailbox, modify the Calendar Settings.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 369You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. You create a distribution group for all users in your company.

You need to ensure that new users can add their mailboxes to the distribution group.

What should you do?

A. Modify the group scope of the distribution group.B. Modify the approval mode of the distribution group.C. Modify the security settings of the distribution group.D. Modify the authentication settings of the ECP virtual directory.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 243: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 370You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. You need to modify the permissions of a public folder.Which tool should you use?

A. Exchange Control Panel (ECP).B. Exchange Management Console (EMC).C. Microsoft Office Outlook.D. Public Folder Management Console.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:I changed the answer from C: to D.The question says (Which tool) , yes it can be done from the individual user Public folder permissions in outlook, but this is a tool in Exchange is more closer as far I understand.

Also Review: http://blogs.msexchange.org/walther/2010/04/07/manage-public-folders-using-the-new- manage-settings-wizard-in-exchange-2010-sp1/

Page 244: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox
Page 245: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 371Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 server.

You need to prevent a user named User1 from using Exchange ActiveSync to download attachments that arelarger than 50KB. The solution must not affect other users.

What should you do?

A. Modify the properties of User1's mailbox.B. Run the Manage Mobile Phone wizard for User1's mailbox.C. Create a new Exchange ActiveSync mailbox policy and assign the policy to User1.D. Create a new Exchange ActiveSync virtual directory and configure User1 to connect to the new virtual

directory.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Page 246: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 372Your network contains a single Active Directory site. You install 10 new Exchange Server 2010 Client Accessservers. All servers are configured to use a wildcard certificate.

Users connect to their mailboxes by using Windows Mobile 6.5 devices. All devices are configured to connectto cas.contoso.com.

You need to ensure that users can connect to their mailboxes by using mail.contoso.com.

Which cmdlet should you run?

A. Set-ActiveSyncDeviceAccessRule.B. Set-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicy.C. Set-ActiveSyncOrganizationSetting.D. Set-ActiveSyncVirtualDirectory.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Set-PowerShellVirtualDirectory "Contoso (default Web site)" -ExternalUrl "http://www.contoso.com/ powershell"

QUESTION 373You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization named contoso.com.

Your organization contains the following:

Two Client Access Servers named CAS1 and CAS2.

A Client Access array named array1.contoso.com.

An Outlook Anywhere external URL that is set to oa.contoso.com.

You need to issue an X.509 certificate for Outlook Anywhere on CAS1.contoso.com.

What domain name should you specify for the certificate?

A. *.contoso.com.B. oa.contoso.com.C. CAS1.contoso.com.D. OWA.contoso.com.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Page 247: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A wildcard certificate is designed to support a domain and multiple subdomains. For example, configuring awildcard certificate for *.contoso.com results in a certificate that will work for mail.contoso.com, web.contoso.com, and autodiscover.contoso.com.

How to configure it:http://www.windowsinfo.eu/?p=236

QUESTION 374You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

All users on the network run Microsoft Office Outlook 2010 to access their mailboxes. Outlook 2010 isconfigured for Outlook Anywhere by using Autodiscover.You create a Client Access server array named outlook.contoso.com. You verify that all computers can resolveoutlook.contoso.com.

You discover that users do not connect to the Client Access server array name from Outlook 2010. You need toensure that all users connect to the Client Access server array to access their mailboxes.

What should you do?

A. Modify the authentication settings of the RPC virtual directory.B. Modify the RPC Client Access server property of the mailbox databases.C. Set the Outlook Anywhere FQDN to outlook.contoso.com.D. Set the external URL of the Exchange Web Services virtual directory to https://outlook.contoso.com/ews.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 375You purchase a wildcard certificate. You plan to use the certificate for Outlook Anywhere.

You need to configure an Exchange organization to use the certificate.

What should you do first?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, modify the properties of the WEB Outlook Provider.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, modify the properties of the EXPR Outlook Provider.C. From the Internet Information Services (IIS) Manager, modify the properties of the RPC virtual directory.D. From the Internet Information Services (IIS) Manager, modify the properties of the Autodiscover virtual

directory.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Firstly we need to enable Outlook Anywhere on our Exchange Server, secondly we need to tell Exchange touse our wildcard certificate for outlook anywhere connections. We can do that with the Powershell command

Set-OutlookProvider EXPR -CertPrincipalName msstd:*.contoso.com We should also set the Outlook clientwith the same settings, although outlook 2010 using Autodiscover should automatically set the correct settingsin the user profile, the good idea is to check if everything is correct.

Page 248: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 376You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. All users access their mailboxes by using Microsoft OfficeOutlook 2007, Outlook Anywhere, and Autodiscover.

You need to prevent users who have computers that are joined to the domain from being prompted forauthentication when they use Outlook Anywhere. All other users must be prompted for authentication when theyuse Outlook Anywhere.

What should you do?

A. Configure Outlook Anywhere to use Basic authentication. Enable Basic authentication and NTLMauthentication on the RPC virtual directory.

B. Configure Outlook Anywhere to use NTLM authentication. Enable Basic authentication and NTLMauthentication on the RPC virtual directory.

C. Configure Outlook Anywhere to use Basic authentication. Enable Basic authentication and NTLMauthentication on the RpcWithCert virtual directory.

D. Configure Outlook Anywhere to use NTLM authentication. Enable Basic authentication and NTLMauthentication on the RpcWithCert virtual directory.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 377Your company's organization is authoritative for the contoso.com domain. Your network contains a WindowsServer 2008 R2 certification authority (CA).

Page 249: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You have an Exchange Server 2010 server named Server1. Server1 has the Client Access, Hub Transport, andMailbox server roles installed.You plan to create a federated sharing relationship between your company and another company namedNorthwind Traders. Northwind Traders has an internal root CA.

You need to install a certificate that can be used to create the federated trust. The solution must minimizecosts.

What should you do from Server1?

A. Generate a selfsigned certificate.B. Request a Computer certificate from the contoso.com CA.C. Create a computer certificate request and submit the request to a third party trusted CA.D. Create a computer certificate request and submit the request to the Northwind Traders CA.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 378You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to prevent users from changing their password using Outlook Web App (OWA).

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the authentication settings of the ECP virtualdirectory.

B. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the segmentation settings of the OWA virtualdirectory.

C. From the Internet Information Services (IIS) Manager, modify the application settings of the ECP virtualdirectory.

D. From the Internet Information Services (IIS) Manager, modify the authentication settings of the OWA virtualdirectory.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

http://www.gratisexam.com/

Page 250: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 379You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

Users access their mailboxes using Microsoft Office Outlook 2010 and Outlook Web App (OWA).

Users report that they cannot open Information Rights Management (IRM) protected email messages in OWA.

Users can open IRM protected email from Outlook 2010. You need to ensure that users can open IRMprotected email in OWA.

What should you do?

A. Modify the organization's IRM configuration for OWA.B. Instruct the users to add the OWA URL to their Trusted sites.C. Modify the Active Directory Rights Management Services (AD RMS) Prelicensing Agent on the Hub

Transport servers.D. Add a Federated Delivery mailbox to the Active Directory Rights Management Services (AD RMS)

SuperUsers group.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:

Page 251: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 380You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

A user named Admin1 sends frequent email messages to a moderated recipient named Group1.

You need to ensure that all email messages sent by Admin1 to Group1 are delivered immediately.

What should you do?

A. Modify the permissions of Admin1.B. Modify the permissions of Group1.C. Configure Admin1 as the owner of Group1.D. Configure Admin1 as a moderator for Group1.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 381You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization named contoso.com.

You need to add a disclaimer to all email messages sent by members of a mail-enabled group named Group1.

The solution must only affect email messages sent to the Internet.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), create a transport rule.B. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the mail flow settings of Group1.C. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the NewRemoteDomain cmdlet, and then run the Set-

SendConnector cmdlet.D. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the NewSystemMessage cmdlet, and then run the Set-

SendConnector cmdlet.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 382Your company acquires a new internet domain name.

You need to ensure that all users can receive email messages sent to the new domain name.

Which two actions should you perform? (Each correct answer presents part of the solution. Choose two).

A. Modify the email address policy.B. Create an Authoritative accepted domain.C. Create an External Relay accepted domain.

Page 252: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

D. Modify the properties of the default Receive connector.E. Generate a new Exchange certificate that contains the new domain name.

Correct Answer: ABSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 383You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization that contains 50 Hub Transport servers.

You need to minimize the amount of disk space used to store shadow copies of messages on the HubTransport servers.

What should you do?

A. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-TransportConfig cmdlet.B. From the Exchange Management Shell, run the Set-TransportServer cmdlet.C. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the transport settings.D. From the Exchange Management Console (EMC), modify the properties of the Hub Transport server.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Use the ShadowMessageAutoDiscardInterval parameter of the Set-TransportConfig cmdlet to configure themaximum age for shadow messages in your organization. By default, shadow messages are discardedautomatically after two days.

Assume that due to the hardware constraints on your servers, you don't want to retain shadow copies formessages that are delayed. This example reduces the retention period of shadow messages to four hours foryour organization.

Set-TransportConfig -ShadowMessageAutoDiscardInterval 04:00:00

Note:When a message expires, the primary server queues a discard event for that message, and the shadow serverdiscards the shadow message when it receives the discard notification. The value you configure for theShadowMessageAutoDiscardInterval parameter should be equal to or lower than the message expiration time-out interval configured on your transport servers.

QUESTION 384Your network contains an Exchange Server 2010 Edge Transport server named Server1. You install a newExchange Server 2010 Edge Transport server named Server2.

You need to copy all of the Edge Transport configurations from Server1 to Server2.

Which two actions should you perform on Server1? (Each correct answer presents part of the solution.Choose two).

A. Back up the system state.B. Run the ExportEdgeConfig.PS1 script.C. Run the Export-ExchangeCertificate cmdlet.

Page 253: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

D. Run the New-EdgeSyncServiceConfig cmdlet.E. Run the Export-TransportRuleCollection cmdlet.

Correct Answer: BESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 385You have an Active Directory forest named contoso.com. You install a new Exchange Server 2010 organizationthat contains a Client Access server named CAS1.

You need to configure certificates in the organization to support the following client connections:

Autodiscover.

Outlook Anywhere.

Exchange ActiveSync.

What should you do?

A. Re-issue a self-signed certificate to CAS1.B. Configure the Default Web Site on CAS1 to require SSL.C. Issue a trusted certificate that contains multiple subject alternate names.D. Install Active Directory Rights Management Service (AD RMS) on a member server.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 386You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to ensure that a user named User1 can access his mailbox using Outlook Web App only.

What should you do?

A. Modify the mailbox features for User1.B. Enable and configure Outlook Anywhere.C. Create an Outlook Web App Mailbox policy.D. Remove the Autodiscover record from the DNS zone.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Page 254: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 387You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. You plan to enable federated sharing.

You need to create a DNS record to store the Application Identifier (AppID) of the domain for the federatedtrust.

Which type of record should you create?

A. A.B. CNAME.C. SRV.D. TXT.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:To provide proof of ownership of the registered Internet domain, you must create a text (TXT) record in theDomain Name System (DNS) zone of each accepted domain you want to federate. The TXT record containsthe federated domain proof encryption string generated when you run the Get- FederatedDomainProof cmdletfor each domain.

1- In DNS Manager, expand the DNS server you want, and then expand Forward Lookup Zones. 2- Select theforward lookup zone in which you want to create the TXT record. 3- From the menu bar, navigate to Action >Other New Records. 4- In Resource Record Type, select Text (TXT), and then click Create Record.5- In New Resource Record, complete the following fields:*Record name (uses parent domain if left blank) Leave this field blank, allowing it to create a record with thesame name as the domain name.*Fully qualified domain name type (FQDN) This read-only field displays the FQDN created by concatenating therecord name to the domain name.*Text Type the federated domain proof string that was generated when you ran the Get-FederatedDomainProof cmdlet.( Get-FederatedDomainProof -DomainName contoso.com)For example, if the federated domain proof string is 7Zyr2i/fE/M/T3AwCpitDbF30Fk/TdzXME6f7d1lDaKGthPdoS+UF94t43D2nU5hLNnIAP+5A3jJR2ik9HDPgg==, you would enter the entire stringin the Text field.6- Click OK, and then click Done to create the record.

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ee423548.aspx

QUESTION 388You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. The organization is authoritative for the domain contoso.com.

You create a federated trust.

You need to ensure that federated partners can automatically locate the Client Access servers in theorganization.

What should you create from an external DNS server?

A. an A record for autodiscover.contoso.com.B. an A record for FederatedSharing.contoso.com.

Page 255: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. an SRV record for _autodiscover._TCP._msdcs.contoso.com.D. an SRV record for _FederatedSharing._UDP._msdcs.contoso.com.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:As mentioned in another question, this should actually be a CNAME record, according to Technet, but I left thisin here as an A record for contoso.com would need creating before the CNAME for autodiscover. contoso.com.The exam will only mention CNAME records though.

Reference:

http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/ff601760.aspx

QUESTION 389You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization. Users access their email from the Internet by using OutlookWeb App.

You need to prevent users from downloading ZIP files from Outlook Web App. The solution must ensure thatusers can download ZIP files using Microsoft Office Outlook.

What should you do?

A. Configure the Content Filter agent.B. Configure the Attachment Filter agent.C. Create a managed folder mailbox policy.D. Create an Outlook Web App Mailbox policy.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:http://technet.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd297989.aspx

You can get all allowed file types: Get-OwaMailboxPolicy | select AllowedFileTypes -ExpandPropertyAllowedFileTypes

to allow:Set-OwaMailboxPolicy -Identity Default -AllowedFileTypes '.doc', '.pdf'

to block:Set-OwaMailboxPolicy -Identity Default -BlockedFileTypes '.exe'

QUESTION 390You have an Exchange Server 2010 organization.

You need to prevent users in the organization from changing passwords using Outlook Web App. The solutionmust not prevent users from changing passwords by using Windows.

What should you do?

A. From the properties of the user accounts, configure the settings on the Account tab.B. From the properties of the mailboxes, configure the settings on the Mailbox Features tab.

Page 256: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. From the properties of the OWA virtual directory, configure the settings on the Segmentation tab.D. From the properties of the OWA virtual directory, configure the settings on the Authentication tab.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

QUESTION 391You need to perform an automated installation of an Exchange Server 2010 server.

Which command should you include in your script?

A. Setup.exeB. Setup.comC. Msiexec.exeD. lpsetupui.exe

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Page 257: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Exam K

QUESTION 392In which of the following circumstances should you run the command Setup /PrepareLegacyExchangePermissions?

A. Your organization has an existing Exchange Server 2010 organization.B. Your organization has an existing Exchange Server 2003 organization.C. Your organization has an existing Exchange Server 2007 organization.D. Exchange has not previously been deployed in your organization.

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: It is not necessary to run Setup /PrepareLegacyExchangePermissions if your organization has anexisting Exchange Server 2010 deployment. B. Correct: It is necessary to run Setup /PrepareLegacyExchangePermissions only if your organization has an existing Exchange Server 2003organization. C. Incorrect: It is not necessary to run Setup /PrepareLegacyExchangePermissions if yourorganization has an existing Exchange Server 2007 deployment. D. Incorrect: It is not necessary to run Setup /PrepareLegacyExchangePermissions if your organization has not previously deployed Exchange.

QUESTION 393You work for an Australian government department. You are preparing to deploy Exchange Server 2010 to yourorganization's Traralgon site. All domain controllers at the Traralgon site have Windows Server 2003 Standardedition (x86) installed. One of the domain controllers at the Traralgon site functions as a global catalog server.Which of the following steps allows you to deploy Exchange Server 2010 to this site while minimizing theamount of administrative effort involved?

A. Upgrade all domain controllers at the Traralgon site to Windows Server 2008 Standard edition (x86)B. Upgrade all domain controllers at the Traralgon site to Windows Server 2008 R2 Standard edition (x64)C. Ensure that Service Pack 1 or later is installed on each domain controller running Windows Server 2003

Standard Edition at the Traralgon siteD. Upgrade all domain controllers at the Traralgon site to Windows Server 2003 R2 Enterprise edition (x64)

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: You should not upgrade the domain controllers to Windows Server 2008, as this would requireunnecessary administrative effort. Applying a service pack will prepare the site for the deployment of ExchangeServer 2010.B. Incorrect: You should not upgrade the domain controllers to Windows Server 2008 R2. Applying a servicepack will prepare the site for the deployment of Exchange Server 2010. C. Correct: Prior to deploying ExchangeServer 2010 to a site, you should ensure that the global catalog server at the site is running the WindowsServer 2003 Service Pack 1 operating system or later.D. Incorrect: You should not upgrade the domain controllers to Windows Server 2008 R2. Applying a servicepack will prepare the site for the deployment of Exchange Server 2010.

Page 258: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 394Your organization has Exchange Server 2003 deployed as a messaging solution. You are planning a period ofcoexistence between Exchange Server 2003 and Exchange Server 2010. Which of the following steps shouldyou take to prepare the computers that host Exchange Server 2003 for the introduction of Exchange Server2010?

A. Ensure that the servers are configured with Exchange Server 2003 Service Pack 1B. Ensure that the servers hosting Exchange Server 2003 are upgraded to Windows Server 2008C. Ensure that the servers hosting Exchange Server 2003 are upgraded to Windows Server 2003 R2D. Ensure that the servers are configured with Exchange Server 2003 Service Pack 2

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: Servers that have Exchange Server 2003 installed must have Exchange Server 2003 Service Pack2 applied to allow for coexistence with Exchange Server 2010. B. Incorrect: It is not necessary to upgrade thehost platform to Windows Server 2008 to allow for coexistence with Exchange Server 2010. Exchange Server2003 cannot be installed on Windows Server 2008.C. Incorrect: It is not necessary to upgrade the host platform to Windows Server 2008 to allow for coexistencewith Exchange Server 2010.D. Correct: Servers that have Exchange Server 2003 installed must have Exchange Server 2003 Service Pack2 applied to allow for coexistence with Exchange Server 2010.

QUESTION 395Your existing Exchange Server 2003 organization contains three routing groups. As a part of configuring yourexisting organization for coexistence with ExchangeServer 2010, you need to suppress minor link state updates. Which of the following tools can you use toaccomplish this goal?

A. Registry EditorB. Exchange Management ConsoleC. Exchange Management ShellD. Exchange System Manager

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: AA. Correct: You suppress minor link state updates by editing the registry on every Exchange Server 2003.B. Incorrect: You cannot suppress minor link state updates by using Exchange Management Console.C. Incorrect: You cannot suppress minor link state updates by using Exchange Management Shell.D. Incorrect: Although you can use Exchange System Manager to manage an Exchange Server 2003organization, you cannot use this tool to suppress minor link state updates.

QUESTION 396Which of the following commands can you use to determine which computer in your organization holds theSchema Master role?

A. dsquery

Page 259: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

B. dsgetC. dsaddD. dsmod

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: AA. Correct: You can use the command dsquery server hasfsmo schema command to determine whichcomputer holds the Schema Master role.

B. Incorrect: You cannot use the dsget command-line utility to determine which computer in the organizationhosts the Schema Master role. Dsget provides information about specific objects but does not query ActiveDirectory for information about specific FSMO roles.

C. Incorrect: The dsadd utility is used to add objects to Active Directory. It cannot be used to determine whichcomputer holds the Schema Master role.

D. Incorrect: The dsmod utility is used to modify objects in Active Directory. You cannot use this utility todetermine which computer holds the Schema Master role.

QUESTION 397Which of the following additional components should you install on a computer running Windows Server 2008R2 Enterprise edition (x64) if you wanted that computer to host the Exchange Server 2010 Hub Transportserver role?

A. Silverlight 3 or laterB. Microsoft Data Engine (MSDE)C. Office System Converter: Microsoft Filter PackD. Microsoft Office Outlook Connector 12.1 or later

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:1. Correct Answers: A and CA. Correct: The Office System Converter: Microsoft Filter Pack is used with the Mailbox and Hub Transportroles.B. Incorrect: The Client Access role does not utilize the Office System Converter: Microsoft Filter Pack.C. Correct: The Office System Converter: Microsoft Filter Pack is used with the Mailbox and Hub Transportroles.D. Incorrect: The Edge Transport role does not utilize the Office System Converter:Microsoft Filter Pack.

QUESTION 398On computers running which of the following operating systems can you install Exchange Server 2010?

A. Windows Server 2003 R2 (x64) Enterprise editionB. Windows Server 2008 Standard edition with Service Pack 2 (x64)C. Windows Server 2008 Enterprise edition with Service Pack 2 (x86)D. Windows Server 2003 Datacenter edition (x64) with Service Pack 2

Page 260: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:2. Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: You cannot install Exchange Server 2010 on computers running the Windows Server 2003 orWindows Server 2003 R2 operating system.B. Correct: You can install Exchange Server 2010 on a computer running Windows Server 2008 Standardedition as long as it is the x64 version and has Service Pack 2 installed. C. Incorrect: You cannot installExchange Server 2010 on a computer running an x86 version of Windows Server 2008.D. Incorrect: You cannot install Exchange Server 2010 on computers running the Windows Server 2003 orWindows Server 2003 R2 operating system.

QUESTION 399A Windows Server 2008 R2 (x64) server has been installed and joined to your organization's Active Directorydomain. The server has undergone no additional configuration. You use the following PowerShell commands toprepare the server to host the Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox, Hub Transport, and Client Access server roles:Import-Module ServerManagerAdd-WindowsFeature RSAT-ADDS,Web-Server,Web-Basic-Auth,Web-Windows-Auth,Web- Metabase,Web-Net-Ext,Web-Lgcy-Mgmt-Console,WAS-Process-Model,RSAT-Web-Server,Web- ISAPI-Ext,Web-Digest-Auth,Web-Dyn-Compression,NET-HTTP-Activation,RPC-Over-HTTP- ProxyWhich of the following additional commands would you issue to configure the server to support the designatedExchange Server 2010 roles? (Choose all that apply; each answer forms part of a complete solution.)

A. Add-WindowsFeature NET-FrameworkB. Add-WindowsFeature SMTP-ServerC. Set-Service -Name NetTcpPortSharing -StartupType AutomaticD. Set-Service -Name SNMPTRAP -StartupType Automatic

Correct Answer: ACSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answers: A and CA. Correct: You need to install the .NET Framework feature to support Exchange Server 2010. B. Incorrect: Youdo not need to add the SMTP feature to support Exchange Server 2010. C. Correct: You need to ensure thatthe Net.Tcp Port Sharing service is set to start automatically to support Exchange Server 2010.D. Incorrect: You do not need to configure the SNMP Trap service to support Exchange Server 2010.

QUESTION 400You want to delegate the setup of several branch office Exchange Server 2010 servers to local IT staff at theremote locations. Which of the following commands must you use before a user that is a member of theDelegated Setup role group is able to install a server named SYD-MBX02?

A. Setup.com /PrepareTopologyB. Setup.com /RemoveProvisionedServer:SYD-MBX02C. Setup.com /NewProvisionedServer:SYD-MBX02D. Setup.com /mode:Install

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Page 261: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: Setup.com /PrepareTopology is used to prepare Active Directory. The command cannot be usedto allow a user who is a member of the Delegated Setup role to install Exchange Server 2010.B. Incorrect: The Setup.com /RemoveProvisionedServer:SYD-MBX02 command. C. Correct: You must run theSetup /NewProvisionedServer:SYD-MBX02 command to provision SYD- MBX02 so that it can be setup by auser who is a member of the Delegated Setup role group. D. Incorrect: You do not use the Setup.com /mide:install command to provision a server to allow a user who is a member of the Delegated Setup role toinstall Exchange Server 2010.

QUESTION 401Your organization s network is configured with five sites. You install the Exchange Server 2010 Hub Transport,Client Access server, and Mailbox server roles in the head office site. You install the Edge Transport server roleon the head office site perimeter network. You are preparing to deploy Exchange Server 2010 roles to each ofthe four branch office sites. Which of the following roles must you deploy to each site to ensure that emailmessages flow and client access at each site functions correctly? (Choose all that apply; each answer formspart of a complete solution.)

A. Hub Transport serverB. Edge Transport serverC. Mailbox serverD. Client Access server

Correct Answer: ACDSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answers: A, C, and DA. Correct: You need to deploy the Hub Transport and Mailbox server roles to ensure that mail flow at eachbranch office site functions correctly.B. Incorrect: You do not need to deploy the Edge Transport server role at each site to ensure that mail flow orclient access at each branch office site functions correctly. C. Correct: You need to deploy the Hub Transportand Mailbox server roles to ensure that mail flow at each branch office site functions correctly.D. Correct: You need to deploy the Client Access server role at each site to ensure that client access at eachbranch office site functions correctly.

QUESTION 402Which of the following commands can you use to install the Mailbox and Hub Transport server ExchangeServer 2010 roles on an appropriately configuredWindows Server 2008 R2 host?

A. Setup.com /mode:Install /role:HT,MB. Setup.com /mode:Uninstall /role:HT,MC. Setup.com /mode:Install /role:C,MD. Setup.com /mode:Uninstall /role:C,M

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: AA. Correct: You can use the command setup.com /mode:Install /role:HT,M to install the Mailbox and Hub

Page 262: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Transport server roles on an appropriately configured Windows Server 2008 R2 host.B. Incorrect: The command setup.com /mode:Uninstall /role:HT,M removes the Hub Transport and Mailboxserver roles from a computer running Exchange Server 2010. C. Incorrect: The command setup.com /mode:install /role:C,M installs the Client Access and Mailbox server roles. It does not install the Hub Transportserver role as specified in the question text.D. Incorrect: The command setup.com /mode:Uninstall /role:C,M removes the Client Access and Mailboxserver roles from a computer running Exchange Server 2010

QUESTION 403Each branch office site in your organization is configured so that one server hosts the Mailbox, Client Access,and Hub Transport server roles. You have installed an additional server at each site and added just the ClientAccess and Hub Transport Server roles to this additional server. You want to remove the Client Access andHub Transport server roles from each of the original servers while leaving the servers functioning as ExchangeServer 2010 mailbox servers. Which of the following commands allows you to accomplish this goal?

A. Setup.com /mode:Install /role:MailboxB. Setup.com /mode:Uninstall /role:MailboxC. Setup.com /mode:Install /role:ClientAccess,HubTransportD. Setup.com /mode:Uninstall /role:ClientAccess,HubTransport

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: You should not use the command Setup.com /mode:Install /role:Mailbox, as this will attempt toinstall the Mailbox server role on a computer that already has this role. B. Incorrect: You should not use thecommand Setup.com /mode:Uninstall /role:Mailbox , as this will remove the Mailbox server role when youwanted to retain this role on the branch office server.C. Incorrect: You should not use the command Setup.com /mode:Install / role:ClientAccess,HubTransport, asthis command attempts to install the Client Access and Hub Transport server roles rather than remove theseroles as specified in the question text. D. Correct: The command Setup.com /mode:Uninstall /role:ClientAccess,HubTransport removes the Client Access and Hub Transport server roles from an existingcomputer running Exchange Server 2010.

QUESTION 404Which of the following Exchange Management Shell cmdlets can you use to verify that a specific set of roleshas been successfully installed on a computer running Exchange Server 2010?

A. Test-SystemHealthB. Set-ExchangeServerC. Get-ExchangeServerD. Test-ServiceHealth

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: The Test-SystemHealth cmdlet allows you to gather information about an Exchange Server systemso that it can be used for an analysis of the data with respect to best practices. This cmdlet does not provideyou with a list of roles deployed in a specific server that hosts Exchange Server 2010.B. Incorrect: The Set-ExchangeServer cmdlet allows you to configure attributes within Active Directory for aparticular server. This cmdlet does not provide you with a list of roles deployed in a specific server that hosts

Page 263: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Exchange Server 2010. C. Correct: The Get-ExchangeServer cmdlet can be used to verify which roles havebeen deployed to a specific computer that has Exchange Server 2010 installed. D. Incorrect: The Test-ServiceHealth cmdlet allows you to verify that all Microsoft Windows services that Exchange Server 2010depends on have started properly. This cmdlet does not provide you with a list of roles deployed in a specificserver that hosts Exchange Server 2010.

QUESTION 405Which of the following roles allows a user to install an Exchange Server 2010 mailbox server in an existingExchange Server 2010 organization?

A. Discovery ManagementB. Recipient ManagementC. Organization ManagementD. Public Folder Management

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: Users delegated the Discovery Management role can perform searches of mailboxes. They areunable to install Mailbox servers in an existing Exchange Server 2010 organization.B. Incorrect: Users delegated the Recipient Management role are able to create or modify recipients. They areunable to install Mailbox servers in an existing Exchange Server 2010 organization.C. Correct: A user needs to be delegated the Organization Management role if Exchange Server 2010 Mailboxservers are to be installed in an Active Directory forest where Exchange Server 2010 has already beendeployed.D. Incorrect: Users delegated the Public Folder Management role are able to manage public folders. They areunable to install Mailbox servers in an existing Exchange Server 2010 organization.

QUESTION 406Which of the following Exchange Server 2010 roles requires that you deploy Office System Converter:Microsoft Filter Pack prior to role deployment? (Choose all that apply; each answer forms a complete solution.)

A. MailboxB. Client AccessC. Hub TransportD. Edge Transport

Correct Answer: ACSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answers: A and CA. Correct: The Office System Converter: Microsoft Filter Pack is used with the Mailbox and Hub Transportroles.B. Incorrect: The Client Access role does not utilize the Office System Converter: Microsoft Filter Pack.C. Correct: The Office System Converter: Microsoft Filter Pack is used with the Mailbox and Hub Transportroles.D. Incorrect: The Edge Transport role does not utilize the Office System Converter:Microsoft Filter Pack.

QUESTION 407

Page 264: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

You have used the EMS to create a mailbox database called Marketing on the server VAN-EX1 and to set thewarning quota on that database to 2.5 GB. You now want to enable it to be used to provision new mailboxes.What EMS command do you enter?

A. New-MailboxDatabase "Name Marketing "Server VAN-EX1B. Set-MailboxDatabase "Identity Marketing "IssueWarningQuota 2.5GBC. Mount-Database "Identity MarketingD. Dismount-Database "Identity Marketing

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: This command creates the database, and it is likely that you have already used it. It does notenable the database to be used to provision new mailboxes. B. Incorrect: This command sets the databasewarning quota, and it is likely that you have already used it. It does not enable the database to be used toprovision new mailboxes. C. Correct: This command mounts the database. You need to mount the database toenable it to be used to provision new mailboxes.D. Incorrect: This command dismounts the database. To enable the database to be used to provision newmailboxes, you need to mount it, not dismount it.

QUESTION 408Currently, both the database and transaction log files for the Sales mailbox database are in the same folder onthe C: volume. You want to move the transaction logs to the E:\SalesTransactionLog folder. What is the firstcommand that you enter in the EMS in order to accomplish this?

A. Dismount-Database "Identity SalesB. Mount-Database "Identity SalesC. Set-MailboxDatabase "Identity Sales "LogFolderPath E:\ SalesTransactionLogD. Move-DatabasePath "Identity Sales "LogFolderPath E:\ SalesTransactionLog

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: You do not need to dismount a database before entering the command to move the path to itstransaction logs. The Move-DatabasePath cmdlet automatically dismounts the database if it is mounted, movesthe path, and then, if appropriate, mounts the database again.B. Incorrect: You do not need to mount a database before moving its transaction log file path. C. Incorrect: Youcan use the Set-MailboxDatabase cmdlet to configure most database properties but not to move file paths. Youneed to use the Move-Database Path cmdlet for this purpose.D. Correct: This command moves the transaction logs to the required folder.

QUESTION 409You want to ensure that the mailbox database named Production undergoes the removal of items that havepassed their retention period, the removal of unused indexes, and other cleanup tasks. You want to schedulethese operations so that they occur every Sunday between 10:15 and 11:45 PM. What command do you enterin the EMS?

A. Get-MailboxDatabase -Identity Production -MaintenanceSchedule 0.10:15-0.11:45B. Set-MailboxDatabase -Identity Production -MaintenanceSchedule 6.22:15-6.23:45

Page 265: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. Set-MailboxDatabase -Identity Production -MaintenanceSchedule 0.22:15-0.23:45D. Set-MailboxDatabase -Identity Production -MaintenanceSchedule 0.10:15-0.11:45

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: You accomplish the required tasks by configuring a maintenance schedule. However, you cannotdo this using the Get-MailboxDatabase cmdlet. Also, the times given in this answer are incorrect (10:15 to11:45 AM).B. Incorrect: This command schedules the exchange database maintenance tasks listed in the question to runeach Saturday, not each Sunday.C. Correct: This command schedules the exchange database maintenance tasks listed in the question to runeach Sunday between 10:15 and 11:45 PM.D. Incorrect: This command schedules the exchange database maintenance tasks listed in the question to runeach Sunday between 10:15 and 11:45 AM.

QUESTION 410You have created a public folder database named CompanyInformation on the server VAN-EX1 runningExchange Server 2010. You want to configure this public folder database to retain items for 42 days. Which ofthe following EMS commands could you enter to accomplish this goal?

A. New-PublicFolderDatabase "Server VAN-EX1 "Name CompanyInformationB. New-PublicFolderDatabase "Server VAN-EX1 "Name CompanyInformation "ItemRetentionPeriod 42C. Set-PublicFolderDatabase "Server VAN-EX1 "Name CompanyInformation -ItemRetentionPeriod 42D. Set-PublicFolderDatabase "Identity CompanyInformation -ItemRetentionPeriod 42

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: This command creates the public folder database. However, you have already done this. TheNew-PublicFolderDatabase cmdlet cannot be used to set an item retention period. B. Incorrect: The New-PublicFolderDatabase cmdlet cannot be used to set an item retention period and does not support theItemRetentionPeriod parameter. C. Incorrect: The Set-PublicFolderDatabase cmdlet does not support theServer parameter and uses the Name parameter to change the name of a database. It requires that you identifythe database using the Identity parameter.D. Correct: This command sets the item retention period for the CompanyInformation public folder database.

QUESTION 411You have created a custom OAB named AdatumDenver. You want to move the generation task for this OABfrom the server DEN-EX1 to the server DEN-EX2. What command do you enter in the EMS?

A. Set-OfflineAddressBook -Identity AdatumDenver -Server DEN-EX2B. Set-OfflineAddressBook -Identity AdatumDenver -Server DEN-EX1,DEN-EX2C. Move-OfflineAddressBook -Identity AdatumDenver -Server DEN-EX2D. Move-OfflineAddressBook -Identity AdatumDenver -Server Server DEN-EX1, DEN-EX2

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Page 266: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: The location of the server that performs the OAB generation task is not considered to be an OABproperty, and you cannot use the Set-OfflineAddressBook cmdlet to change it. The Set- OfflineAddressBookcmdlet does not support the Server parameter. B. Incorrect: The location of the server that performs the OABgeneration task is not considered to be an OAB property, and you cannot use the Set-OfflineAddressBookcmdlet to change it. The Set- OfflineAddressBook cmdlet does not support the Server parameter. C. Correct:This command moves the generation task for the AdatumDenver OAB to the server DEN- EX2.D. Incorrect: The Server parameter of the Move-OfflineAddressBook cmdlet specifies the server to which youwant to move the generation process. You do not need to specify the server on which the OAB is currentlygenerated, and a syntax error is returned if you attempt to do so

QUESTION 412You want to create the address list ColoradoStaff that includes recipients that are mailbox users and haveStateOrProvince set to Colorado. You then want to create the child address list DenverStaff in theColoradoStaff parent container. What commands do you enter in the EMS? (Choose 2; each answer forms partof the solution.)

A. New-AddressList -Name ColoradoStaff -RecipientFilter {((RecipientType -eq UserMailbox ) -and(StateOrProvince -eq Colorado ))}

B. New-AddressList -Name DenverStaff -Container \ColoradoStaff -ConditionalCustomAttribute1 DenverC. New-AddressList -Name DenverStaff -RecipientFilter {((RecipientType -eq UserMailbox ) -and

(ConditionalCustomAttribute1 Denver ))}D. New-AddressList -Name ColoradoStaff -Container \DenverStaff -RecipientFilter {((RecipientType -eq

UserMailbox ) -and (StateOrProvince -eq Colorado ))}

Correct Answer: ABSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answers: A and BA. Correct: This command creates the address list ColoradoStaff as specified. B. Correct: This commandcreates the address list DenverStaff as a child of the ColoradoStaff address list.C. Incorrect: This command creates an address list named DenverStaff but not as a child of the ColoradoStaffaddress list.D. Incorrect: This command specifies the ColoradoStaff address list as a child of the DenverStaff address listwhen it should be the other way around.

QUESTION 413You want to create an OAB named ColoradoOffline based on the ColoradoStaff address list. This OAB shouldbe generated on the server named DEN-EX1 and should use web-based distribution. It should not be availableto Outlook 2003 and other MAPI clients. Which of the following EMS commands should you enter?

A. New-OfflineAddressBook "Name ColoradoOffline "Server DEN-EX1 "AddressLists ColoradoStaff"PublicFolderDistributionEnabled $true

B. New-OfflineAddressBook "Name ColoradoOffline "Server DEN-EX1 "AddressLists ColoradoStaff"VirtualDirectories DEN-EX1\OAB (Default Web Site)

C. Set-OfflineAddressBook "Name ColoradoOffline "Server DEN-EX1 "AddressLists ColoradoStaff"PublicFolderDistributionEnabled $true

D. Set-OfflineAddressBook "Name ColoradoOffline "Server DEN-EX1 "AddressLists ColoradoStaff"VirtualDirectories SYDNEYMBX1\OAB (Default Web Site)

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)

Page 267: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: This command creates an OAB that uses public folder distribution and is available to Outlook 2003and other MAPI clients.

B. Correct: This command creates an OAB named ColoradoOffline, based on the ColoradoStaff address list,generated on the server named DEN-EX1, and using web-based distribution. Because the OAB does not usepublic folder distribution, it is not available to Outlook 2003 and other MAPI clients.

C. Incorrect: The Set-OfflineAddressBook cmdlet edits an existing OAB, and you cannot use it to create anOAB. The cmdlet does not support the Name parameter. D. Incorrect: The Set-OfflineAddressBook cmdletedits an existing OAB, and you cannot use it to create an OAB. The cmdlet does not support the Nameparameter.

QUESTION 414You want to create a GAL named Blue Sky Airlines " All Employees to include all mailbox users employed byBlue Sky Airlines. What command do you enter in the EMS?

A. Set-AddressList "Identity Blue Sky Airlines " All Employees -IncludedRecipients MailboxUsers"ConditionalCompany Blue Sky Airlines

B. New-AddressList "Name Blue Sky Airlines " All Employees -IncludedRecipients MailboxUsers"ConditionalCompany Blue Sky Airlines

C. Set-GlobalAddressList "Identity Blue Sky Airlines " All Employees -IncludedRecipients MailboxUsers"ConditionalCompany Blue Sky Airlines

D. New-GlobalAddressList "Name Blue Sky Airlines " All Employees -IncludedRecipients MailboxUsers"ConditionalCompany Blue Sky Airlines

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: The Set-AddressList cmdlet configures an existing address list. It does not create a new GAL.B. Incorrect: This command creates an address list called Blue Sky Airlines All Employees. However, thisaddress list is not a GAL.C. Incorrect: The Set-GlobalAddressList cmdlet configures an existing GAL. It does not create a new GAL.D. Correct: This command creates a GAL called Blue Sky Airlines All Employees that includes all mailboxusers employed by Blue Sky Airlines.

QUESTION 415Which of the following cmdlets would you use to move a mailbox from an Exchange Server 2010 mailboxserver in one site to an Exchange Server 2010 mailbox server in another Active Directory site while minimizingthe disruption to the mailbox user?

A. Set-MailboxB. Move-MailboxC. New-MoveRequestD. Get-Mailbox

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Page 268: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: Set-Mailbox is used to configure mailbox properties but is not used to move mailboxes from oneserver to another.B. Incorrect: Move-Mailbox is used to move mailboxes in previous versions of Exchange and is not used tomove mailboxes in Exchange Server 2010. C. Correct: The New-MoveRequest cmdlet is used to performonline mailbox moves from one Exchange Server 2010 Mailbox server to another Exchange Server 2010Mailbox server. D. Incorrect: Get-Mailbox is used to view the properties of a mailbox but is not used to move amailbox.

QUESTION 416Which of the following commands configures the Send As permission for Kim Akers on Don Hall s mailbox?

A. Add-MailboxPermission "Identity Kim Akers "User adatum\Don_Hall "AccessRights FullAccess"InheritanceType all

B. Add-MailboxPermission "Identity Don Hall "User adatum\Kim_Akers "AccessRights FullAccess"InheritanceType all

C. Add-ADPermission Don Hall "User adatum\Kim_Akers "Extendedrights Send AsD. Add-ADPermission Kim Akers "User adatum\Don_Hall "Extendedrights Send As

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:2. Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: The Add-MailboxPermission command listed grants access to read the contents of a mailbox butnot the Send As permission.B. Incorrect: The Add-MailboxPermission command listed grants access to read the contents of a mailbox butnot the Send As permission.C. Correct: The Add-ADPermission command, run against Don Hall's mailbox and specifying Kim Akers as theuser with the "Send As" extended right, grants Kim Akers Send As permission on Don Hall's mailbox.D. Incorrect: This command would give Don Hall Send As permission on Kim Aker's mailbox rather than theother way around, as specified by the question.

QUESTION 417Which of the following cmdlets allows you to connect a disconnected mailbox to a newly created ActiveDirectory user account?

A. New-MailboxB. Set-MailboxC. Enable-MailboxD. Connect-Mailbox

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:3. Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: New-Mailbox can be used to create new mailboxes but cannot be used to connect disconnectedmailboxes to Active Directory user accounts. B. Incorrect: Set-Mailbox can be used to modify the properties ofmailboxes but cannot be used to connect disconnected mailboxes to Active Directory user accounts. C.

Page 269: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Incorrect: Enable-Mailbox can be used to create new mailboxes for existing Active Directory user accounts butis not used to connect disconnected mailboxes to user accounts.D. Correct: The Connect-Mailbox cmdlet is used to connect disconnected Exchange Mailboxes to ActiveDirectory user accounts.

QUESTION 418You want to limit the messages that Kim Akers can send and receive to 2 MB in size. Which of the followingcommands could you use to accomplish this goal?

A. Set-Mailbox Kim Akers "MaxReceiveSize 2097152 "MaxSendSize 2097152B. Set-Mailbox Kim Akers "ProhibitSendQuota 2097152 "MaxSendSize 2097152C. Set-Mailbox Kim Akers "MaxReceiveSize 2097152 "ProhibitSendQuota 2097152D. Set-Mailbox Kim Akers "IssueWarningQuota 2097152 "ProhibitSendQuota 2097152

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:4. Correct Answer: AA. Correct: This answer correctly specifies the MaxReceiveSize and MaxSendSize parameters, which are usedto limit incoming and outgoing message sizes.B. Incorrect: This answer incorrectly mentions the ProhibitSendQuota parameter, which is used in relation tomailbox quota but not outgoing or incoming message size restriction. This answer does limit send size to thecorrect value.C. Incorrect: This answer incorrectly mentions the ProhibitSendQuota parameter, which is used in relation tomailbox quota but not outgoing or incoming message size restriction. This answer does limit receive size to thecorrect value.D. Incorrect: This answer incorrectly mentions the IssueWarningQuota and ProhibitSendQuota parameters,which are used in relation to mailbox quota but not for incoming our outgoing message size restriction.

QUESTION 419Which of the following parameters would you use with the Set-Mailbox cmdlet to ensure that email that had anSCL greater than 5 was sent to the junk email folder?

A. SCLQuarantineEnabled and SCLQuarantineThresholdB. SCLJunkEnabled and SCLJunkThresholdC. SCLDeleteEnabled and SCLDeleteThresholdD. SCLRejectEnabled and SCLRejectThreshold

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:5. Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: The SCLQuarantineEnabled and SCLQuarantineThreshold parameters relate to routing mail thatexceeds a specific SCL threshold into quarantine. Quarantine allows administrator review to determine whetherthe messages have been correctly identified as unsolicited commercial email.

B. Correct: The SCLJunkEnabled and SCLJunkThreshold parameters allow you to configure the threshold atwhich messages will be routed to the junk email folder.

C. Incorrect: The SCLDeleteEnabled and SCLDeleteThreshold parameters relate to the threshold at whichmessages will be deleted rather than be moved to the junk email folder. D. Incorrect: The SCLRejectEnabledand SCLRejectThreshold parameters relate to the threshold at which messages are rejected rather than be

Page 270: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

moved into the junk email folder.

QUESTION 420A recent renovation has increased the number of seats that are available in a conference room in yourcompany building from 10 to 15. Which cmdlet would you use to modify the room mailbox associated with thisroom?

A. New-MailboxB. Set-MailboxC. Get-MailboxD. Enable-Mailbox

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:1. Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: The New-Mailbox cmdlet is used to create new mailboxes and cannot be used to modify theresource capacity of existing mailboxes.

B. Correct: You would use the Set-Mailbox cmdlet with the ResourceCapacity parameter to modify the resourcecapacity of an existing mailbox.

C. Incorrect: The Get-Mailbox cmdlet is used to get information about existing mailboxes and cannot be used tomodify the resource capacity of an existing mailbox. D. Incorrect: The Enable-Mailbox cmdlet is used toprovision existing Active Directory user accounts with mailboxes. You cannot use this account to modify theresource capacity of an existing mailbox.

QUESTION 421You have been reviewing the setup of Exchange mailboxes at one of your organization s interstate offices. Youhave determined that the contractor who created several mailboxes at the office incorrectly created roommailboxes when he should have created shared mailboxes. The room mailboxes currently store content thatyou want to retain, so you have decided to convert these mailboxes from room mailboxes to shared mailboxes.Which of the following commands would you use to reconfigure a room mailbox named SalesInfo so that itfunctions as a shared mailbox?

A. Set-Mailbox SalesInfo "Type RoomB. Set-Mailbox SalesInfo "Type SharedC. Set-Mailbox SalesInfo "Type EquipmentD. Set-Mailbox SalesInfo "Type Regular

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: Set-Mailbox SalesInfo Type Room

B. Correct: Set-Mailbox SalesInfo Type Shared

C. Incorrect: Set-Mailbox SalesInfo Type EquipmentD. Incorrect: Set-Mailbox SalesInfo Type Regular

Page 271: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 422Which of the following cmdlets would you use to delegate control of a room mailbox to a specific user so that allrequests for the room would be forwarded to that specific user for approval?

A. Set-MailboxB. Set-CalendarNotificationC. Set-CalendarProcessingD. Get-Mailbox

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:3. Correct Answer: C(Use the Set-CalendarProcessing cmdlet to modify calendar-related processing configuration properties for thetarget mailbox, which include Calendar Attendant, resource booking assistant, and calendar configuration.)

A. Incorrect: Although the Set-Mailbox cmdlet allows you to configure the settings of mailboxes, the Set-Mailbox cmdlet does not allow you to delegate control of a room mailbox. This must be done with the Set-CalendarProcessing cmdlet.

B. Incorrect: The Set-CalendarNotification cmdlet allows you to configure notifications for calendar events. Itdoes not allow you to delegate control of a resource mailbox.

C. Correct: The Set-CalendarProcessing cmdlet allows you to set a delegate on a resource mailbox. Thedelegate is able to control the scheduling options.

D. Incorrect: The Get-Mailbox cmdlet allows you to get information about a mailbox. It does not allow you todelegate control of a room mailbox.

QUESTION 423Which of the following EMS cmdlets allows you to specify delegates and booking

A. Set-MailboxB. Set-CalendarProcessingC. Set-LinkedUserD. Set-Group

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: The Set-Mailbox cmdlet is used to configure the properties of a mailbox but cannot be used tospecify delegates and booking windows for resource mailboxes.

B. Correct: The Set-CalendarProcessing cmdlet can be used to specify delegates and booking windows forresource mailboxes.

C. Incorrect: The Set-LinkedUser cmdlet is used to configure the properties of linked users, but cannot be usedto specify delegates and booking windows for resource mailboxes.

D. Incorrect: The Set-Group cmdlet allows you to modify group settings but cannot be used to specify delegatesand booking windows for resource mailboxes.

Page 272: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 424You are responsible for managing Exchange at Adatum. Sam Abolrous is a contractor who retrieves email fromthe messaging system at Contoso. Sam needs to be able to log on locally to the Adatum domain but does notyet have this right. Which of the following EMS cmdlets would you use to configure Exchange and ActiveDirectory so that Sam could log on locally but so that all messages sent to Sam through Exchange wereforwarded to the messaging system at Contoso?

A. Set-MailUserB. New-MailContactC. New-MailUserD. Set-MailContact

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: The Set-MailUser cmdlet is used to modify the mail-related settings of an existing user. As Samdoes not have an existing user account, you need to use the New-MailUser cmdlet to create a user accountand associate it with an external email address.

B. Incorrect: The New-MailContact cmdlet allows you to create a new mail-enabled contact. Mail-enabledcontacts represent external addresses in Exchange but do not confer local logon rights.

C. Correct: The New-MailUser cmdlet allows you to create a user account that allows for logon but also allowsmessages sent to Sam to be forwarded to an external messaging system.

D. Incorrect: The Set-MailContact cmdlet allows you to modify an existing mail-enabled contact. Mail- enabledcontacts represent external addresses in Exchange but do not confer local logon rights.

QUESTION 425Which of the following security group types can you mail-enable using the Enable-DistributionGroup cmdlet?

A. Domain localB. LocalC. GlobalD. Universal

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: D

A. Incorrect: You cannot mail-enable a domain local group. Only universal groups can be mail-enabled. Undercertain conditions, domain local groups can be converted to universal groups.B. Incorrect: You cannot mail-enable a local group. Only universal groups can be mail-enabled.C. Incorrect: You cannot mail-enable a global group. Only universal groups can be mail-enabled. Under certainconditions, global groups can be converted to universal groups.

D. Correct: You can mail-enable only security groups that have been configured with the universal scope.

Page 273: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 426Which of the following EMS cmdlets would you use to configure an additional proxy address for a dynamicdistribution group?

A. Set-ContactB. Set-DistributionGroupC. Set-DynamicDistributionGroupD. Set-Group

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: The Set-Contact cmdlet is used to configure the properties of a contact, not add proxy addressesto a distribution group.B. Incorrect: The Set-DistributionGroup cmdlet cannot be used to set additional proxy addresses for a dynamicdistribution group but can be used to set additional proxy addresses for a normal distribution group.

C. Correct: The Set-DynamicDistributionGroup cmdlet with the EmailAddresses parameter can used to setadditional proxy addresses for a dynamic distribution group.

D. Incorrect: The Set-Group cmdlet is used to manage Active Directory groups rather than dynamic distributiongroups. This cmdlet cannot be used to configure additional proxy addresses for a dynamic distribution group.

QUESTION 427You need to set an expansion server for a large dynamic distribution group. Each server running ExchangeServer 2010 in your organization hosts a separate role. Which of the following servers should you configure asthe expansion server for the large dynamic distribution group?

A. VAN-MBX-1 (Mailbox server)B. VAN-HT-1 (Hub Transport server)C. VAN-ET-1 (Edge Transport server)D. VAN-CAS-1 (Client Access server)

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:4. Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: Dynamic distribution group expansion occurs on Hub Transport rather than Mailbox servers.

B. Correct: Hub Transport servers are used for dynamic distribution group expansion. As the expansion of largedynamic distribution groups can be resource intensive, you should choose an underutilized Hub Transportserver to expand dynamic distribution groups with an especially large number of recipients.

C. Incorrect: Dynamic distribution group expansion occurs on Hub Transport rather than Edge Transportservers.

D. Incorrect: Dynamic distribution group expansion occurs on Hub Transport rather than Client Access servers.

QUESTION 428Which of the following cmdlets would you use to hide a sensitive distribution group from Exchange address

Page 274: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

lists?

A. Set-MailboxPermissionB. Set-DynamicDistributionGroupC. Set-GroupD. Set-DistributionGroup

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: D

A. Incorrect: The Set-MailboxPermission cmdlet is used to set permissions on mailboxes. It cannot be used toconfigure a distribution group so that it is hidden from Exchange address lists.B. Incorrect: The Set-DynamicDistributionGroup cmdlet is used to manage dynamic distribution groups and notdistribution groups. You can use the Set- DynamicDistributionGroup cmdlet to hide sensitive dynamicdistribution groups using the HiddenFromAddressListsEnabled parameter.

C. Incorrect: The Set-Group cmdlet is used to manage active directory groups. It cannot be used to manage anexchange distribution group.

D. Correct: You can use the Set-DistributionGroup cmdlet with the HiddenFromAddressListsEnabled $trueparameter and option to hide a sensitive distribution group from address lists.

QUESTION 429Which of the following EMS cmdlets allows you to mail-enable a public folder?

A. New-PublicFolderB. Set-MailPublicFolderC. Set-PublicFolderD. Enable-MailPublicFolder

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:1. Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: You use the New-PublicFolder cmdlet to create new public folders. You cannot use this cmdlet tomail-enable an existing public folder.B. Incorrect: You use the Set-MailPublicFolder cmdlet to configure the properties of a mail-enabled publicfolder. You cannot use this cmdlet to mail-enable an existing public folder.C. Incorrect: You use the Set-PublicFolder cmdlet to configure the settings of public folders. You cannot usethis cmdlet to mail-enable an existing public folder.

D. Correct: You use the Enable-MailPublicFolder cmdlet to mail-enable an existing public folder.

QUESTION 430Which of the following EMS cmdlets can you use to assign the PublishingEditor role for the Development publicfolder to Orin?

A. Add-PublicFolderClientPermissionB. Set-PublicFolder

Page 275: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. Set-MailPublicFolderD. Add-PublicFolderAdministrativePermission

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:2. Correct Answer: A

A. Correct: You use the Add-PublicFolderClientPermission cmdlet to assign public folder client permissionssuch as PublishingEditor and PublishingAuthor roles.

B. Incorrect: You cannot use the Set-PublicFolder cmdlet to assign public folder client permission roles. Thiscmdlet is used to configure the settings of public folders, such as maximum item size.C. Incorrect: You cannot use the Set-MailPublicFolder cmdlet to assign public folder client permission roles.This cmdlet is used to configure the settings of mail-enabled public folders, such as maximum size for receiveditems.

D. Incorrect: You use the Add-PublicFolderAdministrativePermission cmdlet to assign explicit administrativepermissions to public folders, but do not use this cmdlet to assign roles such as PublishingAuthor orPublishingEditor.

QUESTION 431Which of the following EMS cmdlets can you use to configure item age limit settings on an existing mail-enabled public folder?

A. New-PublicFolderB. Get-PublicFolderC. Set-MailPublicFolderD. Set-PublicFolder

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:3. Correct Answer: D

A. Incorrect: The New-PublicFolder cmdlet is used to create public folders. It cannot be used to configure theitem age limit settings on existing mail-enabled public folders.

B. Incorrect: The Get-PublicFolder cmdlet is used to display information about public folders but cannot be usedto directly configure public folders.

C. Incorrect: You cannot use the Set-MailPublicFolder cmdlet to configure item age limit settings on mail-enabled public folders. You must use the Set-PublicFolder cmdlet to accomplish this task.

D. Correct: You use the Set-PublicFolder cmdlet to configure item age limit settings on both mail-enabled andnonmail-enabled public folders.

QUESTION 432Which of the following EMS cmdlets can you use to configure maximum message size on a mail-enabled publicfolder? (Choose all that apply.)

A. Set-MailPublicFolder

Page 276: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

B. Set-PublicFolderC. Set-MailboxDatabaseD. Set-PublicFolderDatabase

Correct Answer: BDSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:4. Correct Answers: B and DA. Incorrect: You cannot configure maximum message size using the Set-MailPublicFolder cmdlet. You can dothis directly only by using the Set-PublicFolder cmdlet for the folder or Set-PublicFolderDatase to configurethese settings indirectly through the host database settings.

B. Correct: You can use the Set-PublicFolder cmdlet with the MaxItemSize parameters to configure maximumitem size settings for a public folder.

C. Incorrect: You cannot use mailbox database settings to configure settings for public folders. Public foldersare hosted in public folder databases. D. Correct: You can use the Set-PublicFolderDatabase cmdlet toindirectly configure public folder maximum item size settings, as these settings are inherited by public foldershosted on the database.

QUESTION 433Which of the following cmdlets could you use to verify that the Autodiscover service is functioning correctly forOutlook 2010 clients on an Exchange Server 2010 Client Access server?

A. Test-OwaConnectivityB. Test-WebServicesConnectivityC. Test-OutlookWebServicesD. Test-ActiveSyncConnectivity

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:1. Correct Answer: C

A. Incorrect: The Test-OwaConnectivity cmdlet allows you to test that OWA is running as expected but does notallow you to verify that the Autodiscover service settings for Outlook 2007 and 2010 clients are configuredcorrectly.

B. Incorrect: The Test-WebServicesConnectivity cmdlet allows you to verify the functionality of Exchange WebServices but does not allow you to verify that the Autodiscover service settings for Outlook 2007 and 2010clients are configured correctly.

C. Correct: The Test-OutlookWebServices cmdlet allows you to verify that the Autodiscover service settings forOutlook 2007 and 2010 clients are configured correctly.

D. Incorrect: The Test-ActiveSyncConnectivity cmdlet allows you to perform a test ActiveSync synchronizationagainst a mailbox but does not allow you to verify that the Autodiscover service settings for Outlook 2007 and2010 clients are configured correctly.

QUESTION 434Which of the following EMS cmdlets could you use to verify that ActiveSync is functioning correctly for a specificuser?

Page 277: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Test-WebServicesConnectivityB. Test-OutlookWebServicesC. Test-OwaConnectivityD. Test-ActiveSyncConnectivity

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:2. Correct Answer: D

A. Incorrect: The Test-WebServicesConnectivity cmdlet allows you to verify the functionality of Exchange WebServices but does not allow you to verify that ActiveSync is functioning correctly for a specific user.

B. Incorrect: The Test-OutlookWebServices cmdlet allows you to verify that the Autodiscover service settingsfor Outlook 2007 and 2010 clients are configured correctly but does not allow you to verify that ActiveSync isfunctioning correctly for a specific user.

C. Incorrect: The Test-OwaConnectivity cmdlet allows you to test that OWA is running as expected but doesnot allow you to verify that ActiveSync is functioning correctly for a specific user.

D. Correct: The Test-ActiveSyncConnectivity cmdlet allows you to verify that ActiveSync is functioning correctlyfor a specific user.

QUESTION 435Which of the following EMS cmdlets can you use to remotely wipe a mobile phone?

A. Get-ActiveSyncDeviceStatisticsB. Clear-ActiveSyncDeviceC. Remove-ActiveSyncDeviceD. Get-ActiveSyncDevice

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:3. Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: The Get-ActiveSyncDeviceStatistics cmdlet is used to retrieve a list of mobile phones that areconfigured to synchronize with a specific user's mailbox; this cmdlet cannot be used to delete all data from amobile phone

B. Correct: The Clear-ActiveSyncDevice cmdlet is used to delete all data from a mobile phone.

C. Incorrect: The Remove-ActiveSyncDevice cmdlet is used to remove a mobile phone partnership but cannotbe used to delete all data from a mobile phone.D. Incorrect: The Get-ActiveSyncDevice cmdlet allows you to view a list of devices that have existingActiveSync partnerships; this cmdlet cannot be used to delete all data from a mobile phone.

QUESTION 436Which of the following cmdlets can you use to enable password recovery for mobile devices that use ExchangeActiveSync?

Page 278: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Set-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicyB. Set-OwaMailboxPolicyC. Set-ActiveSyncVirtualDirectoryD. Set-OwaVirtualDirectory

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:4. Correct Answer: A

A. Correct: You use the Set-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicy cmdlet with the PasswordRecoveryEnabled parameter toenable password recovery for mobile devices.

B. Incorrect: You use the Set-OwaMailboxPolicy cmdlet to configure options for OWA mailboxes. You use theSet-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicy cmdlet to enable password recovery for mobile devices.

C. Incorrect: Although you can use the Set-ActiveSyncVirtualDirectory cmdlet to configure options such aswhether basic authentication is enabled for Activesync, you use the Set-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicy cmdlet toenable password recovery for mobile devices. D. Incorrect: The Set-OwaVirtualDirectory cmdlet is used toconfigure the properties of the OWA virtual directory. You use the Set-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicy cmdlet toenable password recovery for mobile devices

QUESTION 437Which of the following cmdlets can you use to configure Exchange ActiveSync to use basic authentication?

A. Set-OwaVirtualDirectoryB. Set-ActiveSyncVirtualDirectoryC. Set-OwaMailboxPolicyD. Set-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicy

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:5. Correct Answer: B

A. Incorrect: You use the Set-OwaVirtualDirectory cmdlet to configure the properties of OWA virtual directories.You use the Set-ActiveSyncVirtualDirectory cmdlet with the BasicAuthEnabled parameter to configureExchange ActiveSync to use basicauthentication.

B. Correct: You can use the Set-ActiveSyncVirtualDirectory cmdlet to configure Exchange ActiveSync to usebasic authentication. You use the BasicAuthEnabled parameter to accomplish this goal.

C. Incorrect: You use the Set-OawMailboxPolicy cmdlet to configure the properties of OWA. You use the Set-ActiveSyncVirtualDirectory cmdlet with the BasicAuthEnabled parameter to configure Exchange ActiveSync touse basic authentication.

D. Incorrect: Although Set-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicy can be used to configure options such as minimum devicepassword length; it cannot be used to configure ActiveSync to use basic authentication. You use the Set-ActiveSyncVirtualDirectory cmdlet with the BasicAuthEnabled parameter to configure Exchange ActiveSync touse basic authentication.

Page 279: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 438Which of the following cmdlets would you use to test Outlook Anywhere connectivity?

A. Test-WebServicesConnectivityB. Test-OutlookConnectivityC. Test-OutlookWebServicesD. Test-OwaConnectivity

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: The Test-WebServicesConnectivity cmdlet allows you to test the functionality of Exchange WebServices but does not allow you to test outlook anywhere connectivity.

B. Correct: You use the Test-OutlookConnectivity cmdlet to test Outlook Anywhere connectivity.C. Incorrect: The Test-OutlookWebServices cmdlet allows you to verify that the Autodiscover settings, ratherthan the Outlook Anywhere settings, are correctly configured. D. Incorrect: The Test-OwaConnectivity cmdletallows you to test that OWA is running as expected but does not allow you to test the Outlook Anywheresettings.

QUESTION 439Which if the following EMS cmdlets would you use to configure the external hostname for Outlook Anywhere fora site that has an externally facing client access array?

A. Set-ActiveSyncOrganizationSettingsB. Set-ActiveSyncVirtualDirectoryC. Set-OutlookAnywhereD. Set-OwaVirtualDirectory

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: The Set-ActiveSyncOrganizationSettings cmdlet allows you to configure ActiveSync organizationsettings but does not allow you to specify the Outlook Anywhere external host name.

B. Incorrect: The Set-ActiveSyncVirtualDirectory cmdlet allows you to configure the ActiveSync virtual directorysettings but does not allow you to specify the Outlook Anywhere external host name.

C. Correct: You use the Set-OutlookAnywhere cmdlet to configure the external host name for OutlookAnywhere, whether it uses a single Client Access server or a client access array.

D. Incorrect: The Set-OwaVirtualDirectory cmdlet allows you to configure the Outlook Web App virtual directorybut does not allow you to set the external host name for Outlook Anywhere.

QUESTION 440Which of the following EMS cmdlets would you use to create a new client access array for a specific ActiveDirectory site?

A. Set-ClientAccessServer

Page 280: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

B. New-ClientAccessArrayC. Set-CASMailboxD. Set-RpcClientAccess

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: B

A. Incorrect: While the Set-ClientAccessServer cmdlet can be used to configure properties on a specific ClientAccess server, it cannot be used to create a new client access array for a specific Active Directory site.

B. Correct: The New-ClientAccessArray cmdlet is used to create a new client access array for a specific ActiveDirectory site.

C. Incorrect: The Set-CASMailbox cmdlet allows you to set attributes related to client access for a specific user,but this command cannot be used to create a new client access array for a specific Active Directory site.

D. Incorrect: The Set-RpcClientAccess cmdlet manages settings for the Exchange RPC Client Access Servicebut cannot be used to create a new client access array for a specific Active Directory site.

QUESTION 441Which EMS cmdlet would you use to set the client authentication method for Outlook Anywhere to NTLM?

A. Set-ClientAccessArrayB. Set-ActiveSyncOrganizationSettingsC. Set-OutlookProviderD. Set-OutlookAnywhere

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: You use the Set-ClientAccessArray cmdlet to configure a client access array; you use the Set-OutlookAnywhere cmdlet to configure Outlook Anywhere client authentication methods.

B. Incorrect: You use Set-ActiveSyncOrganizationSettings to configure organizational ActiveSync settings; youuse the Set-OutlookAnywhere cmdlet to configure Outlook Anywhere client authentication methods.

C. Incorrect: The Set-OutlookProvider cmdlet allows you to configure the Autodiscover service but does notallow you to configure Outlook Anywhere. You use the Set-OutlookAnywhere cmdlet to configure OutlookAnywhere client authentication methods.

D. Correct: You use the Set-OutlookAnywhere cmdlet to configure the client authentication method for OutlookAnywhere. The options available include Basic, Digest, NTML, forms-based authentication, WindowsIntegrated, and Certificate.

QUESTION 442Which of the following features must be installed on a computer running Windows Server 2008 R2 before thatcomputer can support the Exchange Client Access server role with the Outlook Anywhere component?

A. Message Queuing

Page 281: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

B. Peer Name Resolution ProtocolC. RPC over HTTP ProxyD. Remote Differential Compression

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: C

A. Incorrect: The Message Queuing component provides message delivery between applications. Although thiscomponent has a name that sounds as though it is related to Exchange, it is unnecessary on a computerWindows Server 2008 R2, where you want to install the client access role with the Outlook Anywherecomponent.

B. Incorrect: The Peer Name Resolution Protocol is a name resolution protocol that allows clients to findcomputers on the network using a simplified addressing scheme. This component is not necessary to supportthe Client Access server role.

C. Correct: You must install the RPC over HTTP Proxy feature on a Windows Server 2008 R2 computer if thatcomputer is going to support the Client Access server role with the Outlook Anywhere component.

D. Incorrect: Remote Differential Compression is a feature that assists in the transfers of files across a networkbut is not a component that is necessary to support the Exchange Client Access server role with the OutlookAnywhere component.

QUESTION 443Which of the following EMS cmdlets can you use to block a group of users from changing their password whenconnected to their Exchange mailbox through OWA without blocking this functionality from all users?

A. Set-OwaMailboxPolicyB. Set-OwaVirtualDirectoryC. Get-OwaMailboxPolicyD. Get-OwaVirtualDirectory

Correct Answer: ABSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answers: A and B

A. Correct: You can use the Set-OwaMailboxPolicy cmdlet to configure an OWA mailbox policy for a group ofusers so that those users are unable to change their passwords when connected to OWA.

B. Correct: You can use the Set-OwaVirtualDirectory cmdlet to block all users from changing their passwordwhen connected to OWA, but you must use OWA mailbox policies, applied to users, to block this functionalityfrom only some users. When you need to configure a setting for all users, do it at the OWA virtual directorylevel, but if you want to configure different settings based on group or department membership, do this throughOWA mailbox policies.

C. Incorrect: The Get-OwaMailboxPolicy cmdlet provides details of an OWA mailbox policy but cannot be usedto configure policy settings.

D. Incorrect: The Get-OwaVirtualDirectory cmdlet allows you to view the properties of a virtual directory but

Page 282: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

does not allow you to alter settings applied to that virtual directory.

QUESTION 444Which of the following EMS cmdlets can you use to verify that Outlook Web App is functional?

A. Test-OutlookConnectivityB. Test-ActiveSyncConnectivityC. Test-OwaConnectivityD. Test-PopConnectivity

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: The Test-OutlookConnectivity cmdlet allows you to verify that services that support Outlook, suchas Outlook Anywhere, are functioning. This cmdlet does not allow you to test OWA functionality.

B. Incorrect: The Test-ActiveSync cmdlet allows you to verify that ActiveSync is functioning correctly.

C. Correct: The Test-OwaConnectivity cmdlet can be used to verify that OWA is functional.

D. Incorrect: . The Test-PopConnectivity cmdlet can be used to test POP3 functionality. This cmdlet does notallow you to test OWA functionality.

QUESTION 445Tailspin Toys and Wingtip Toys recently merged, and you are in the process of consolidating their Exchangeinfrastructure. Many of the users at both companies access their email using OWA from their home computers.OWA will be hosted on a single Client Access server at the merged company. You want to ensure that thesehome users are able to access OWA using either the address https://owa.tailspintoys. com or the addresshttps://owa.wingtiptoys.com and minimize the effort required to configure the computers of these users. Whichof the following should you do when obtaining an SSL certificate for this Client Access server?

A. Obtain a certificate that does not support SANs from an internal CA.B. Obtain a certificate that does not support SANs from a trusted third-party CA.C. Obtain a certificate that supports SANs from an internal CA.D. Obtain a certificate that supports SANs from a trusted third-party CA.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: D

A. Incorrect: You need to obtain a certificate that supports SANs, as users need to access OWA using both theaddress https://owa.tailspintoys.com and the address https://owa .wingtiptoys.com.B. Incorrect: You need to obtain a certificate that supports SANs, as users need to access OWA using both theaddress https://owa.tailspintoys.com and the address https://owa .wingtiptoys.com.C. Incorrect: While you do need a certificate that supports SANs, you should not choose to obtain this certificatefrom an internal CA, as this will not minimize the effort required to configure the home computers of the usersaccessing OWA.

D. Correct: You need to obtain a certificate that supports SANs, as you want to support the address https://owa.tailspintoys.com and the address https://owa.wingtiptoys.com. You need to obtain a certificate from a

Page 283: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

trusted third-party CA, as you want to minimize the effort required to configure the home computers of the usersaccessing OWA.

QUESTION 446Which of the following cmdlets can you use to configure Exchange so that users in the Developers group areable to receive and open attachments in .EXE format from OWA while ensuring that all other users are blockedfrom opening this type of attachment?

A. Set-OwaMailboxPolicyB. Set-CASMailboxC. Set-RpcClientAccessD. Set-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicy

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: A

A. Correct: You can use the Set-OwaMailboxPolicy cmdlet to allow and block attachments on the basis of filetype.

B. Incorrect: Although you can enable and disable OWA for a user using the Set- CASMailbox cmdlet as well asspecify an OWA mailbox policy, you cannot specifically allow or block attachment types using this cmdlet.C. Incorrect: The Set-RpcClientAccess cmdlet allows you to configure the RPC Client Access service butcannot be used to allow and block attachment types for OWA. D. Incorrect: The Set-ActiveSyncMailboxPolicycmdlet allows you to configure synchronization between Exchange and mobile devices but does not allow youto configure which attachment types are blocked and allowed in OWA.

QUESTION 447You want to ensure that users always log on to OWA using their primary email address. Which of the followingEMS cmdlets allows you to accomplish this goal?

A. Set-OwaMailboxPolicyB. Set-ClientAccessServerC. Set-OwaVirtualDirectoryD. Set-OutlookAnywhere

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: C

A. Incorrect: Although Set-OwaMailboxPolicy can be used to configure per-user OWA settings, you cannot useSet-OwaMailboxPolicy to configure the authentication method used by OWA.

B. Incorrect: While the Set-ClientAccessServer cmdlet is used to configure some Client Access serverproperties, this cmdlet cannot be used to configure the authentication method used by OWA.

C. Correct: You use the Set-OwaVirtualDirectory cmdlet to configure the authentication method used by OWA.

D. Incorrect: The Set-OutlookAnywhere cmdlet is used to configure the properties of Outlook Anywhere. Youcannot use this cmdlet to configure the properties of OWA.

Page 284: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 448You have created a scope named Hub Transport Scope that includes only the Hub Transport servers Hub01,Hub02, and Hub03. Users who are assigned management roles that have this scope can perform only tasksallowed by the role against these servers. You configure a new Hub Transport server called Hub04 and want toadd it to the scope. What command do you enter in the EMS?

A. New-ManagementScope " Name HubTransport Scope "ServerList Hub01,Hub02,Hub03,Hub04B. New-ManagementScope " Name HubTransport Scope "ServerList Hub04C. Set-ManagementScope " Identity HubTransport Scope "ServerList Hub01, Hub02, Hub03, Hub04D. Set-ManagementScope " Identity HubTransport Scope "ServerList Hub04

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect. The New-ManagementScope cmdlet creates a management scope. However, the HubTransportScope management scope already exists.B. Incorrect. The New-ManagementScope cmdlet creates a management scope. However, the HubTransportScope management scope already exists.

C. Correct: This command configures the management scope to include Hub Transport servers Hub01, Hub02,Hub03, and Hub04.D. Incorrect: This command configures the management scope to include only Hub Transport server Hub04.

QUESTION 449Jeff Hay is a delegate of the built-in Help Desk role group. Only the default roles are associated with this rolegroup, and no management roles have been added or removed. What does delegate membership of this rolegroup enable Jeff to do? (Choose all that apply.)

A. Configure mailbox size.B. Manage mailbox databases.C. Modify a user s display name when that user is not permitted to modify his or her own display name.D. Manage membership of the role group.E. View and modify the Microsoft Office Outlook Web App options of any user in the organization.

Correct Answer: DESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answers: D and EA. Incorrect: Jeff cannot configure settings that are unavailable in Outlook Web App options, such as mailboxsize.B. Incorrect: Jeff cannot configure settings that are unavailable in Outlook Web App options, such as mailboxdatabase configuration settings.C. Incorrect: Jeff can modify only the Outlook Web App options that the user himself or herself can modify. Hecannot modify a user's display name when that user is not permitted to modify it.

D. Correct: Jeff is a delegate and can manage membership of the role group.

E. Correct: Jeff can view and modify the Microsoft Office Outlook Web App options of any user in theorganization. These might include display name, address, phone number, and so on. Note that, by definition, a

Page 285: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

user can configure his or her own Microsoft Office Outlook Web App options. If a user cannot configure, forexample, the display name, this is not a Microsoft Office Outlook Web App option for that user, and Jeff cannotmodify iteither.

QUESTION 450You have created a custom management role based on the Transport Rules built-in management role, but youdo not want users assigned to that role to perform certain tasks assigned to its parent role. What EMS cmdletswould you use to modify the custom management role by removing tasks that role members are permitted tocarry out? (Choose all that apply; each correct answer forms part of the solution.)

A. Add-ManagementRoleEntryB. Remove-ManagementRoleEntryC. New-ManagementRoleAssignmentD. New-ManagementRoleE. Get-ManagementRole

Correct Answer: BESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answers: B and EA. Incorrect: You can use the Add-ManagementRoleEntry cmdlet to add management role entries to an existingmanagement role. The question requires you to remove management role entries, not add them.B. Correct: The Remove-ManagementRoleEntry cmdlet removes a management role entry (or permission)from a management role. However, in order to use this cmdlet, you first need to obtain the permission you wantto remove by using the Get-ManagementRole cmdlet with a filter (Where) condition.

C. Incorrect: You can use the New-ManagementRoleAssignment cmdlet to assign a management role to amanagement role group, management role assignment policy, user, or universal security group. You cannotuse it to remove a management role entry.

D. Incorrect: You can use the New-ManagementRole cmdlet to create a custom management role. You cannotuse it to remove a management role entry from an existing management role.

E. Correct: Although the Remove-ManagementRoleEntry cmdlet removes a management role entry (orpermission) from a management role, you first need to use the Get-ManagementRole cmdlet with a filter(Where) condition to obtain the entry you want to remove.

QUESTION 451You want to create a new management role named MyManagementRole based on the built-in Journalingmanagement role. What command should you enter in the EMS?

A. New-ManagementRole "Name MyManagementRole "Parent JournalingB. New-ManagementRole "Name Journaling "Parent MyManagementRoleC. New-ManagementRoleAssignment "Name MyManagementRole "Parent JournalingD. New-ManagementRoleAssignment "Name Journaling "Parent MyManagementRole

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: A

Page 286: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Correct: This command creates a new management role named MyManagementRole based on theJournaling management role.

B. Incorrect: This command attempts to create a new management role named Journaling based on themanagement role MyManagementRole. This is not possible because a built-in management role calledJournaling already exists.

C. Incorrect: The New-ManagementRoleAssignment cmdlet assigns a management role to a management rolegroup, management role assignment policy, user, or universal security group. It does not create a newmanagement role.D. Incorrect: The New-ManagementRoleAssignment cmdlet assigns a management role to a management rolegroup, management role assignment policy, user, or universal security group. It does not create a newmanagement role.

QUESTION 452You want Kim Akers to be able to create or modify recipients within your Exchange organization and toconfigure compliance features, including retention policy tags, message classifications, and transport rules. Youdo not want to give her any administrative privileges other than those listed. To which built-in role groups shouldyou add her? (Choose all that apply; each correct answer forms part of the solution.)

A. Recipient ManagementB. Organization ManagementC. Public Folder ManagementD. Server ManagementE. Records Management

Correct Answer: AESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answers: A and E

A. Correct: Membership of the Recipient Management role group enables Kim to create or modify recipientswithin the Exchange organization.

B. Incorrect: Membership of the Organization Management provides access to the entire Exchange Server2010 organization. Kim would be able to carry out all the tasks listed but would have more administrativepermissions than the question specifies. C. Incorrect: Membership of the Public Folder Management role grouppermits Kim to manage public folders and databases on Exchange Server 2010 servers. It does not enable herto create or modify recipients within the Exchange organization and to configure compliance features.D. Incorrect: Membership of the Server Management role group permits Kim to perform Exchange serverconfiguration. It does not enable her to create or modify recipients within the Exchange organization and toconfigure compliance features.

E. Correct: Membership of the Records Management role group enables Kim to configure compliance features,including retention policy tags, message classifications, and transport rules.

QUESTION 453You are creating a federation trust. You use the Get-ExchangeCertificate EMS cmdlet to obtain a list ofthumbprints of the certificates available on your Client Access server, choose a certificate, and enter the New-FederationTrust cmdlet with the Thumbprint parameter to create a federation trust named Microsoft FederationGateway. You get the error shown in Figure 6-16. What is the likely cause of this error?

Page 287: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Error in creating a federation trust

A. The certificate is already being used for another purpose.B. You cannot use the EMS to create a federation trust named Microsoft Federation Gateway. You need to use

the EMC.C. You cannot create a federation trust on a Client Access server. You need to do this on a domain controller.D. The certificate you have chosen is not trusted by Windows Live Domain Services.

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: Provided that an X.509 certificate is trusted by Windows Live Domain Services, it can be used toverify a federation trust, even if it is also being used for other purposes.

B. Incorrect: When you use the EMC to create a federation trust, that trust must be named Microsoft FederationGateway. However, when you use the EMS, you can specify any name that is syntactically correct, includingMicrosoft Federation Gateway.

C. Incorrect: You can create a federation trust on a Client Access server. You cannot create it on a domaincontroller unless that domain controller is also an Exchange Server 2010 server (which would be bad practice).

D. Correct: You have chosen the thumbprint of a certificate that is not exportable and not trusted by WindowsLive Domain. It is likely that you have chosen a self-signed certificate.

QUESTION 454You are testing Exchange Server 2010 configuration on a test network that is isolated from any other network.You have obtained an X.509 certificate from a trusted third-party CA and have exported it to your test networkusing removable media. You attempt to create a federation trust but are unable to do so. What is the probablereason?

A. Your test network is not connected to the Internet.B. Your certificate was exported to your test network using removable media and is therefore not valid for that

network.C. The EMS is not available on your test network.D. The CA is not trusted by Windows Live Domain Services.

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Page 288: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: A

A. Correct: Your network is isolated from any other network, which would include the Internet. An Internetconnection is necessary to create a federation trust.

B. Incorrect: Certificates are frequently exported using removable media. Provided that the certificate is anX.509 certificate trusted by Windows Live Domain Services, it can be used to verify a federation trust.C. Incorrect: You are testing Exchange Server 2010 configuration, and therefore the EMS is available on yournetwork.D. Incorrect: A trusted third-party CA is by definition trusted by everyone, including Windows Live DomainServices.

QUESTION 455You want to configure all mailboxes in your Exchange organization that are associated with the MarketingDepartment so that they use the Adatum Marketing federated sharing policy. Which of the following commandsshould you use?

A. Set-Mailbox " Filter { Department " eq Marketing } | Get-Mailbox "SharingPolicy Adatum MarketingB. Get-Mailbox " Filter { Department " eq Marketing } | Set-Mailbox "SharingPolicy Adatum MarketingC. Set-Mailbox " Organization Marketing | Get-Mailbox "SharingPolicy Adatum MarketingD. Get-Mailbox " Filter " Organization Marketing | Set-Mailbox "SharingPolicy Adatum Marketing

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: You use Get-Mailbox to obtain the Marketing mailboxes and Set-Mailbox to apply the AdatumMarketing sharing policy. This answer has the cmdlets the wrong way around.B. Correct: This command uses Get-Mailbox to obtain the Marketing mailboxes and Set-Mailbox to apply theAdatum Marketing sharing policy.

C. Incorrect: The Organization parameter is reserved for Microsoft use and does not in any event specify adepartment. Also, the cmdlets are the wrong way around.

D. Incorrect: The Organization parameter is reserved for Microsoft use and does not in any event specify adepartment.

QUESTION 456You want to create an account namespace for your Exchange organization with the Federation Gateway andenable federation so that you can make use of the facilities that federation provides, such as sharing calendarsor contacts and accessing free or busy information. What EMS cmdlet would enable you to do this?

A. New-OrganizationRelationshipB. Get-FederatedOrganizationIdentifierC. Set-OrganizationRelationshipD. Set-FederatedOrganizationIdentifier

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:

Page 289: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: You use the New-OrganizationRelationship cmdlet to create a relationship with an externalMicrosoft Exchange Server 2010 organization. The cmdlet does not create an account namespace for yourExchange organization with the Federation Gateway and enable federation.

B. Incorrect: You use the Get-FederatedOrganizationIdentifier EMS cmdlet to retrieve your Microsoft ExchangeServer 2010 organization's federated organization identifier and related details, such as federated domains,organization contact, and status. The cmdlet does not create an account namespace for your Exchangeorganization with the Federation Gateway and enable federation.

C. Incorrect: You use the Set-OrganizationRelationship cmdlet to modify a relationship with an externalMicrosoft Exchange Server 2010 organization for the purposes of, for example, accessing free or busyinformation. The cmdlet does not create an account namespace for your Exchange organization with theFederation Gateway and enable federation.

D. Correct: You can use the Set-FederatedOrganizationIdentifier EMS cmdlet to configure the federatedorganization identifier for your Exchange organization. You configure a federated organization identifier tocreate an account namespace for your Exchange organization with the Federation Gateway and enablefederation.

QUESTION 457A federated sharing relationship exists between Blue Sky Airlines and Consolidated Messenger. A user in BlueSky Airlines sends an encrypted, authenticated email message to a user in Consolidated Messenger. Which ofthe following describes the first three steps of the process? (Choose all that apply; each answer forms part ofthe solution.)

A. The Blue Sky Airlines Hub Transport server accesses a ConsoldatedMessenger.com domain controller toverify that a sharing relationship is configured with ConsolidatedMessenger.com and that the user haspermission to send messages across the sharing relationship.

B. The Blue Sky Airlines Hub Transport server accesses a BlueSkyAirlines.com domain controller to verify thata sharing relationship is configured with ConsolidatedMessenger.com and that the user has permission tosend messages across the sharing relationship.

C. If both verifications succeed, the Blue Sky Airlines Hub Transport server connects to the FederationGateway and requests a security token for the Blue Sky Airlines user. Because BlueSkyAirlines.com isconfigured in the organization identifier, the Federation Gateway issues the token.

D. The message is sent through a Blue Sky Airlines Mailbox server to a Blue Sky Airlines Hub Transportserver.

E. If both verifications succeed, the Consolidated Messenger Hub Transport server connects to the FederationGateway and requests a security token for the Blue Sky Airlines user. Because BlueSkyAirlines.com isconfigured in the organization identifier, the Federation Gateway issues the token.

F. The message is sent through a Blue Sky Airlines Mailbox server to a Consolidated Messenger HubTransport server.

Correct Answer: BCDSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answers: B, C, and D

A. Incorrect: The Blue Sky airlines organization cannot access the Consolidated Messenger organization untilthe sharing relationship has been verified and a token issued. No Consolidated Messenger servers are involvedin the first three steps of this process.

D. Correct: The message is sent from a Mailbox server to a Hub Transport server in the originatingorganization. This is the first step of the process.

Page 290: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

B. Correct: The domain controller in the originating organization needs to verify the sharing relationship.This is the second step of the process.C. Correct: When the sharing relationship is verified, a token is requested from the Federation Gateway. Thispermits access to the Consolidated Messenger organization. This is the third step of the process.

E. Incorrect: The sending organization requests the token, and a Consolidated Messenger Hub Transportserver cannot request a security token for the Blue Sky Airlines user. No Consolidated Messenger servers areinvolved in the first three steps of this process. F. Incorrect: The message is initially sent internally to a HubTransport server in the originating organization. No Consolidated Messenger servers are involved in the firstthree steps of this process.

QUESTION 458You want to create a transport rule named AddPaulWest that adds Paul West to the recipients whenever anemail message is sent to Don Hall, except when the message subject includes the word holiday. Whatcommand do you enter on a Hub Transport server?

A. New-TransportRule "Name AddPaulWest "SentTo Don Hall "AddToRecipients Paul West"ExceptIfSubjectOrBodyContainsWords holiday

B. New-TransportRule "Name AddPaulWest "SentTo Don Hall "AddToRecipients Paul West"ExceptIfSubjectContainsWords holiday

C. New-TransportRule "Name AddPaulWest "SentTo Paul West "AddToRecipients Don Hall"ExceptIfSubjectContainsWords holiday

D. New-TransportRule "Name AddPaulWest "SentTo Paul West "AddToRecipients Don Hall"ExceptIfSubjectOrBodyContainsWords holiday

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: This creates a rule that adds Paul West to the recipients whenever an email message is sent toDon Hall, except when the either the message subject or the message body includes the word "holiday." Therequirement is that the rule is not applied only when the message subject includes the word "holiday."

B. Correct: This creates a rule that adds Paul West to the recipients whenever an email message is sent to DonHall, except when the message subject includes the word "holiday."

C. Incorrect: This creates a rule that adds Don Hall to the recipients whenever an email message is sent toPaul West, except when the message subject includes the word "holiday." This is not what is required.D. Incorrect: This creates a rule that adds Don Hall to the recipients whenever an email message is sent toPaul West, except when the message subject or the message body includes the word "holiday." This is notwhat is required.

QUESTION 459You want to amend the transport rule AddPaulWest so that both Paul West and Kim Akers are added to therecipients when email is sent to Don Hall. What EMS cmdlet would you use?

A. Get-TransportRuleB. New-TransportRuleC. Set-TransportRuleD. Set-TransportRulePredicate

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Page 291: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: The Get-TransportRule cmdlet returns details about a specified transport rule, but you cannot useit to amend the rule.B. Incorrect: The New-TransportRule cmdlet creates a new transport rule. You cannot use it to amend anexisting transport rule.

C. Correct: You can use the Set-TransportRule cmdlet to amend the AddPaulWest transport rule.

D. Incorrect: You can use the Get-TransportRulePredicate cmdlet to retrieve a list of all available rulepredicates that you can use with the transport rules agent on a Hub Transport server or an Edge Transportserver. You cannot use it to amend an existing transport rule.

QUESTION 460You are using a regular expression in a transport rule and specify that an action is to be implemented when apattern in the subject or body matches the expression \D\D\S\S\ d\d\d\d\S\S\S\d\d\d\d. Which of the followingpatterns trigger the action? (Choose all that apply.)

A. ABCA1221YZz3333B. A12A3421YZU6234C. AB986556+++9688D. 1Aaa9865fg99999E. Good4444bad2222F. 4leggood2legbad

Correct Answer: ACESection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answers: A, C, and E

A. Correct: The first two metacharacters are nonnumeric digits (not numbers and not symbols), and A and B fitthat specification. The next two metacharacters match any single character that is not a space, and C and A fitthat specification. The next four metacharacters match any single numeric digit, and 1, 2, 2, and 1 fit thatspecification. The next three metacharacters match any single character (numeric, alphabetic, or symbol) thatis not a space, and Y, Z, and z fit that specification. The final four metacharacters match any single numericdigit, and 3, 3, 3, and 3 fit that specification.

B. Incorrect: The first two metacharacters specify nonnumeric digits (not numbers and not symbols), and thesecond digit, 1, does not match this specification. There is no point in further analysis. The pattern does not fitthe specification.

C. Correct: The first two metacharacters are nonnumeric digits (not numbers and not symbols), and A and B fitthat specification. The next two metacharacters match any single character that is not a space, and 9 and 8 fitthat specification. The next four metacharacters match any single numeric digit, and 6, 5, 5, and 6 fit thatspecification. The next three metacharacters match any single character (numeric, alphabetic, or symbol) thatis not a space, and +, +, and + fit that specification. The final four metacharacters match any single numericdigit, and 9, 6, 8, and 8 fit that specification.

D. Incorrect: The first two metacharacters specify nonnumeric digits (not numbers and not symbols), and thefirst digit, 1, does not match this specification. There is no point in further analysis. The pattern does not fit thespecification.

E. Correct: The first two metacharacters are nonnumeric digits (not numbers and not symbols), and G and o fitthat specification. The next two metacharacters match any single character that is not a space, and o and d fit

Page 292: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

that specification. The next four metacharacters match any single numeric digit, and 4, 4, 4, and 4 fit thatspecification. The next three metacharacters match any single character (numeric, alphabetic, or symbol) thatis not a space, and b, a, and d fit that specification. The final four metacharacters match any single numericdigit, and 2, 2, 2, and 2 fit that specification.

F. Incorrect: The first two metacharacters specify nonnumeric digits (not numbers and not symbols), and thefirst digit, 4, does not match this specification. There is no point in further analysis. The pattern does not fit thespecification.

QUESTION 461You are using the EMC New Transport Rule Wizard to create a transport protection rule that IRM-protectsemail traffic. What check box do you need to select on the Action page of the wizard, shown in Figure 7-16?

A. Append Disclaimer Text And Fallback Action If Unable To ApplyB. Rights Protect Message With RMS TemplateC. Add A Recipient In The To Field AddressD. Forward The Message To Addresses For Moderation

Page 293: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: You would select the Append Disclaimer Text And Fallback Action If Unable To Apply check box ifyou were configuring a disclaimer. You do not need to select that check box when configuring a transportprotection rule that IRM-protects email traffic.

B. Correct: You IRM-protect email traffic by configuring a transport protection rule that applies an RMStemplate. Therefore, you need to select the Rights Protect Message With RMS Template check box.

C. Incorrect: You select the Add A Recipient In The To Field Address check box if you want to send specifiedemail traffic to an additional user. You do not need to select that check box when configuring a transportprotection rule that IRM-protects email traffic. D. Incorrect: You select the Forward The Message To AddressesFor Moderation check box if you are configuring moderation. You do not need to select that check box whenconfiguring a transport protection rule that IRM-protects email traffic.

QUESTION 462You want to configure a transport rule that appends an HTML disclaimer to all messages sent outside yourorganization (Adatum.com). The disclaimer should read, All messages sent by the Adatum Corporation havebeen checked for viruses and other malware using the best and most up-to-date software available. If, for anyreason, this disclaimer cannot be appended to an email message, the message should be rejected. What EMScommand creates the transport rule AppendDisclaimer that implements this requirement?

A. New-TransportRule -Name AppendDisclaimer -Enabled $true -SentToScope NotInOrganization -ApplyHtmlDisclaimerLocation Append -ApplyHtmlDisclaimerText <h3>Adatum Corporation Policy</h3><p>All messages sent by the Adatum Corporation have been checked for viruses and other malwareusing the best and most up-to-date software available.</p> -ApplyHtmlDisclaimerFallbackAction Reject

B. New-TransportRule -Name AppendDisclaimer -Enabled $true -SentToScope InOrganization -ApplyHtmlDisclaimerLocation Append -ApplyHtmlDisclaimerText <h3>Adatum Corporation Policy</h3><p>All messages sent by the Adatum Corporation have been checked for viruses and other malwareusing the best and most up-to-date software available.</p> - ApplyHtmlDisclaimerFallbackAction Reject

C. New-TransportRule -Name AppendDisclaimer -Enabled $true -SentToScope NotInOrganization -ApplyHtmlDisclaimerLocation Append -ApplyHtmlDisclaimerText <h3>Adatum Corporation Policy</h3><p>All messages sent by the Adatum Corporation have been checked for viruses and other malwareusing the best and most up-to-date software available.</p> -ApplyHtmlDisclaimerFallbackAction Ignore

D. New-TransportRule -Name AppendDisclaimer -Enabled $true -SentToScope InOrganization -ApplyHtmlDisclaimerLocation Append -ApplyHtmlDisclaimerText <h3>Adatum Corporation Policy</h3><p>All messages sent by the Adatum Corporation have been checked for viruses and other malwareusing the best and most up-to-date software available.</p> -ApplyHtmlDisclaimerFallbackAction Ignore

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: AA. Correct: This creates a transport rule that appends an HTML disclaimer as specified to all messages sentoutside the organization Adatum.com. If, for any reason, this disclaimer cannot be appended to an emailmessage, the message is rejected.

B. Incorrect: This creates a transport rule that appends an HTML disclaimer to all messages sent inside theorganization Adatum.com.

Page 294: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. Incorrect: This creates a transport rule that appends an HTML disclaimer as specified to all messages sentoutside the organization Adatum.com. However, if this disclaimer cannot be appended to an email message,the requirement that the disclaimer should be appended is ignored, and the message is sent without thedisclaimer.

D. Incorrect: This creates a transport rule that appends an HTML disclaimer as specified to all messages sentwithin the organization Adatum.com. Also, if this disclaimer cannot be appended to an email message, therequirement that the disclaimer should be appended is ignored, and the message is sent without the disclaimer.

QUESTION 463You want to designate the Active Directory site MySite as a hub site for the purposes of Exchange messagerouting. What EMS command do you enter?

A. Get-AdSite -Identity MyADSite -HubSiteEnabled $trueB. Get-AdSiteLink -Identity MyADSite -HubSiteEnabled $trueC. Set-AdSite -Identity MySite -HubSiteEnabled $trueD. Set-AdSiteLink -Identity MyADSite -HubSiteEnabled $true

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: The Get-AdSite cmdlet displays configuration information about one or more Active Directory sites.You cannot use it to designate a site as a hub site. B. Incorrect: The Get-AdSiteLink cmdlet lets you viewconfiguration information about an Active Directory IP site link. You cannot use it to designate a site as a hubsite.

C. Correct: This command designates the Active Directory site MySite as a hub site.

D. Incorrect: You can use the Set-AdSiteLink cmdlet to assign an Exchange-specific cost to an Active DirectoryIP site link. You can also use this cmdlet to configure the maximum message size that can pass across anActive Directory IP site link. However, you cannot use it to designate a site as a hub site.

QUESTION 464Email traffic from Active Directory site Site01 destined for Site03 currently passes through Site02. The ActiveDirectory cost of the route from Site01 to Site03 through Site02 is 200. An alternative path exists throughSite04, but the Active Directory cost of this route is 300. You want to ensure that email traffic from Site01 toSite03 is routed through Site04 rather than Site02. You do not want to affect other, non-Exchange networktraffic. You want to implement this change by configuring the IP site link Site02-Site03. What EMS command doyou use?

A. Set-AdSiteLink -Identity Site02-Site03 -ExchangeCost 100B. Set-AdSiteLink -Identity Site02-Site03 -ExchangeCost 400C. Set-AdSite -Identity Site03 -ExchangeCost 400D. Set-AdSite -Identity Site02 -ExchangeCost 400

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: Setting the Exchange cost of IP site link Site02-Site03 to 100 does not ensure that the total cost ofthe route from Site01 to Site03 via Site02 is greater than 300 for email traffic. This setting would not guarantee

Page 295: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

that traffic is routed through Site04 rather than Site02.

B. Correct: Setting the Exchange cost of IP site link Site02-Site03 to 400 ensures that the total cost of the routefrom Site01 to Site03 via Site02 is greater than 300 for email traffic. This setting guarantees that email traffic isrouted through Site04 rather than Site02.

C. Incorrect: The Set-ADSite EMS cmdlet is used to reconfigure a site. For example, you could use it toconfigure a site as a hub site. You cannot use this cmdlet to configure the cost of a site link.D. Incorrect: The Set-ADSite EMS cmdlet is used to reconfigure a site. For example, you could use it toconfigure a site as a hub site. You cannot use this cmdlet to configure the cost of a site link.

QUESTION 465You are creating a Send connector to send email to a domain with which you have established MTLSauthentication. Which usage type would you specify?

A. CustomB. InternalC. InternetD. Partner

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: D

A. Incorrect: You would select the Custom usage type for a Send connector on an unsubscribed EdgeTransport server that sends email to a Hub Transport server, for a cross-forest Send connector on a HubTransport server that sends email to an Exchange Server 2010 or Exchange Server 2007 Hub Transportserver, or for an Exchange Server 2003 bridgehead server in a second forest. To send email to a domain withwhich youhave established MTLS authentication, you need to create a Send connector with the Partner usage type.

B. Incorrect: You would select the Internal usage type for a Send connector on a subscribed Edge Transportserver that sends email to a Hub Transport server or to an Exchange 2003 bridgehead server. To send email toa domain with which you have established MTLS authentication, you need to create a Send connector with thePartner usage type.

C. Incorrect: You would select the Internet usage type for a Send connector on an Edge Transport server thatsends email to the Internet. To send email to a domain with which you have established MTLS authentication,you need to create a Send connector with the Partner usage type.

D. Correct: You would create a Send connector with the Partner usage type to send email to a domain withwhich you have established MTLS authentication.

QUESTION 466You want to ensure that the maximum size of any email message sent to the contoso.com domain and all itssubdomains is 5 MB. You have already configured a Send connector named ContosoSend that sends email tothe *.contoso.com address space. What command reconfigures this Send connector to enforce this limitation?

A. Set-SendConnector "Identity ContosoSend "MaxMessageSize 5MBB. Set-SendConnector "Identity ContosoSend "Usage Custom "MaxMessageSize 5MBC. Set-SendConnector "Identity ContosoSend "AddressSpace contoso.com,mail .contoso.com

"MaxMessageSize 5MBD. Set-SendConnector "Identity ContosoSend "IsScopedConnector $true "MaxMessageSize 5MB

Page 296: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: A

A. Correct: This command reconfigures the ContosoSend Send connector so that it rejects any email messagegreater than 5 MB.

B. Incorrect: You cannot reconfigure the usage type of a Send connector by using the Set-SendConnector EMScmdlet. In any case, the Send connector is already configured to send email to the contoso.com domain and allits subdomains. and you require only to reconfigure the maximum message size.

C. Incorrect: The Send connector is already configured to send email to the contoso. com domain and all itssubdomains, and you require only to reconfigure the maximum message size. This command also reconfiguresthe address space so that the Send connector sends email only to the contoso.com and mail.contoso.comdomains, which is not what is required.

D. Incorrect: If you set the IsScopedConnector parameter to $true, the Send connector is available only to HubTransport servers within your own Exchange organization. This is not what is required.

QUESTION 467You want to create a Receive connector named MyRC with the Custom usage type. The connector listens forincoming SMTP connections on the IP address 10.10.123.123 and port 25. It accepts incoming SMTPconnections only from the IP range 10.10.8.1 through 10.10.8.127. You want to set the authenticationmechanism of the Receive connector to be Integrated Windows authentication. What command do you use tocreate this connector?

A. Set-ReceiveConnector -Name MyRC -Usage Custom -Bindings 10.10.123.123:25 -RemoteIPRanges10.10.8.1-10.10.8.127 "AuthMechanism Integrated

B. Set-ReceiveConnector -Name MyRC -Usage Custom -Bindings 10.10.8.1-10.10.8.127 "RemoteIPRanges10.10.123.123:25 AuthMechanism Integrated

C. New-ReceiveConnector -Name MyRC -Usage Custom -Bindings 10.10.123.123:25 -RemoteIPRanges10.10.8.1-10.10.8.127 "AuthMechanism Integrated

D. New-ReceiveConnector -Name MyRC -Usage Custom -Bindings 10.10.8.1-

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: C

A. Incorrect: You use the New-ReceiveConnector EMS cmdlet--not Set-ReceiveConnector--to create a Receiveconnector.

B. Incorrect: You use the New-ReceiveConnector EMS cmdlet--not Set-ReceiveConnector--to create a Receiveconnector. Also, the arguments for the Bindings and the RemoteIPRanges parameters are incorrect in thiscommand.

C. Correct: This command creates a Receive connector named MyRC with the Custom usage type. Theconnector listens for incoming SMTP connections on the IP address 10.10.123.123 and port 25. It acceptsincoming SMTP connections only from the IP range 10.10.8.1 through 10.10.8.127. The authenticationmechanism of this Receive connector is set to Integrated Windows authentication.

D. Incorrect: The Bindings parameter defines the IP address and port on which the connector listens. This

Page 297: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

parameter should take the argument 10.10.123.123:25. The RemoteIPRanges parameter should take theargument 10.10.8.1-10.10.8.127. In this

QUESTION 468Which of the following EMS cmdlets would you use to configure an existing accepted domain to change it frombeing an internal relay domain to being Authoritative?

A. Set-ForeignConnectorB. Set-SendConnectorC. Set-AddressRewriteEntryD. Set-AcceptedDomain

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: The Set-ForeignConnector cmdlet allows you to modify the properties of a foreign connector butdoes not allow you to modify the properties of an accepted domain.B. Incorrect: The Set-SendConnector cmdlet allows you to modify a send connector but does not allow you tomodify the properties of an accepted domain. C. Incorrect: The Set-AddressRewriteEntry cmdlet is used toreconfigure an address rewrite entry but does not allow you to modify the properties of an accepted domain.

D. Correct: You can use the Set-AcceptedDomain cmdlet to convert an existing accepted domain from being aninternal relay domain to one that is authoritative.

QUESTION 469Your organization is partnered with Contoso. You want to allow recipients at Contoso to receive internal out-of-office messages from users in your organization. You want to ensure that other partners do not receive thesemessages. Which of the following EMS cmdlets would you use to accomplish this goal?

A. New-RemoteDomainB. New-ForeignConnectorC. New-SendConnectorD. New-AcceptedDomain

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: A

A. Correct: You can configure whether out-of-office messages are sent to a particular external location byconfiguring a remote domain for that location using the New-RemoteDomain cmdlet.

B. Incorrect: The new-ForeignConnector cmdlet creates a new foreign connector. You cannot configurewhether out-of-office settings for foreign connectors.

C. Incorrect: The new-Sendconnector cmdlet creates a send connector. You cannot configure out-of- officesettings for send connectors.

D. Incorrect: The New-AcceptedDomain cmdlet is used to configure accepted domains, which involve incomingrather than outgoing messages.

Page 298: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 470You are configuring Exchange to accept incoming email for the domain Fabrikam. com. Messages toaddresses in Fabrikam.com are delivered to mailboxes hosted on your organization s Exchange Server 2010mailbox servers. Which of the following should you configure with respect to the Fabrikam.com domain on yourorganization s transport servers to support this configuration?

A. Internal relay domainB. Authoritative domainC. External relay domainD. Foreign connector

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: An internal relay domain is a domain for which your organization accepts messages but wherethose messages are forwarded to an internal messaging system other than Exchange.

B. Correct: Authoritative domains are domains for which your Exchange organization accepts email messages.

C. Incorrect: External relay domains are domains for which your organization will accept email but for whichyour organization hands off the messages to an external third party. You configure an authoritative domainwhen your organization accepts email messages for a specific domain.

D. Incorrect: Foreign connectors are connectors to external mail systems. You should configure an authoritativedomain in this situation.

QUESTION 471Your organization is in the process of changing its name. It is currently known as Wingtip Toys but will bechanging its name to Tailspin Toys. You want to ensure that users are able to receive email at addresses eitherfor the domains wingtiptoys.com and tailspintoys.com. You have configured Tailspin Toys and Wingtip Toys asauthoritative domains. Which of the following commands should you use to configure email addresses for usersthat reflect the new company name?

A. New-AddressRewriteEntryB. New-AcceptedDomainC. New-EmailAddressPolicyD. New-AddressList

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: C

A. Incorrect: Address rewrite entries are used to rewrite addresses as they are going out but do not configureemail addresses for users. You use an email address policy to accomplish this goal.

B. Incorrect: You have already configured Wingtip Toys and Tailspin Toys as authoritative domains, so there isno need to use the New-AcceptedDomain cmdlet. You use an email address policy to accomplish this goal.

C. Correct: You use the New-EmailAddress policy to create a set of new email addresses for users. Forexample, you could create a policy that automatically populated email addresses based on the format.

Page 299: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

[email protected].

D. Incorrect: The New-AddressList cmdlet is used to create new address lists but is not used to create newemail address formats.

QUESTION 472Which of the following EMS cmdlets would you use to configure transport dumpster settings on yourorganization s Hub Transport servers?

A. Set-TransportServerB. Set-TransportAgentC. Set-TransportConfigD. Set-SendConnector

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: C

A. Incorrect: The Set-TransportServer cmdlet is used to configure options for a single transport server but is notused to configure transport dumpster properties, which are configured at the organization level.

B. Incorrect: The Set-TransportAgent command allows you to modify the settings of a transport agent but doesnot allow you to configure the settings of the transport dumpster.

C. Correct: The Set-TransportConfig cmdlet is used to configure transport dumpster properties on anorganization's Hub Transport servers.

D. Incorrect: The Set-SendConnector cmdlet allows you to modify the settings of a send connector but does notallow you to configure transport dumpster properties.

QUESTION 473Which of the following features or roles must be installed on a computer running Windows Server 2008 R2before you can install the Hub Transport role? (Choose all that apply.)

A. .NET Framework 3.5.1B. Active Directory Lightweight Directory ServicesC. RPC over HTTPD. Active Directory Domain Services

Correct Answer: ABSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answers: A and B

A. Correct: You need to ensure that .NET Framework 3.5.1 or later, Active Directory Lightweight DirectoryServices, and the RSAT tools for Active Directory Directory Services are installed on a computer runningWindows Server 2008 R2 before you can deploy the Edge Transport server role.

B. Correct: You need to ensure that .NET Framework 3.5.1 or later, Active Directory Lightweight DirectoryServices, and the RSAT tools for Active Directory Directory Services are installed on a computer runningWindows Server 2008 R2 before you can deploy the Edge Transport server role.

Page 300: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. Incorrect: The RPC over HTTP role is necessary if you are going to install the Client Access server role andsupport Outlook Anywhere, but it is not necessary to install this role to support the Edge Transport server role.

D. Incorrect: The Active Directory Directory Services role does not need to be installed on a server to supportthe Edge Transport server role. The RSAT tools to administer Active Directory Directory Services role arerequired, but these are separate from Active Directory Directory Services.

QUESTION 474You are configuring a third-party firewall device that is used to demarcate your internal network from thescreened network on which your organization s Edge Transport server resides. You have opened port 25between the Edge Transport server and the Hub Transport servers on your internal network. Which other portsshould you open to support the EdgeSync synchronization process?

A. TCP port 443B. TCP port 110C. TCP port 50636D. TCP port 80

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: TCP port 443 is used for Secure Sockets Layer transmissions. You must open TCP port 50636 tosupport EdgeSync synchronization.B. Incorrect: TCP port 110 is used to support the POP3 protocol. You must open TCP port 50636 to supportEdgeSync synchronization.

C. Correct: The EdgeSync synchronization process requires that TCP port 50636 be open on a firewallseparating the screened network from the internal network that hosts your organization's Hub Transportservers.

D. Incorrect: Port 80 is used by the HTTP protocol. You must open TCP port 50636 to support EdgeSyncsynchronization.

QUESTION 475Your organization TMs Edge Transport server, VAN-EX-A, recently failed. While the server was unavailable,users were unable to send or receive messages from external locations. As this had a negative impact on thebusiness, management authorized the purchase of a second server to hold the Edge Transport role. The nameof this server is VAN-EX-B. There are custom transport rules present on the existing server. You want toensure that the new server has an identical configuration. Which of the following steps should you take toaccomplish this goal? (Choose 2; each answer forms part of the solution.)

A. Run the ExportEdgeConfig.ps1 script on VAN-EX-AB. Run the ImportEdgeConfig.ps1 script on VAN-EX-BC. Run the ImportEdgeConfig.ps1 script on VAN-EX-AD. Run the ExportEdgeConfig.ps1 script on VAN-EX-B

Correct Answer: ABSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answers: A and B

Page 301: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Correct: You must export the configuration of server VAN-EX-A, which has the existing custom transportrules.B. Correct: You must import the configuration exported from VAN-EX-A onto server VAN-EX-B. This willtransfer the existing custom transport rules from the original server to the new server.C. Incorrect: You should not import the configuration onto VAN-EX-A, as this server already has the customtransport rules.D. Incorrect: You should not export the configuration of server VAN-EX-B, as this server does not have anytransport rules that you wish to copy to another location.

QUESTION 476You are about to perform the EdgeSync process between an Edge Transport server named VAN-ET and a HubTransport server named VAN-HT. Which of the following commands would you run as a part of that process?(Choose 2; each answer forms part of the solution.)

A. Start-EdgeSynchronization on VAN-HTB. Start-EdgeSynchronization on VAN-ETC. New-EdgeSubscription on VAN-HTD. New-EdgeSubscription on VAN-ET

Correct Answer: CDSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answers: C and DA. Incorrect: The Start-EdgeSynchronization cmdlet initiates synchronization when an existing subscription ispresent; it cannot be used to create a subscription. B. Incorrect: The Start-EdgeSynchronization cmdlet initiatessynchronization when an existing subscription is present; it cannot be used to create a subscription.

C. Correct: You can import a subscription file generated on an Edge Transport server using the New-EdgeSubscription cmdlet.

D. Correct: You can create a subscription file on an Edge Transport server by using the New- EdgeSubscriptioncmdlet.

QUESTION 477Your organization uses a multitude of different internal email addresses based on which business unit a user islocated in. You want to keep these internal addresses but also want to ensure that all email addressed torecipients on the Internet uses a consistent email address format for your organization s parent email domain,Contoso.com. Which of the following cmdlets would you use to accomplish this goal?

A. New-SendConnectorB. New-EmailAddressPolicyC. New-AddressRewriteEntryD. New-RemoteDomain

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: C

A. Incorrect: You should not set up a new send connector, as send connectors cannot be used to rewriteoutbound email so that they use a consistent email address format.

Page 302: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

B. Incorrect: You should not use the New-EmailAddressPolicy cmdlet, as you want to keep existing internaladdresses but rewrite the addresses associated with outbound messages.

C. Correct: You can use the New-AddressRewriteEntry cmdlet to configure a new address rewrite entry so thatall outbound email uses a consistent email address format.

D. Incorrect: You should not set up a new remote domain, as remote domains cannot be used to rewriteoutbound emails so that they use a consistent email address format.

QUESTION 478You want to view detailed information, including backup and mount status information, about the public folderdatabase on the ContosoMail01 mailbox server. What EMS command do you enter?

A. Get-PublicFolderDatabase "Identity ContosoMail01 | FLB. Get-PublicFolderDatabase "Server ContosoMail01 | FLC. Get-PublicFolderDatabase "Identity ContosoMail01 -Status | FLD. Get-PublicFolderDatabase "Server ContosoMail01 -Status | FL

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: You identify the Mailbox server by using the Server parameter, not the Identity parameter. Also,you need to specify the Status parameter to view status information.

B. Incorrect: You need to specify the Status parameter to view status information.

C. Incorrect: You identify the Mailbox server by using the Server parameter, not the Identity parameter.

D. Correct: This command enables you to view detailed information, including backup and mount statusinformation, about the public folder database on the ContosoMail01 Mailbox server.

QUESTION 479You want to discover whether the status of the mailbox database MyMailboxDatabase is BackupInProgress,Mounted, or OnlineMaintenanceInProgress. You also want to find how much free space is available in thedatabase root. What EMS command do you enter?

A. Get-MailboxDatabase -Identity MyMailboxDatabase -Status | FLB. Get-MailboxDatabase -Server MyMailboxDatabase "Status | FLC. Get-MailboxDatabase -Identity MyMailboxDatabase " DumpsterStatistics | FLD. Get-MailboxDatabase -Server MyMailboxDatabase " DumpsterStatistics | FL

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: A

A. Correct: This command returns the status of the mailbox database MyMailboxDatabase and tells you howmuch free space is available in the database root.

B. Incorrect: To identify a specific mailbox database, you need to use the Identity parameter, not the Serverparameter.

Page 303: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. Incorrect: Specifying the DumpsterStatistics parameter lets you obtain statistics (if available) about thetransport dumpster, such as dumpster deletes per second, dumpster inserts per second, and dumpster itemcount. This parameter does not return the status of the mailbox database and does not tell you how much freespace is available in the database root.

D. Incorrect: To identify a specific mailbox database, you need to use the Identity parameter, not the Serverparameter. Also, specifying the DumpsterStatistics parameter lets you obtain statistics (if available) about thetransport dumpster, such as dumpster deletes per second, dumpster inserts per second, and dumpster itemcount. This parameter does not return the status of the mailbox database and does not tell you how much freespace is available in the database root.

QUESTION 480You want to obtain statistics for the Jeff Hay mailbox in the mailbox database MyMailboxDatabase on theMailbox server Mal01. You enter the following command: Get-MailboxStatistics "Identity "Jeff Hay" | FL Mailboxstatistics are not returned, but instead you get a warning message. What is the likely reason for this?

A. You need to use the Server parameter and specify the value Mail01.B. You need to use the Database parameter and specify the value MyMailboxDatabase.C. Jeff Hay has never logged on to his mailbox, and the mailbox has not been accessed in any other way (for

example, an email message has not been sent to it).D. You need to use the Get-StoreUsageStatistics cmdlet, not the Get-MailboxStatistics cmdlet.

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: You use the Identity parameter to specify a single mailbox when you are viewing mailbox statistics.You do not need to use the Server parameter. B. Incorrect: You use the Identity parameter to specify a singlemailbox when you are viewing mailbox statistics. You do not need to use the Database parameter.

C. Correct: If you attempt to obtain statistics for a mailbox that has not been accessed, you will get no statisticalinformation but will instead receive a warning message that tells you the user has not logged on to the mailbox.

D. Incorrect: You can use the Get-StoreUsageStatistics EMS cmdlet to generate a report on the 25 accountsthat are using the greatest amount of resources within a mailbox database. You can use this cmdlet to generatea report on a single user, but only if that user is in the top 25 resource users list. The command specified in thequestion is the correct command for obtaining mailbox statistics for a single mailbox.

QUESTION 481Which mailbox database copy status indicates that the mailbox database copy is no longer connected to theactive database copy and that it was in the Resynchronizing state when the loss of connection occurred?

A. DisconnectedAndResynchronizingB. ActivationSuspendedC. SeedingD. DisconnectedAndHealthy

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: A

Page 304: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Correct: The DisconnectedAndResynchronizing status indicates that the mailbox database copy is no longerconnected to the active database copy and that it was in the Resynchronizing state when the loss of connectionoccurred. This status represents the database copy's view of connectivity to its source database copy. It maybe reported during DAG network failures between the source copy and the target database copy.

B. Incorrect: The ActivationSuspended status indicates that an administrator has manually blocked the mailboxdatabase copy from activation. It does not indicate that the mailbox database copy is no longer connected tothe active database copy and that it was in the Resynchronizing state when the loss of connection occurred. C.Incorrect: The Seeding status indicates that the mailbox database copy is being seeded, the content index forthe mailbox database copy is being seeded, or both. It does not indicate that the mailbox database copy is nolonger connected to the active database copy and that it was in the Resynchronizing state when the loss ofconnection occurred. D. Incorrect: The DisconnectedAndHealthy status indicates that the mailbox databasecopy is no longer connected to the active database copy and was in the Healthy state when the loss ofconnection occurred. It does not indicate that the mailbox database copy was in the Resynchronizing statewhen the loss of connection occurred.

QUESTION 482Which EMS cmdlet can you use to generate a report on the 25 accounts that are using the greatest amount ofresources within a mailbox database?

A. Get-MailboxStatisticsB. Get-StoreUsageStatisticsC. Get-MailboxDatabaseD. Get-MailboxDatabaseCopyStatus

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: The Get-MailboxStatistics cmdlet enables you to view the statistics for all the mailboxes on aserver, for all the mailboxes in a mailbox database, or for a single mailbox. It does not generate a report on the25 accounts that are using the greatest amount of resources within a mailbox database.

B. Correct: The Get-StoreUsageStatistics cmdlet enables you to generate a report on the 25 accounts that areusing the greatest amount of resources within a mailbox database.

C. Incorrect: The Get-MailboxDatabase cmdlet enables you to obtain general information about mailboxdatabases. It does not generate a report on the 25 accounts that are using the greatest amount of resourceswithin a mailbox database. D. Incorrect: The Get-MailboxDatabaseCopyStatus cmdlet enables you to viewstatus information about mailbox database copies. It does not generate a report on the 25 accounts that areusing the greatest amount of resources within a mailbox database.

QUESTION 483You want to enable message tracking on the Mailbox server AdatumMail02. What EMS command do you use?

A. Set-TransportServer "Identity AdatumMail02 -MessageTrackingLogEnabled:$falseB. Set-MailboxServer "Identity AdatumMail02 -MessageTrackingLogEnabled:$falseC. Set-TransportServer "Identity AdatumMail02 -MessageTrackingLogEnabled:$trueD. Set-MailboxServer "Identity AdatumMail02 -MessageTrackingLogEnabled:$true

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Page 305: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: You use the Set-MailboxServer cmdlet, not the Set-TransportServer cmdlet, to configure messagetracking for the Mailbox server role.B. Incorrect: This command disables message tracking on the Mailbox server AdatumMail02.C. Incorrect: You use the Set-MailboxServer cmdlet, not the Set-TransportServer cmdlet, to configure messagetracking for the Mailbox server role.

D. Correct: This command enables message tracking on the Mailbox server AdatumMail02

QUESTION 484You want to change the maximum size of each message tracking log file on the Edge Transport server NY-Edge01 to 15 MB. What command do you enter in the EMS?

A. Set-TransportServer "Identity NY-Edge01 -MessageTrackingLogMaxDirectorySize 15MBB. Set-TransportServer "Identity NY-Edge01 -MessageTrackingLogMaxFileSize 15MBC. Set-MailboxServer "Identity NY-Edge01 -MessageTrackingLogMaxDirectorySize 15MBD. Set-MailboxServer "Identity NY-Edge01 -MessageTrackingLogMaxFileSize 15MB

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: The MessageTrackingLogMaxDirectorySize parameter sets the maximum size for the entiremessage tracking log directory, not the maximum size of each message tracking log file.

B. Correct: This command changes the maximum size of each message tracking log file on the Edge Transportserver NY-Edge01 to 15 MB.

C. Incorrect: To change message tracking log message sizes on an Edge Transport server, you need to usethe Set-TransportServer cmdlet, not the Set-MailboxServer cmdlet. Also, theMessageTrackingLogMaxDirectorySize parameter sets the maximum size for the entire message tracking logdirectory, not the maximum size of each message tracking log file. D. Incorrect: To change message trackinglog message sizes on an Edge Transport server, you need to use the Set-TransportServer cmdlet, not the Set-MailboxServer cmdlet.

QUESTION 485You want to display the number of messages in queues on an Edge Transport server in the Contoso.comdomain that are bound for the BlueSkyAirlines.com domain. What command do you enter in the EMS?

A. Get-Queue "Filter {NextHopDomain "eq blueskyairlines.com }B. Get-Queue -Filter {MessageCount -gt 50}C. Get-Queue "Filter {NextHopDomain "eq adatum.com }D. Get-Queue -Filter {MessageCount -ge 50}

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: A

Page 306: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Correct: This command lists the number of messages on the Edge Transport server on which it is enteredthat are bound for the BlueSkyAirlines.com domain as their next-hop destination.

B. Incorrect: This command lists all the queues on the Hub Transport or Edge Transport server on which it isentered that that contain more than 50 messages. It does not take the next-hop destination into account.

C. Incorrect: This command lists the number of messages on the Edge Transport server on which it is enteredthat are bound for the Adatum.com domain as their next-hop destination.D. Incorrect: This command lists all the queues on the Hub Transport or Edge Transport server on which it isentered that that contain more than 50 or more messages. It does not take the next-hop destination intoaccount.

QUESTION 486You want to suspend all queues on a Hub Transport server that have a message count equal to or greater than450 and have a status of Retry. The command should work immediately without requiring confirmation.What EMS command do you enter on the server?

A. Suspend-Queue -Filter {MessageCount -ge 450 -and Status -eq Retry }B. Suspend-Queue -Filter {MessageCount -gt 450 -and Status -eq Retry } -Confirm:$FalseC. Suspend-Queue -Filter {MessageCount -ge 450 -and Status -eq Active } -Confirm:$FalseD. Suspend-Queue -Filter {MessageCount -ge 450 -and Status -eq Retry } -Confirm:$False

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: This command suspends all queues on the Hub Transport server on which it is entered that have amessage count equal to or greater than 450 and have a status of Retry. However, the command does not workimmediately and requires confirmation.

B. Incorrect: This command suspends all queues on the Hub Transport server on which it is entered that have amessage count greater than 450 and have a status of Retry. It would not suspend a queue that has a messagecount of exactly 450. C. Incorrect: This command suspends all queues on the Hub Transport server on which itis entered that have a message count equal to or greater than 450 and have a status of Active.

D. Correct: This command suspends all queues on the Hub Transport server on which it is entered that have amessage count equal to or greater than 450 and have a status of Retry. The command works immediatelywithout requiring confirmation.

QUESTION 487You want to test the message flow from the Mailbox server NY-EX1 to the Mailbox server NY-EX2. Whatcommand do you enter in the EMS?

A. Test-Mailflow NY-EX1 -TargetMailboxServer NY-EX2B. Test-Mailflow NY-EX2 -TargetMailboxServer NY-EX1C. Test-Mailflow NY-EX1 -TargetDatabase NY-EX2D. Test-Mailflow NY-EX1 -TargetEmailAddress NY-EX2

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: A

Page 307: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

A. Correct: This command tests the message flow from the Mailbox server NY-EX1 to the Mailbox server NY-EX2.

B. Incorrect: This command tests the message flow from the Mailbox server NY-E2 to the Mailbox server NY-EX1.C. Incorrect: You use the TargetMailboxServer parameter to specify the target Mailbox server. TheTargetDatabase parameter specifies a target mailbox database. D. Incorrect: You use the TargetMailboxServerparameter to specify the target Mailbox server. The TangetEmailAddress parameter specifies a target emailaddress.

QUESTION 488You have opened a Telnet session on an Edge Transport server and want to access the Mailbox serverMailbox02.fabricam.com in the remote Fabrikam.com domain using SMTP and ESMTP. What Telnet sessioncommand do you enter to access the server Mailbox02.fabricam.com?

A. open Mailbox02.fabrikam.comB. EHLO fabrikam.comC. open Mailbox02.fabricam.com 25D. set localecho

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: CA. Incorrect: You need to specify a port on which you access the specified server. For SMTP and ESMTP, thisis port 25.

B. Incorrect: This command tests that ESMTP is operating in the Fabrikam.com domain. It does not access theserver Mailbox02.fabricam.com using SMTP and ESMTP.

C. Correct: This command accesses the server Mailbox02.fabricam.com using SMTP and ESMTP.

D. Incorrect: This optional command lets you view the characters as you type them. It does not access theserver Mailbox02.fabricam.com using SMTP and ESMTP.

QUESTION 489You want to view the network configuration information for all network adapters configured on a Mailbox server.What EMS cmdlet enables you to do so?

A. Get-NetworkConnectionInfoB. Test-WebServicesConnectivityC. Test-OutlookWebServicesD. Set-ActiveSyncVirtualDirectory

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: AA. Correct: You can use the Get-NetworkConnectionInfo cmdlet to view the network configuration informationfor all network adapters configured on a computer running Exchange Server 2010.

B. Incorrect: The Test-WebServicesConnectivity cmdlet tests the functionality of EWS and performs basic

Page 308: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

operations to verify the functionality of Outlook Anywhere. You cannot use this cmdlet to view the networkconfiguration information for network adapters. C. Incorrect: The Test-OutlookWebServices cmdlet enables youto verify the service information returned to an Outlook client from the Autodiscover service. You cannot usethis cmdlet to view the network configuration information for network adapters. D. Incorrect: The Set-ActiveSyncVirtualDirectory cmdlet enables you to configure the Exchange ActiveSync virtual directory. Youcannot use this cmdlet to view the network configuration information for network adapters.

QUESTION 490You want to test POP3 connectivity over an SSL connection between the Client Access server VAN- CAS01and all mailboxes in your Exchange organization. What EMS command do you use?

A. Test-PopConnectivity -MailboxServer:VAN-CAS01 "ConnectionType:TLSB. Test-PopConnectivity -ClientAccessServer:VAN-CAS01 "ConnectionType:TLSC. Test-PopConnectivity -MailboxServer:VAN-CAS01 "ConnectionType:SSLD. Test-PopConnectivity -ClientAccessServer:VAN-CAS01 "ConnectionType:SSL

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: You use the ClientAccessServer parameter, not the MailboxServer parameter, to specify a ClientAccess server. Also, the ConnectionType parameter in this answer is TLS. It should be SSL.B. Incorrect: The ConnectionType parameter in this answer is TLS. It should be SSL. C. Incorrect: You use theClientAccessServer parameter, not the MailboxServer parameter, to specify a Client Access server.

D. Correct: This command tests POP3 connectivity over an SSL connection between the Client Access serverVAN-CAS01 and all mailboxes in your Exchange organization.

QUESTION 491Your organization provides email access to third-party email clients on TCP port 143 on the Client Accessserver NY-CAS01. Some clients are unable to retrieve email. What EMS cmdlet would you use to verify that therelevant service on MY-CAS01 is functioning correctly?

A. Test-ImapConnectivityB. Test-PopConnectivityC. Test-MapiConnectivityD. Test-WebServicesConnectivity

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: AA. Correct: IMAP4 uses port 143 by default. SSL-protected IMAP4 uses port 993. For either port, you can usecommands based on the Test-ImapConnectivity EMS cmdlet to verify that the IMAP4 service is working asexpected.

B. Incorrect: POP3 uses port 110. SSL-protected POP3 uses port 995. Therefore, commands based on theTest-PopConnectivity EMS cmdlet verify that the POP3 service is working on these ports, not on port 143.

C. Incorrect: RPC uses port 135. MAPI negotiates a dynamic port with a port number greater than 1024.Therefore, the Test-MapiConnectivity cmdlet tests connectivity on these ports, not on port 143.

Page 309: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

D. Incorrect: The Test-WebServicesConnectivity cmdlet tests the functionality of EWS and performs basicoperations to verify the functionality of Outlook Anywhere. It does not test connectivity on port 143.

QUESTION 492You want to test Web services continuity for only the Getfolder operation between a Client Access server andall mailboxes in the same Exchange organization. You want the test to operate over a secure channelauthenticated by any available SSL certificate. What EMS command do you enter on the Client Access server?

A. Test-WebServicesConnectivity "TrustAnySSLCertificate:$true | FLB. Test-WebServicesConnectivity "LightMode:$true "TrustAnySSLCertificate:$true | FLC. Test-WebServicesConnectivity "AllowUnsecureAccess:$true | FLD. Test-WebServicesConnectivity "LightMode:$true "AllowUnsecureAccess:$true | FL

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:

Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: This command tests Web services continuity for the Getfolder operation. The test operates over asecure channel authenticated by any available SSL certificate. However, the command also tests continuity forthe CreateItem, DeleteItem, and SyncFolderItems operations.B. Correct: This command tests Web services continuity for the Getfolder operation only. The test can operateover a secure channel authenticated by any available SSL certificate. C. Incorrect: This command tests Webservices continuity for the Getfolder operation. However, the test can operate over an insecure channel butcannot operate over a secure channel authenticated by any available SSL certificate. Also, the command testscontinuity for the CreateItem, DeleteItem, and SyncFolderItems operations in addition to the Getfolderoperation.D. Incorrect: This command tests Web services continuity for the Getfolder operation. However, the test canoperate over an insecure channel but cannot operate over a secure channel authenticated by any available SSLcertificate.

QUESTION 493You want to list the top 10 mailboxes in the mailbox database Research in descending order of item count.What command do you enter in the EMS?

A. Get-MailboxStatistics "Database Research | Sort-Object ItemCount | Select-Object "First 10 | FTDisplayName,ItemCount

B. Get-MailboxStatistics "Database Research | Select-Object ItemCount "Descending | Sort-Object "First 10 |FT DisplayName,ItemCount

C. Get-Mailbox "Database Research | Sort-Object ItemCount "Descending | Select-Object "First 10 | FTDisplayName,ItemCount

D. Get-MailboxStatistics "Database Research | Sort-Object ItemCount "Descending | Select-Object "First 10 |FT DisplayName,ItemCount

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: D

A. Incorrect: Sort-Object does not sort in descending order by default. You need to include the Descendingswitch parameter.

Page 310: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

B. Incorrect: Sort-Object sorts in the order defined by a statistic. You use Select Object to define the number ofobjects listed. In this answer, the cmdlets are the wrong way around.

C. Incorrect: You use Get-MailboxStatistics, not Get-Mailbox, to return such statistics as item count.

D. Correct: This command lists the top 10 mailboxes in the mailbox database Research in descending order ofitem count.

QUESTION 494Which Exchange tool would you use to generate a health scan report on a computer running Exchange Server2010?

A. System Center Operations Manager 2007B. Exchange Server Mail Flow AnalyzerC. ExBPAD. EMS

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: C

A. Incorrect: You can use System Center Operations Manager 2007 for server monitoring.The tool does not generate a health scan report.

B. Incorrect: You use Exchange Server Mail Flow Analyzer to troubleshoot mail flow problems. The tool doesnot generate a health scan report.

C. Correct: ExBPA can generate a health scan report.

D. Incorrect: Although you can use EMS commands to obtain information that could indicate problems, the tooldoes not directly generate a health scan report.

QUESTION 495The Mailbox server DEN-EX1 has three mailbox databases: Research, Manufacturing, and Production. Youwant to generate a report about the logon statistics of only those mailboxes hosted in the Research database.You want this data outputted in table format. Which of the following EMS commands would you enter?

A. Get-LogonStatistics "Database Research | FTB. Get-LogonStatistics "Server DEN-EX1 | FTC. Get-LogonStatistics "Database Research | FLD. Get-LogonStatistics "Server DEN-EX1 | FL

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: AA. Correct: This command outputs the logon statistics for the mailboxes in the Research database in tableformat. In a production system, you might want to capture the statistics in a CSV file or view only selectedstatistics, but neither of these facilities is required by the question.

B. Incorrect: This command outputs the logon statistics for the mailboxes in the entire DEN-EX1 server in table

Page 311: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

format.

C. Incorrect: This command outputs the logon statistics for the mailboxes in the Research database in listformat.

D. Incorrect: This command outputs the logon statistics for the mailboxes in the entire DEN-EX1 server in listformat.

QUESTION 496You want to list all folders in the Kim Akers mailbox in descending order of item count. You want to report theresult in list format and display only the folder name and the number of items. What command do you enter inthe EMS?

A. Get-MailboxStatistics "Identity Kim Akers | Sort-Object NumberOfItems "Descending | FL Name,NumberOfItems

B. Get-MailboxFolderStatistics "Identity Kim Akers | Sort-Object NumberOfItems "Descending | FLName,NumberOfItems

C. Get-MailboxStatistics "Identity Kim Akers | Sort-Object NumberOfItems "Descending | FT Name,NumberOfItems

D. Get-MailboxFolderStatistics "Identity Kim Akers | Sort-Object NumberOfItems "Descending | FTName,NumberOfItems

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: The Get-MailboxStatistics cmdlet returns statistics for one or more entire mailboxes. It does notreturn mailbox folder statistics.

B. Correct: This command lists all folders in the Kim Akers mailbox in descending order of item count. It reportsthe result in list format and displays only the folder name and the number of items.

C. Incorrect: The Get-MailboxStatistics cmdlet returns statistics for one or more entire mailboxes. It does notreturn mailbox folder statistics. Also, the FT cmdlet displays the results in table format, not list format.D. Incorrect: The FT cmdlet displays the results in table format, not list format.

QUESTION 497You want to test that the system mailbox on the Mailbox server DEN-EX1 can send email to the mailbox withthe SMTP address [email protected]. What command do you enter in the EMS?

A. Test-Mailflow "Identity system "TargetEmailAddress [email protected]. Test-Mailflow "Identity DEN-EX1 "TargetEmailAddress [email protected]. Get-Message "Server DEN-EX1 "TargetEmailAddress [email protected]. Test-Mailflow "Identity [email protected] -TargetEmailAddress system

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: The Test-Message cmdlet always sends test messages from a system mailbox. The Identityparameter identifies the server that holds the system mailbox. B. Correct: This command tests that the systemmailbox on the Mailbox server DEN-EX1 can send email to the mailbox with the SMTP address

Page 312: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

[email protected]. C. Incorrect: You can use the Get-Message cmdlet to view the details of one or moremessages in a queue on a computer that has the Hub Transport server role or the Edge Transport server roleinstalled. You cannot use the cmdlet to send test messages.

D. Incorrect: The Identity parameter of the Test-Mailflow cmdlet should identify a server. TheTargetEmailAddress parameter should identify the mailbox to which the test message is sent, in this [email protected].

QUESTION 498Written company policy requires that the facility to track messages by specifying message subject be disabled.You want to configure the relevant setting on the Edge Transport server DEN-EDGE01. What command do youenter?

A. Set-TransportServer "Identity DEN-EDGE01- MessageTrackingLogSubjectLoggingEnabled $trueB. Set-TransportServer "Identity DEN-EDGE01- MessageTrackingLogSubjectLoggingEnabled $falseC. Set-MailboxServer "Identity DEN-EDGE01- MessageTrackingLogSubjectLoggingEnabled $trueD. Set-MailboxServer "Identity DEN-EDGE01- MessageTrackingLogSubjectLoggingEnabled $true

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: You need to disable subject logging on the tracking logs. This command enables it.

B. Correct: This command disables subject logging on the tracking logs so that you cannot track messages byspecifying message subject.

C. Incorrect: You cannot run the Set-MailboxServer cmdlet on an Edge Transport server. D. Incorrect: Youcannot run the Set-MailboxServer cmdlet on an Edge Transport server.

QUESTION 499Which EMS command enables protocol logging for the intraorganization Send connector?

A. Set-TransportServer "IntraOrgConnectorProtocolLoggingLevel VerboseB. Set-TransportServer "IntraOrgConnectorProtocolLoggingLevel NoneC. Set-MailboxServer "IntraOrgConnectorProtocolLoggingLevel VerboseD. Set-MailboxServer "IntraOrgConnectorProtocolLoggingLevel None

Correct Answer: ASection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: AA. Correct: This command enables protocol logging for the intraorganization Send connector.

B. Incorrect: This command disables protocol logging for the intraorganization Send connector.

C. Incorrect: The intraorganization Send connector exists on Hub Transport servers. You cannot enable ordisable it using commands based on the Set-MailboxServer cmdlet. D. Incorrect: The intraorganization Sendconnector exists on Hub Transport servers. You cannot enable or disable it using commands based on the Set-MailboxServer cmdlet.

Page 313: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

QUESTION 500What type of log files record all activity by anti-spam and antivirus agents?

A. Connectivity logsB. Protocol logsC. Message Tracking logsD. Agent logs

Correct Answer: DSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: DA. Incorrect: Connectivity logs record the connection activity of the outgoing message delivery queues. They donot record all activity by anti-spam and antivirus agents. B. Incorrect: Protocol logs record SMTP activitybetween messaging servers as part of messaging delivery. They do not record all activity by anti-spam andantivirus agents. C. Incorrect: Message Tracking logs record all message activity on Hub Transport, EdgeTransport, and Mailbox servers. They do not record all activity by anti-spam and antivirus agents.

D. Correct: Agent logs record all activity by anti-spam and antivirus agents.

QUESTION 501What command changes the maximum age of the connectivity log files on the Hub Transport server DEN-EX2to 30 days?

A. Set-MailboxServer DEN-EX2 "ConnectivityLogMaxAge 30.00:00:00B. Set-MailboxServer DEN-EX2 "ConnectivityLogMaxAge 30C. Set-TransportServer DEN-EX2 "ConnectivityLogMaxAge 30.00:00:00D. Set-TransportServer DEN-EX2 "ConnectivityLogMaxAge 30

Correct Answer: CSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: C

A. Incorrect: You need to changes the maximum age of the connectivity log files on the Hub Transport serverDEN-EX2. You cannot use the Set-MailboxServer cmdlet to configure a Hub Transport server.

B. Incorrect: You need to changes the maximum age of the connectivity log files on the Hub Transport serverDEN-EX2. You cannot use the Set-MailboxServer cmdlet to configure a Hub Transport server.

C. Correct: This command changes the maximum age of the connectivity log files on the Hub Transport serverDEN-EX2 to 30 days

D. Incorrect: The ConnectivityLogMaxAge parameter requires a time span argument, for example, 30.00:00:00.

QUESTION 502What EMS command sets the maximum size of the routing table log directory to 70 MB on the Edge Transportserver DEN-EDGE01

A. Set-TransportServer "Server DEN-EDGE01 -RoutingTableLogMaxDirectorySize 70MBB. Set-TransportServer "Identity DEN-EDGE01 -RoutingTableLogMaxDirectorySize 70MB

Page 314: GRATIS EXAM - Microsoft.SurePass.70-662.v2012 …...2012/10/17  · Number: 70-662 Passing Score: 700 Time Limit: 120 min File Version: 1.1 Concatenation of Binary 181q, AnotherInbox

C. Set-TransportServer "Identity DEN-EDGE01 -RoutingTableLogMaxAge 14.00:00:00D. Set-MailboxServer "Identity DEN-EDGE01 -RoutingTableLogMaxDirectorySize 70MB

Correct Answer: BSection: (none)Explanation

Explanation/Reference:Explanation/Reference:Correct Answer: BA. Incorrect: The maximum size of the routing table log directory is set on a per-server basis. The cmdlet usesthe Identity parameter to specify the server. The Server parameter is used in commands where a per-serversetting is optional. B. Correct: This command sets the maximum size of the routing table log directory to 70 MBon the Edge Transport server DEN-EDGE01.

C. Incorrect: This command sets the maximum age of routing table log files to 14 days on the Edge Transportserver DEN-EDGE01.D. Incorrect: The server DEN-EDGE01 is an Edge Transport server. You cannot use the Set- MailboxServercmdlet to set any properties associated with the Edge Transport server role.

http://www.gratisexam.com/


Recommended